PPC: ensure_undef_dynamic on weak undef only in plt
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf64-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC64-specific support for 64-bit ELF.
2 Copyright (C) 1999-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Linus Nordberg, Swox AB <info@swox.com>,
4 based on elf32-ppc.c by Ian Lance Taylor.
5 Largely rewritten by Alan Modra.
6
7 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
20 with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
21 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22
23
24 /* The 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI may be found at
25 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/PPC-elf64abi.txt, and
26 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/spec/book1.html */
27
28 /* Don't generate unused section symbols. */
29 #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS false
30
31 #include "sysdep.h"
32 #include <stdarg.h>
33 #include "bfd.h"
34 #include "bfdlink.h"
35 #include "libbfd.h"
36 #include "elf-bfd.h"
37 #include "elf/ppc64.h"
38 #include "elf64-ppc.h"
39 #include "dwarf2.h"
40
41 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
42 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
43
44 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_ha_reloc
45 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
46 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_branch_reloc
47 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
48 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc
49 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
50 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc
51 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
52 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc
53 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_reloc
55 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc
57 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
58 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc
59 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
60 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc
61 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
62 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc
63 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
64 static bfd_vma opd_entry_value
65 (asection *, bfd_vma, asection **, bfd_vma *, bool);
66
67 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf64_le_vec
68 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf64-powerpcle"
69 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_vec
70 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc"
71 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
72 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC64_ELF_DATA
73 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC64
74 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
75 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
76 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
77 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc64_elf_info_to_howto
78
79 #define elf_backend_want_got_sym 0
80 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
81 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment 3
82 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
83 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 8
84 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
85 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
86 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
87 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
88 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
89 #define elf_backend_default_execstack 0
90
91 #define bfd_elf64_mkobject ppc64_elf_mkobject
92 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup
93 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup
94 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
95 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_print_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data
96 #define bfd_elf64_new_section_hook ppc64_elf_new_section_hook
97 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create
98 #define bfd_elf64_get_synthetic_symtab ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
99 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_just_syms ppc64_elf_link_just_syms
100 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_gc_sections ppc64_elf_gc_sections
101
102 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc64_elf_object_p
103 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus
104 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo
105 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc64_elf_write_core_note
106 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections
107 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
108 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook
109 #define elf_backend_check_directives ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs
110 #define elf_backend_notice_as_needed ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed
111 #define elf_backend_archive_symbol_lookup ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup
112 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc64_elf_check_relocs
113 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
114 #define elf_backend_gc_keep ppc64_elf_gc_keep
115 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_dynamic_ref ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref
116 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook
117 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
118 #define elf_backend_hide_symbol ppc64_elf_hide_symbol
119 #define elf_backend_maybe_function_sym ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym
120 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections ppc64_elf_edit
121 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
122 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc64_elf_hash_symbol
123 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_2_index_sections
124 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc64_elf_action_discarded
125 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc64_elf_relocate_section
126 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
127 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class
128 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
129 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook
130 #define elf_backend_special_sections ppc64_elf_special_sections
131 #define elf_backend_section_flags ppc64_elf_section_flags
132 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol_attribute ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute
133 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol ppc64_elf_merge_symbol
134 #define elf_backend_get_reloc_section bfd_get_section_by_name
135
136 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
137 section. */
138 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
139
140 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table. */
141 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 8)
142 #define LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 16 : 8)
143
144 /* The initial size of the plt reserved for the dynamic linker. */
145 #define PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 16)
146
147 /* Offsets to some stack save slots. */
148 #define STK_LR 16
149 #define STK_TOC(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 40 : 24)
150 /* This one is dodgy. ELFv2 does not have a linker word, so use the
151 CR save slot. Used only by optimised __tls_get_addr call stub,
152 relying on __tls_get_addr_opt not saving CR.. */
153 #define STK_LINKER(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 32 : 8)
154
155 /* TOC base pointers offset from start of TOC. */
156 #define TOC_BASE_OFF 0x8000
157 /* TOC base alignment. */
158 #define TOC_BASE_ALIGN 256
159
160 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
161 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
162 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
163
164 /* .plt call stub instructions. The normal stub is like this, but
165 sometimes the .plt entry crosses a 64k boundary and we need to
166 insert an addi to adjust r11. */
167 #define STD_R2_0R1 0xf8410000 /* std %r2,0+40(%r1) */
168 #define ADDIS_R11_R2 0x3d620000 /* addis %r11,%r2,xxx@ha */
169 #define LD_R12_0R11 0xe98b0000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0@l(%r11) */
170 #define MTCTR_R12 0x7d8903a6 /* mtctr %r12 */
171 #define LD_R2_0R11 0xe84b0000 /* ld %r2,xxx+8@l(%r11) */
172 #define LD_R11_0R11 0xe96b0000 /* ld %r11,xxx+16@l(%r11) */
173 #define BCTR 0x4e800420 /* bctr */
174
175 #define ADDI_R11_R11 0x396b0000 /* addi %r11,%r11,off@l */
176 #define ADDI_R12_R11 0x398b0000 /* addi %r12,%r11,off@l */
177 #define ADDI_R12_R12 0x398c0000 /* addi %r12,%r12,off@l */
178 #define ADDIS_R2_R2 0x3c420000 /* addis %r2,%r2,off@ha */
179 #define ADDI_R2_R2 0x38420000 /* addi %r2,%r2,off@l */
180
181 #define XOR_R2_R12_R12 0x7d826278 /* xor %r2,%r12,%r12 */
182 #define ADD_R11_R11_R2 0x7d6b1214 /* add %r11,%r11,%r2 */
183 #define XOR_R11_R12_R12 0x7d8b6278 /* xor %r11,%r12,%r12 */
184 #define ADD_R2_R2_R11 0x7c425a14 /* add %r2,%r2,%r11 */
185 #define CMPLDI_R2_0 0x28220000 /* cmpldi %r2,0 */
186 #define BNECTR 0x4ca20420 /* bnectr+ */
187 #define BNECTR_P4 0x4ce20420 /* bnectr+ */
188
189 #define LD_R12_0R2 0xe9820000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0(%r2) */
190 #define LD_R11_0R2 0xe9620000 /* ld %r11,xxx+0(%r2) */
191 #define LD_R2_0R2 0xe8420000 /* ld %r2,xxx+0(%r2) */
192
193 #define LD_R2_0R1 0xe8410000 /* ld %r2,0(%r1) */
194 #define LD_R2_0R12 0xe84c0000 /* ld %r2,0(%r12) */
195 #define ADD_R2_R2_R12 0x7c426214 /* add %r2,%r2,%r12 */
196
197 #define LI_R11_0 0x39600000 /* li %r11,0 */
198 #define LIS_R2 0x3c400000 /* lis %r2,xxx@ha */
199 #define LIS_R11 0x3d600000 /* lis %r11,xxx@ha */
200 #define LIS_R12 0x3d800000 /* lis %r12,xxx@ha */
201 #define ADDIS_R2_R12 0x3c4c0000 /* addis %r2,%r12,xxx@ha */
202 #define ADDIS_R12_R2 0x3d820000 /* addis %r12,%r2,xxx@ha */
203 #define ADDIS_R12_R11 0x3d8b0000 /* addis %r12,%r11,xxx@ha */
204 #define ADDIS_R12_R12 0x3d8c0000 /* addis %r12,%r12,xxx@ha */
205 #define ORIS_R12_R12_0 0x658c0000 /* oris %r12,%r12,xxx@hi */
206 #define ORI_R11_R11_0 0x616b0000 /* ori %r11,%r11,xxx@l */
207 #define ORI_R12_R12_0 0x618c0000 /* ori %r12,%r12,xxx@l */
208 #define LD_R12_0R12 0xe98c0000 /* ld %r12,xxx@l(%r12) */
209 #define SLDI_R11_R11_34 0x796b1746 /* sldi %r11,%r11,34 */
210 #define SLDI_R12_R12_32 0x799c07c6 /* sldi %r12,%r12,32 */
211 #define LDX_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b602a /* ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
212 #define ADD_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b6214 /* add %r12,%r11,%r12 */
213 #define PADDI_R12_PC 0x0610000039800000ULL
214 #define PLD_R12_PC 0x04100000e5800000ULL
215 #define PNOP 0x0700000000000000ULL
216
217 /* __glink_PLTresolve stub instructions. We enter with the index in
218 R0 for ELFv1, and the address of a glink branch in R12 for ELFv2. */
219 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE(htab) \
220 (8u + (htab->opd_abi ? 11 * 4 : htab->has_plt_localentry0 ? 14 * 4 : 13 * 4))
221 /* 0: */
222 /* .quad plt0-1f */
223 /* __glink: */
224 #define MFLR_R12 0x7d8802a6 /* mflr %12 */
225 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005 /* bcl 20,31,1f */
226 /* 1: */
227 #define MFLR_R11 0x7d6802a6 /* mflr %11 */
228 /* ld %2,(0b-1b)(%11) */
229 #define MTLR_R12 0x7d8803a6 /* mtlr %12 */
230 #define ADD_R11_R2_R11 0x7d625a14 /* add %11,%2,%11 */
231 /* ld %12,0(%11) */
232 /* ld %2,8(%11) */
233 /* mtctr %12 */
234 /* ld %11,16(%11) */
235 /* bctr */
236
237 #define MFLR_R0 0x7c0802a6 /* mflr %r0 */
238 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
239 #define SUB_R12_R12_R11 0x7d8b6050 /* subf %r12,%r11,%r12 */
240 #define ADDI_R0_R12 0x380c0000 /* addi %r0,%r12,0 */
241 #define SRDI_R0_R0_2 0x7800f082 /* rldicl %r0,%r0,62,2 */
242 #define LD_R0_0R11 0xe80b0000 /* ld %r0,0(%r11) */
243 #define ADD_R11_R0_R11 0x7d605a14 /* add %r11,%r0,%r11 */
244
245 /* Pad with this. */
246 #define NOP 0x60000000
247
248 /* Some other nops. */
249 #define CROR_151515 0x4def7b82
250 #define CROR_313131 0x4ffffb82
251
252 /* .glink entries for the first 32k functions are two instructions. */
253 #define LI_R0_0 0x38000000 /* li %r0,0 */
254 #define B_DOT 0x48000000 /* b . */
255
256 /* After that, we need two instructions to load the index, followed by
257 a branch. */
258 #define LIS_R0_0 0x3c000000 /* lis %r0,0 */
259 #define ORI_R0_R0_0 0x60000000 /* ori %r0,%r0,0 */
260
261 /* Instructions used by the save and restore reg functions. */
262 #define STD_R0_0R1 0xf8010000 /* std %r0,0(%r1) */
263 #define STD_R0_0R12 0xf80c0000 /* std %r0,0(%r12) */
264 #define LD_R0_0R1 0xe8010000 /* ld %r0,0(%r1) */
265 #define LD_R0_0R12 0xe80c0000 /* ld %r0,0(%r12) */
266 #define STFD_FR0_0R1 0xd8010000 /* stfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
267 #define LFD_FR0_0R1 0xc8010000 /* lfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
268 #define LI_R12_0 0x39800000 /* li %r12,0 */
269 #define STVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c01ce /* stvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
270 #define LVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c00ce /* lvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
271 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
272 #define BLR 0x4e800020 /* blr */
273
274 /* Since .opd is an array of descriptors and each entry will end up
275 with identical R_PPC64_RELATIVE relocs, there is really no need to
276 propagate .opd relocs; The dynamic linker should be taught to
277 relocate .opd without reloc entries. */
278 #ifndef NO_OPD_RELOCS
279 #define NO_OPD_RELOCS 0
280 #endif
281
282 #ifndef ARRAY_SIZE
283 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
284 #endif
285
286 static inline int
287 abiversion (bfd *abfd)
288 {
289 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI;
290 }
291
292 static inline void
293 set_abiversion (bfd *abfd, int ver)
294 {
295 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC64_ABI;
296 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= ver & EF_PPC64_ABI;
297 }
298 \f
299 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
300 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
301 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
302 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
303 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
304 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
305 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
306 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
307 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
308 complain, special_func) \
309 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
310 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
311 #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
312
313 static reloc_howto_type *ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) R_PPC64_max];
314
315 static reloc_howto_type ppc64_elf_howto_raw[] =
316 {
317 /* This reloc does nothing. */
318 HOW (R_PPC64_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
322 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, bitfield,
323 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
324
325 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
326 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
327 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, false, bitfield,
328 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329
330 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
331 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
332 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333
334 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
335 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
336 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337
338 /* Bits 16-31 of an address. */
339 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
340 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341
342 /* Bits 16-31 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low 16
343 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
344 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
345 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
346
347 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
348 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
349 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, false, signed,
350 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
351
352 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
353 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
354 bits must be zero. */
355 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, false, signed,
356 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
357
358 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
359 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
360 two bits must be zero. */
361 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, false, signed,
362 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
363
364 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
365 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, true, signed,
366 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
367
368 /* A variant of R_PPC64_REL24, used when r2 is not the toc pointer. */
369 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, true, signed,
370 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
371
372 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
373 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, true, signed,
374 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
375
376 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
377 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
378 zero. */
379 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, true, signed,
380 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
381
382 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
383 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
384 be zero. */
385 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, true, signed,
386 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
387
388 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
389 symbol. */
390 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
391 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
392
393 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
394 the symbol. */
395 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
396 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
397
398 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
399 the symbol. */
400 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
401 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
402
403 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
404 the symbol. */
405 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
406 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
407
408 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
409 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
410 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
411 shared library into the object, because the object being
412 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
413 HOW (R_PPC64_COPY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
414 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415
416 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR64, but used when setting global offset table
417 entries. */
418 HOW (R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
419 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Created by the link editor. Marks a procedure linkage table
422 entry for a symbol. */
423 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
424 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
425
426 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
427 doubleword64 is set to the load address of the object, plus the
428 addend. */
429 HOW (R_PPC64_RELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
430 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
431
432 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
433 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, bitfield,
434 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
435
436 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
437 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
438 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
439
440 /* 32-bit PC relative. */
441 HOW (R_PPC64_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, signed,
442 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
443
444 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
445 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, bitfield,
446 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
447
448 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
449 FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL32 not supported. */
450 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, signed,
451 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452
453 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
454 the symbol. */
455 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
456 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
457
458 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
459 the symbol. */
460 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
461 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462
463 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
464 the symbol. */
465 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
466 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
469 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
470 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
471
472 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but no overflow warning. */
473 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
474 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
475
476 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
477 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
478 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
479
480 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
481 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
482 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc),
483
484 /* Like R_PPC64_REL24 without touching the two least significant bits. */
485 HOW (R_PPC64_REL30, 2, 30, 0xfffffffc, 2, true, dont,
486 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
487
488 /* Relocs in the 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI, not in the 32-bit ABI. */
489
490 /* A standard 64-bit relocation. */
491 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
492 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
493
494 /* The bits 32-47 of an address. */
495 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, false, dont,
496 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
497
498 /* The bits 32-47 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
499 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
500 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, false, dont,
501 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
502
503 /* The bits 48-63 of an address. */
504 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, false, dont,
505 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
506
507 /* The bits 48-63 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
508 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
509 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, false, dont,
510 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
511
512 /* Like ADDR64, but may be unaligned. */
513 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
514 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
515
516 /* 64-bit relative relocation. */
517 HOW (R_PPC64_REL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, true, dont,
518 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
519
520 /* 64-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
521 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
522 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
523
524 /* 64-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage
525 table. */
526 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL64 not supported. */
527 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, true, dont,
528 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529
530 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation. */
531 /* R_PPC64_TOC16 47 half16* S + A - .TOC. */
532 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
533 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
534
535 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation without overflow. */
536 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_LO 48 half16 #lo (S + A - .TOC.) */
537 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
538 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
539
540 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits. */
541 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HI 49 half16 #hi (S + A - .TOC.) */
542 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
543 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits, plus 1 if the
546 contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is
547 negative. */
548 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HA 50 half16 #ha (S + A - .TOC.) */
549 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
550 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc),
551
552 /* 64-bit relocation; insert value of TOC base (.TOC.). */
553 /* R_PPC64_TOC 51 doubleword64 .TOC. */
554 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
555 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc),
556
557 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but also informs the link editor that the
558 value to relocate may (!) refer to a PLT entry which the link
559 editor (a) may replace with the symbol value. If the link editor
560 is unable to fully resolve the symbol, it may (b) create a PLT
561 entry and store the address to the new PLT entry in the GOT.
562 This permits lazy resolution of function symbols at run time.
563 The link editor may also skip all of this and just (c) emit a
564 R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT to tie the symbol to the GOT entry. */
565 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16 not implemented. */
566 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false,signed,
567 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
568
569 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but without overflow. */
570 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
571 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
572 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
573
574 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address. */
575 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI not implemented. */
576 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
577 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
578
579 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address, plus
580 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
581 is negative. */
582 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA not implemented. */
583 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
584 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
585
586 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
587 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
588 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
589
590 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
591 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
592 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
593
594 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
595 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
596 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
597
598 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
599 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
600 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
601
602 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
603 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
604 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
605
606 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but for instructions with a DS field. */
607 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
608 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
609
610 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
611 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
612 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
613
614 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
615 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
616 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
617
618 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
619 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
620 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
621
622 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
623 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS not implemented. */
624 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
625 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
628 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
629 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
630 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
631
632 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
633 HOW (R_PPC64_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
634 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
635
636 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
637 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
638
639 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
640 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
641
642 /* Marker reloc for optimizing r2 save in prologue rather than on
643 each plt call stub. */
644 HOW (R_PPC64_TOCSAVE, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
645 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
646
647 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
648 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
649 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
650
651 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
652 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
653
654 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
655 definition of its TLS sym. */
656 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPMOD64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
657 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
658
659 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
660 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
661 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
662 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
663 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
664
665 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
666 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
667 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
668
669 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
670 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
671 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
672
673 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
674 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
675 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
676
677 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
678 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
679 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
680
681 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
682 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, false, dont,
683 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
684
685 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
686 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, false, dont,
687 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
688
689 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
690 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, false, dont,
691 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
692
693 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
694 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, false, dont,
695 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
696
697 /* Like DTPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
698 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
699 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
700
701 /* Like DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
702 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
703 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
704
705 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
706 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
707 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
708 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
709
710 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
711 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
712 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
713
714 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
715 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
716 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
717
718 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
719 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
720 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
721
722 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
723 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
724 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
725
726 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
727 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, false, dont,
728 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
729
730 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
731 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, false, dont,
732 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
733
734 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
735 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, false, dont,
736 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
737
738 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
739 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, false, dont,
740 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
741
742 /* Like TPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
743 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
744 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
745
746 /* Like TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
747 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
748 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
749
750 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
751 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
752 to the first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
753 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
754 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
755
756 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
757 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
758 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
759
760 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
761 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
762 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
763
764 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
765 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
766 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
767
768 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
769 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
770 first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
771 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
772 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
773
774 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
775 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
776 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
777
778 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
779 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
780 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
781
782 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
783 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
784 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
785
786 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
787 the offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
788 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
789 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
790
791 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
792 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
793 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
794
795 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
796 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
797 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
798
799 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
800 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
801 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
802
803 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
804 offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
805 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
806 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
807
808 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
809 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, dont,
810 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
811
812 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
813 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
814 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
815
816 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
817 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, signed,
818 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
819
820 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_IREL, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
821 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
822
823 HOW (R_PPC64_IRELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
824 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
825
826 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
827 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
828 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
829
830 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
831 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
832 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
833
834 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
835 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, signed,
836 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
837
838 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
839 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
840 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, signed,
841 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
842
843 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
844 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
845
846 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
847 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
848
849 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, true, dont,
850 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
851
852 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, true, dont,
853 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
854
855 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, true, dont,
856 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
857
858 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, true, dont,
859 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
860
861 /* Like R_PPC64_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
862 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
863 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
864
865 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
866 HOW (R_PPC64_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
867 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
868
869 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but no overflow. */
870 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
871 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
872
873 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but no overflow. */
874 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
875 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
876
877 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
878 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
879 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
880
881 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
882 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
883 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
884
885 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
886 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
887 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
888
889 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
890 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
891 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
892
893 /* Marker reloc on ELFv2 large-model function entry. */
894 HOW (R_PPC64_ENTRY, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
895 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
896
897 /* Like ADDR64, but use local entry point of function. */
898 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, false, dont,
899 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
900
901 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
902 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
903
904 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
905 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
906
907 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT, 2, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
908 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
909
910 HOW (R_PPC64_D34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, false, signed,
911 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
912
913 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_LO, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, false, dont,
914 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
915
916 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HI30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, false, dont,
917 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
918
919 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HA30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, false, dont,
920 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
921
922 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
923 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
924
925 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
926 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
927
928 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
929 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
930
931 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
932 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
933
934 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, false, signed,
935 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
936
937 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, false, signed,
938 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
939
940 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
941 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
942
943 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
944 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
945
946 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
947 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
948
949 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
950 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
951
952 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, false, dont,
953 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
954
955 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, false, dont,
956 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
957
958 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, false, dont,
959 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
960
961 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, false, dont,
962 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
963
964 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, true, dont,
965 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
966
967 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, true, dont,
968 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
969
970 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, true, dont,
971 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
972
973 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, true, dont,
974 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
975
976 HOW (R_PPC64_D28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, false, signed,
977 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
978
979 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, true, signed,
980 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
981
982 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
983 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
984 NULL),
985
986 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
987 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
988 NULL),
989 };
990
991 \f
992 /* Initialize the ppc64_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can
993 be done. */
994
995 static void
996 ppc_howto_init (void)
997 {
998 unsigned int i, type;
999
1000 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
1001 {
1002 type = ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
1003 BFD_ASSERT (type < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table));
1004 ppc64_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
1005 }
1006 }
1007
1008 static reloc_howto_type *
1009 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd, bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
1010 {
1011 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1012
1013 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1014 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1015 ppc_howto_init ();
1016
1017 switch (code)
1018 {
1019 default:
1020 /* xgettext:c-format */
1021 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), abfd,
1022 (int) code);
1023 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1024 return NULL;
1025
1026 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1027 break;
1028 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC64_ADDR32;
1029 break;
1030 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC64_ADDR24;
1031 break;
1032 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16;
1033 break;
1034 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO;
1035 break;
1036 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI;
1037 break;
1038 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH;
1039 break;
1040 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
1041 break;
1042 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA;
1043 break;
1044 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14;
1045 break;
1046 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;
1047 break;
1048 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;
1049 break;
1050 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC64_REL24;
1051 break;
1052 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC: r = R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
1053 break;
1054 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC64_REL14;
1055 break;
1056 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN;
1057 break;
1058 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN;
1059 break;
1060 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16;
1061 break;
1062 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO;
1063 break;
1064 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HI;
1065 break;
1066 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HA;
1067 break;
1068 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC64_COPY;
1069 break;
1070 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT;
1071 break;
1072 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL32;
1073 break;
1074 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT32;
1075 break;
1076 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL32;
1077 break;
1078 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO;
1079 break;
1080 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HI;
1081 break;
1082 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HA;
1083 break;
1084 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF;
1085 break;
1086 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO;
1087 break;
1088 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI;
1089 break;
1090 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA;
1091 break;
1092 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1093 break;
1094 case BFD_RELOC_64: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1095 break;
1096 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER;
1097 break;
1098 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA;
1099 break;
1100 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST;
1101 break;
1102 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA;
1103 break;
1104 case BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL64;
1105 break;
1106 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT64;
1107 break;
1108 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL64;
1109 break;
1110 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC64_TOC16;
1111 break;
1112 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
1113 break;
1114 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HI;
1115 break;
1116 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
1117 break;
1118 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC: r = R_PPC64_TOC;
1119 break;
1120 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16;
1121 break;
1122 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO;
1123 break;
1124 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI;
1125 break;
1126 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA;
1127 break;
1128 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS;
1129 break;
1130 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS;
1131 break;
1132 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_DS;
1133 break;
1134 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS;
1135 break;
1136 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS;
1137 break;
1138 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS;
1139 break;
1140 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS;
1141 break;
1142 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_DS;
1143 break;
1144 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS;
1145 break;
1146 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS;
1147 break;
1148 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS;
1149 break;
1150 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TLS_PCREL:
1151 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC64_TLS;
1152 break;
1153 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC64_TLSGD;
1154 break;
1155 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC64_TLSLD;
1156 break;
1157 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC64_DTPMOD64;
1158 break;
1159 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16;
1160 break;
1161 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
1162 break;
1163 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI;
1164 break;
1165 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH;
1166 break;
1167 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
1168 break;
1169 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA;
1170 break;
1171 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
1172 break;
1173 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16;
1174 break;
1175 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO;
1176 break;
1177 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI;
1178 break;
1179 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH;
1180 break;
1181 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA;
1182 break;
1183 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA;
1184 break;
1185 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL64;
1186 break;
1187 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16;
1188 break;
1189 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;
1190 break;
1191 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;
1192 break;
1193 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;
1194 break;
1195 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16;
1196 break;
1197 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;
1198 break;
1199 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;
1200 break;
1201 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;
1202 break;
1203 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS;
1204 break;
1205 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1206 break;
1207 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI;
1208 break;
1209 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA;
1210 break;
1211 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS;
1212 break;
1213 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1214 break;
1215 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;
1216 break;
1217 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;
1218 break;
1219 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS;
1220 break;
1221 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1222 break;
1223 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER;
1224 break;
1225 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA;
1226 break;
1227 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST;
1228 break;
1229 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1230 break;
1231 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS;
1232 break;
1233 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1234 break;
1235 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER;
1236 break;
1237 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA;
1238 break;
1239 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST;
1240 break;
1241 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1242 break;
1243 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16;
1244 break;
1245 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_LO;
1246 break;
1247 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HI;
1248 break;
1249 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HA;
1250 break;
1251 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH;
1252 break;
1253 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA;
1254 break;
1255 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER;
1256 break;
1257 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA;
1258 break;
1259 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST;
1260 break;
1261 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA;
1262 break;
1263 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_16DX_HA;
1264 break;
1265 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA;
1266 break;
1267 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_ENTRY;
1268 break;
1269 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL;
1270 break;
1271 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34: r = R_PPC64_D34;
1272 break;
1273 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_LO: r = R_PPC64_D34_LO;
1274 break;
1275 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HI30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HI30;
1276 break;
1277 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HA30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HA30;
1278 break;
1279 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
1280 break;
1281 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34;
1282 break;
1283 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34;
1284 break;
1285 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL34: r = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
1286 break;
1287 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL34: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL34;
1288 break;
1289 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34;
1290 break;
1291 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34;
1292 break;
1293 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34;
1294 break;
1295 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34;
1296 break;
1297 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34;
1298 break;
1299 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34;
1300 break;
1301 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34;
1302 break;
1303 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34;
1304 break;
1305 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34;
1306 break;
1307 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34;
1308 break;
1309 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34;
1310 break;
1311 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34;
1312 break;
1313 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D28: r = R_PPC64_D28;
1314 break;
1315 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL28: r = R_PPC64_PCREL28;
1316 break;
1317 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT;
1318 break;
1319 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY;
1320 break;
1321 }
1322
1323 return ppc64_elf_howto_table[r];
1324 };
1325
1326 static reloc_howto_type *
1327 ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd, const char *r_name)
1328 {
1329 unsigned int i;
1330 static char *compat_map[][2] = {
1331 { "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34", "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34" },
1332 { "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34", "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34" },
1333 { "R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34", "R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34" },
1334 { "R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34", "R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34" }
1335 };
1336
1337 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
1338 if (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
1339 && strcasecmp (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
1340 return &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
1341
1342 /* Handle old names of relocations in case they were used by
1343 .reloc directives.
1344 FIXME: Remove this soon. Mapping the reloc names is very likely
1345 completely unnecessary. */
1346 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (compat_map); i++)
1347 if (strcasecmp (compat_map[i][0], r_name) == 0)
1348 {
1349 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: %s should be used rather than %s"),
1350 compat_map[i][1], compat_map[i][0]);
1351 return ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (abfd, compat_map[i][1]);
1352 }
1353
1354 return NULL;
1355 }
1356
1357 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
1358
1359 static bool
1360 ppc64_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd, arelent *cache_ptr,
1361 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
1362 {
1363 unsigned int type;
1364
1365 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1366 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1367 ppc_howto_init ();
1368
1369 type = ELF64_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
1370 if (type >= ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table))
1371 {
1372 /* xgettext:c-format */
1373 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1374 abfd, type);
1375 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1376 return false;
1377 }
1378 cache_ptr->howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[type];
1379 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL || cache_ptr->howto->name == NULL)
1380 {
1381 /* xgettext:c-format */
1382 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1383 abfd, type);
1384 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1385 return false;
1386 }
1387
1388 return true;
1389 }
1390
1391 /* Handle the R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA and similar relocs. */
1392
1393 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1394 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1395 void *data, asection *input_section,
1396 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1397 {
1398 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1399 long insn;
1400 bfd_size_type octets;
1401 bfd_vma value;
1402
1403 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1404 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1405 link time. */
1406 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1407 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1408 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1409
1410 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 (or 34) bits.
1411 We won't actually be using the low bits, so trashing them
1412 doesn't matter. */
1413 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1414 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34
1415 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34
1416 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34
1417 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34)
1418 reloc_entry->addend += 1ULL << 33;
1419 else
1420 reloc_entry->addend += 1U << 15;
1421 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA)
1422 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1423
1424 value = 0;
1425 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1426 value = symbol->value;
1427 value += (reloc_entry->addend
1428 + symbol->section->output_offset
1429 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
1430 value -= (reloc_entry->address
1431 + input_section->output_offset
1432 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1433 value = (bfd_signed_vma) value >> 16;
1434
1435 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1436 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1437 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
1438 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
1439 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1440 if (value + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
1441 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1442 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1443 }
1444
1445 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1446 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1447 void *data, asection *input_section,
1448 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1449 {
1450 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1451 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1452 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1453
1454 if (strcmp (symbol->section->name, ".opd") == 0
1455 && (symbol->section->owner->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0)
1456 {
1457 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (symbol->section,
1458 symbol->value + reloc_entry->addend,
1459 NULL, NULL, false);
1460 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
1461 reloc_entry->addend = dest - (symbol->value
1462 + symbol->section->output_section->vma
1463 + symbol->section->output_offset);
1464 }
1465 else
1466 {
1467 elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symbol;
1468
1469 if (symbol->section->owner != abfd
1470 && symbol->section->owner != NULL
1471 && abiversion (symbol->section->owner) >= 2)
1472 {
1473 unsigned int i;
1474
1475 for (i = 0; i < symbol->section->owner->symcount; ++i)
1476 {
1477 asymbol *symdef = symbol->section->owner->outsymbols[i];
1478
1479 if (strcmp (symdef->name, symbol->name) == 0)
1480 {
1481 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symdef;
1482 break;
1483 }
1484 }
1485 }
1486 reloc_entry->addend
1487 += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
1488 }
1489 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1490 }
1491
1492 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1493 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1494 void *data, asection *input_section,
1495 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1496 {
1497 long insn;
1498 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1499 bfd_size_type octets;
1500 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
1501 bool is_isa_v2 = true;
1502
1503 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1504 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1505 link time. */
1506 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1507 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1508 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1509
1510 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1511 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1512 insn &= ~(0x01 << 21);
1513 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1514 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
1515 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN)
1516 insn |= 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
1517
1518 if (is_isa_v2)
1519 {
1520 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
1521 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
1522 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
1523 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
1524 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
1525 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
1526 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
1527 else
1528 goto out;
1529 }
1530 else
1531 {
1532 bfd_vma target = 0;
1533 bfd_vma from;
1534
1535 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1536 target = symbol->value;
1537 target += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1538 target += symbol->section->output_offset;
1539 target += reloc_entry->addend;
1540
1541 from = (reloc_entry->address
1542 + input_section->output_offset
1543 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1544
1545 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
1546 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (target - from) < 0)
1547 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
1548 }
1549 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1550 out:
1551 return ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1552 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1553 }
1554
1555 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1556 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1557 void *data, asection *input_section,
1558 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1559 {
1560 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1561 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1562 link time. */
1563 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1564 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1565 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1566
1567 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1568 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1569 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1570 }
1571
1572 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1573 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1574 void *data, asection *input_section,
1575 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1576 {
1577 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1578 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1579 link time. */
1580 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1581 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1582 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1583
1584 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1585 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1586
1587 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1588 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1589 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1590 }
1591
1592 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1593 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1594 void *data, asection *input_section,
1595 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1596 {
1597 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1598
1599 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1600 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1601 link time. */
1602 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1603 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1604 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1605
1606 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1607 if (TOCstart == 0)
1608 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1609
1610 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1611 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1612 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1613 }
1614
1615 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1616 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1617 void *data, asection *input_section,
1618 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1619 {
1620 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1621
1622 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1623 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1624 link time. */
1625 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1626 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1627 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1628
1629 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1630 if (TOCstart == 0)
1631 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1632
1633 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1634 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1635
1636 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1637 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1638 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1639 }
1640
1641 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1642 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1643 void *data, asection *input_section,
1644 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1645 {
1646 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1647 bfd_size_type octets;
1648
1649 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1650 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1651 link time. */
1652 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1653 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1654 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1655
1656 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1657 if (TOCstart == 0)
1658 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1659
1660 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1661 bfd_put_64 (abfd, TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1662 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1663 }
1664
1665 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1666 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1667 void *data, asection *input_section,
1668 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1669 {
1670 uint64_t insn;
1671 bfd_vma targ;
1672
1673 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1674 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1675 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1676
1677 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1678 insn <<= 32;
1679 insn |= bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1680
1681 targ = (symbol->section->output_section->vma
1682 + symbol->section->output_offset
1683 + reloc_entry->addend);
1684 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1685 targ += symbol->value;
1686 if (reloc_entry->howto->type == R_PPC64_D34_HA30)
1687 targ += 1ULL << 33;
1688 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1689 {
1690 bfd_vma from = (reloc_entry->address
1691 + input_section->output_offset
1692 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1693 targ -=from;
1694 }
1695 targ >>= reloc_entry->howto->rightshift;
1696 insn &= ~reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1697 insn |= ((targ << 16) | (targ & 0xffff)) & reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1698 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1699 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1700 if (reloc_entry->howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
1701 && (targ + (1ULL << (reloc_entry->howto->bitsize - 1))
1702 >= 1ULL << reloc_entry->howto->bitsize))
1703 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1704 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1705 }
1706
1707 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1708 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1709 void *data, asection *input_section,
1710 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1711 {
1712 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1713 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1714 link time. */
1715 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1716 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1717 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1718
1719 if (error_message != NULL)
1720 {
1721 static char *message;
1722 free (message);
1723 if (asprintf (&message, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
1724 reloc_entry->howto->name) < 0)
1725 message = NULL;
1726 *error_message = message;
1727 }
1728 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1729 }
1730
1731 /* Track GOT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
1732 than one got entry per symbol. */
1733 struct got_entry
1734 {
1735 struct got_entry *next;
1736
1737 /* The symbol addend that we'll be placing in the GOT. */
1738 bfd_vma addend;
1739
1740 /* Unlike other ELF targets, we use separate GOT entries for the same
1741 symbol referenced from different input files. This is to support
1742 automatic multiple TOC/GOT sections, where the TOC base can vary
1743 from one input file to another. After partitioning into TOC groups
1744 we merge entries within the group.
1745
1746 Point to the BFD owning this GOT entry. */
1747 bfd *owner;
1748
1749 /* Zero for non-tls entries, or TLS_TLS and one of TLS_GD, TLS_LD,
1750 TLS_TPREL or TLS_DTPREL for tls entries. */
1751 unsigned char tls_type;
1752
1753 /* Non-zero if got.ent points to real entry. */
1754 unsigned char is_indirect;
1755
1756 /* Reference count until size_dynamic_sections, GOT offset thereafter. */
1757 union
1758 {
1759 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1760 bfd_vma offset;
1761 struct got_entry *ent;
1762 } got;
1763 };
1764
1765 /* The same for PLT. */
1766 struct plt_entry
1767 {
1768 struct plt_entry *next;
1769
1770 bfd_vma addend;
1771
1772 union
1773 {
1774 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1775 bfd_vma offset;
1776 } plt;
1777 };
1778
1779 struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata
1780 {
1781 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1782
1783 /* Shortcuts to dynamic linker sections. */
1784 asection *got;
1785 asection *relgot;
1786
1787 /* Used during garbage collection. We attach global symbols defined
1788 on removed .opd entries to this section so that the sym is removed. */
1789 asection *deleted_section;
1790
1791 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. Support for multiple GOT
1792 sections means we potentially need one of these for each input bfd. */
1793 struct got_entry tlsld_got;
1794
1795 union
1796 {
1797 /* A copy of relocs before they are modified for --emit-relocs. */
1798 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
1799
1800 /* Section contents. */
1801 bfd_byte *contents;
1802 } opd;
1803
1804 /* Nonzero if this bfd has small toc/got relocs, ie. that expect
1805 the reloc to be in the range -32768 to 32767. */
1806 unsigned int has_small_toc_reloc : 1;
1807
1808 /* Set if toc/got ha relocs detected not using r2, or lo reloc
1809 instruction not one we handle. */
1810 unsigned int unexpected_toc_insn : 1;
1811
1812 /* Set if PLT/GOT/TOC relocs that can be optimised are present in
1813 this file. */
1814 unsigned int has_optrel : 1;
1815 };
1816
1817 #define ppc64_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1818 ((struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1819
1820 #define ppc64_tlsld_got(bfd) \
1821 (&ppc64_elf_tdata (bfd)->tlsld_got)
1822
1823 #define is_ppc64_elf(bfd) \
1824 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1825 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC64_ELF_DATA)
1826
1827 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1828
1829 static bool
1830 ppc64_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1831 {
1832 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata),
1833 PPC64_ELF_DATA);
1834 }
1835
1836 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 64 bit input bfd when the
1837 default is 32 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1838
1839 static bool
1840 ppc64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1841 {
1842 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1843 return true;
1844
1845 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1848
1849 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
1850 {
1851 /* Relies on arch after 32 bit default being 64 bit default. */
1852 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1853 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64);
1854 }
1855 }
1856 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1857 }
1858
1859 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1860
1861 static bool
1862 ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1863 {
1864 size_t offset, size;
1865
1866 if (note->descsz != 504)
1867 return false;
1868
1869 /* pr_cursig */
1870 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1871
1872 /* pr_pid */
1873 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 32);
1874
1875 /* pr_reg */
1876 offset = 112;
1877 size = 384;
1878
1879 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1880 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1881 size, note->descpos + offset);
1882 }
1883
1884 static bool
1885 ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1886 {
1887 if (note->descsz != 136)
1888 return false;
1889
1890 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1891 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1892 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1893 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 40, 16);
1894 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1895 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 56, 80);
1896
1897 return true;
1898 }
1899
1900 static char *
1901 ppc64_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type,
1902 ...)
1903 {
1904 switch (note_type)
1905 {
1906 default:
1907 return NULL;
1908
1909 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1910 {
1911 char data[136] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1912 va_list ap;
1913
1914 va_start (ap, note_type);
1915 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1916 strncpy (data + 40, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1917 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1918 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1919 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1920 -Wstringop-truncation:
1921 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1922 */
1923 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1924 #endif
1925 strncpy (data + 56, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1926 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1927 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1928 #endif
1929 va_end (ap);
1930 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1931 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1932 }
1933
1934 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1935 {
1936 char data[504];
1937 va_list ap;
1938 long pid;
1939 int cursig;
1940 const void *greg;
1941
1942 va_start (ap, note_type);
1943 memset (data, 0, 112);
1944 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1945 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 32);
1946 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1947 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1948 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1949 memcpy (data + 112, greg, 384);
1950 memset (data + 496, 0, 8);
1951 va_end (ap);
1952 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1953 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1954 }
1955 }
1956 }
1957
1958 /* Add extra PPC sections. */
1959
1960 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc64_elf_special_sections[] =
1961 {
1962 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, 0 },
1963 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1964 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1965 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1966 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1967 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tocbss"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1968 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1969 };
1970
1971 enum _ppc64_sec_type {
1972 sec_normal = 0,
1973 sec_opd = 1,
1974 sec_toc = 2
1975 };
1976
1977 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data
1978 {
1979 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
1980
1981 union
1982 {
1983 /* An array with one entry for each opd function descriptor,
1984 and some spares since opd entries may be either 16 or 24 bytes. */
1985 #define OPD_NDX(OFF) ((OFF) >> 4)
1986 struct _opd_sec_data
1987 {
1988 /* Points to the function code section for local opd entries. */
1989 asection **func_sec;
1990
1991 /* After editing .opd, adjust references to opd local syms. */
1992 long *adjust;
1993 } opd;
1994
1995 /* An array for toc sections, indexed by offset/8. */
1996 struct _toc_sec_data
1997 {
1998 /* Specifies the relocation symbol index used at a given toc offset. */
1999 unsigned *symndx;
2000
2001 /* And the relocation addend. */
2002 bfd_vma *add;
2003 } toc;
2004 } u;
2005
2006 enum _ppc64_sec_type sec_type:2;
2007
2008 /* Flag set when small branches are detected. Used to
2009 select suitable defaults for the stub group size. */
2010 unsigned int has_14bit_branch:1;
2011
2012 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2013 unsigned int has_pltcall:1;
2014
2015 /* Flag set when section has PLT/GOT/TOC relocations that can be
2016 optimised. */
2017 unsigned int has_optrel:1;
2018 };
2019
2020 #define ppc64_elf_section_data(sec) \
2021 ((struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
2022
2023 static bool
2024 ppc64_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2025 {
2026 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
2027 {
2028 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *sdata;
2029 size_t amt = sizeof (*sdata);
2030
2031 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2032 if (sdata == NULL)
2033 return false;
2034 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2035 }
2036
2037 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2038 }
2039
2040 static bool
2041 ppc64_elf_section_flags (const Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
2042 {
2043 const char *name = hdr->bfd_section->name;
2044
2045 if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
2046 || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
2047 hdr->bfd_section->flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
2048
2049 return true;
2050 }
2051
2052 static struct _opd_sec_data *
2053 get_opd_info (asection * sec)
2054 {
2055 if (sec != NULL
2056 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) != NULL
2057 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd)
2058 return &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
2059 return NULL;
2060 }
2061 \f
2062 /* Parameters for the qsort hook. */
2063 static bool synthetic_relocatable;
2064 static const asection *synthetic_opd;
2065
2066 /* qsort comparison function for ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab. */
2067
2068 static int
2069 compare_symbols (const void *ap, const void *bp)
2070 {
2071 const asymbol *a = *(const asymbol **) ap;
2072 const asymbol *b = *(const asymbol **) bp;
2073
2074 /* Section symbols first. */
2075 if ((a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && !(b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2076 return -1;
2077 if (!(a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && (b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2078 return 1;
2079
2080 /* then .opd symbols. */
2081 if (synthetic_opd != NULL)
2082 {
2083 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") == 0
2084 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2085 return -1;
2086 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") != 0
2087 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2088 return 1;
2089 }
2090
2091 /* then other code symbols. */
2092 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2093 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2094 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2095 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2096 return -1;
2097
2098 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2099 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2100 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2101 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2102 return 1;
2103
2104 if (synthetic_relocatable)
2105 {
2106 if (a->section->id < b->section->id)
2107 return -1;
2108
2109 if (a->section->id > b->section->id)
2110 return 1;
2111 }
2112
2113 if (a->value + a->section->vma < b->value + b->section->vma)
2114 return -1;
2115
2116 if (a->value + a->section->vma > b->value + b->section->vma)
2117 return 1;
2118
2119 /* For syms with the same value, prefer strong dynamic global function
2120 syms over other syms. */
2121 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0)
2122 return -1;
2123
2124 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0)
2125 return 1;
2126
2127 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0)
2128 return -1;
2129
2130 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
2131 return 1;
2132
2133 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0)
2134 return -1;
2135
2136 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0)
2137 return 1;
2138
2139 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0)
2140 return -1;
2141
2142 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
2143 return 1;
2144
2145 /* Finally, sort on where the symbol is in memory. The symbols will
2146 be in at most two malloc'd blocks, one for static syms, one for
2147 dynamic syms, and we distinguish the two blocks above by testing
2148 BSF_DYNAMIC. Since we are sorting the symbol pointers which were
2149 originally in the same order as the symbols (and we're not
2150 sorting the symbols themselves), this ensures a stable sort. */
2151 if (a < b)
2152 return -1;
2153 if (a > b)
2154 return 1;
2155 return 0;
2156 }
2157
2158 /* Search SYMS for a symbol of the given VALUE. */
2159
2160 static asymbol *
2161 sym_exists_at (asymbol **syms, size_t lo, size_t hi, unsigned int id,
2162 bfd_vma value)
2163 {
2164 size_t mid;
2165
2166 if (id == (unsigned) -1)
2167 {
2168 while (lo < hi)
2169 {
2170 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2171 if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma < value)
2172 lo = mid + 1;
2173 else if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma > value)
2174 hi = mid;
2175 else
2176 return syms[mid];
2177 }
2178 }
2179 else
2180 {
2181 while (lo < hi)
2182 {
2183 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2184 if (syms[mid]->section->id < id)
2185 lo = mid + 1;
2186 else if (syms[mid]->section->id > id)
2187 hi = mid;
2188 else if (syms[mid]->value < value)
2189 lo = mid + 1;
2190 else if (syms[mid]->value > value)
2191 hi = mid;
2192 else
2193 return syms[mid];
2194 }
2195 }
2196 return NULL;
2197 }
2198
2199 static bool
2200 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
2201 {
2202 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
2203 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2204 && section->vma <= vma
2205 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
2206 }
2207
2208 /* Create synthetic symbols, effectively restoring "dot-symbol" function
2209 entry syms. Also generate @plt symbols for the glink branch table.
2210 Returns count of synthetic symbols in RET or -1 on error. */
2211
2212 static long
2213 ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
2214 long static_count, asymbol **static_syms,
2215 long dyn_count, asymbol **dyn_syms,
2216 asymbol **ret)
2217 {
2218 asymbol *s;
2219 size_t i, j, count;
2220 char *names;
2221 size_t symcount, codesecsym, codesecsymend, secsymend, opdsymend;
2222 asection *opd = NULL;
2223 bool relocatable = (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0;
2224 asymbol **syms;
2225 int abi = abiversion (abfd);
2226
2227 *ret = NULL;
2228
2229 if (abi < 2)
2230 {
2231 opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".opd");
2232 if (opd == NULL && abi == 1)
2233 return 0;
2234 }
2235
2236 syms = NULL;
2237 codesecsym = 0;
2238 codesecsymend = 0;
2239 secsymend = 0;
2240 opdsymend = 0;
2241 symcount = 0;
2242 if (opd != NULL)
2243 {
2244 symcount = static_count;
2245 if (!relocatable)
2246 symcount += dyn_count;
2247 if (symcount == 0)
2248 return 0;
2249
2250 syms = bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2251 if (syms == NULL)
2252 return -1;
2253
2254 if (!relocatable && static_count != 0 && dyn_count != 0)
2255 {
2256 /* Use both symbol tables. */
2257 memcpy (syms, static_syms, static_count * sizeof (*syms));
2258 memcpy (syms + static_count, dyn_syms,
2259 (dyn_count + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2260 }
2261 else if (!relocatable && static_count == 0)
2262 memcpy (syms, dyn_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2263 else
2264 memcpy (syms, static_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2265
2266 /* Trim uninteresting symbols. Interesting symbols are section,
2267 function, and notype symbols. */
2268 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < symcount; ++i)
2269 if ((syms[i]->flags & (BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
2270 | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) == 0)
2271 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2272 symcount = j;
2273
2274 synthetic_relocatable = relocatable;
2275 synthetic_opd = opd;
2276 qsort (syms, symcount, sizeof (*syms), compare_symbols);
2277
2278 if (!relocatable && symcount > 1)
2279 {
2280 /* Trim duplicate syms, since we may have merged the normal
2281 and dynamic symbols. Actually, we only care about syms
2282 that have different values, so trim any with the same
2283 value. Don't consider ifunc and ifunc resolver symbols
2284 duplicates however, because GDB wants to know whether a
2285 text symbol is an ifunc resolver. */
2286 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < symcount; ++i)
2287 {
2288 const asymbol *s0 = syms[i - 1];
2289 const asymbol *s1 = syms[i];
2290
2291 if ((s0->value + s0->section->vma
2292 != s1->value + s1->section->vma)
2293 || ((s0->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)
2294 != (s1->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)))
2295 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2296 }
2297 symcount = j;
2298 }
2299
2300 i = 0;
2301 /* Note that here and in compare_symbols we can't compare opd and
2302 sym->section directly. With separate debug info files, the
2303 symbols will be extracted from the debug file while abfd passed
2304 to this function is the real binary. */
2305 if ((syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
2306 && strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2307 ++i;
2308 codesecsym = i;
2309
2310 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2311 if (((syms[i]->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC
2312 | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2313 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2314 || (syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2315 break;
2316 codesecsymend = i;
2317
2318 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2319 if ((syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2320 break;
2321 secsymend = i;
2322
2323 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2324 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2325 break;
2326 opdsymend = i;
2327
2328 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2329 if (((syms[i]->section->flags
2330 & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
2331 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2332 break;
2333 symcount = i;
2334 }
2335 count = 0;
2336
2337 if (relocatable)
2338 {
2339 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
2340 arelent *r;
2341 size_t size;
2342 size_t relcount;
2343
2344 if (opdsymend == secsymend)
2345 goto done;
2346
2347 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2348 relcount = (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) ? opd->reloc_count : 0;
2349 if (relcount == 0)
2350 goto done;
2351
2352 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, opd, static_syms, false))
2353 {
2354 count = -1;
2355 goto done;
2356 }
2357
2358 size = 0;
2359 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2360 {
2361 asymbol *sym;
2362
2363 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2364 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2365 ++r;
2366
2367 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2368 break;
2369
2370 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2371 continue;
2372
2373 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2374 continue;
2375
2376 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2377 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2378 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2379 {
2380 ++count;
2381 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2382 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2383 }
2384 }
2385
2386 if (size == 0)
2387 goto done;
2388 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2389 if (s == NULL)
2390 {
2391 count = -1;
2392 goto done;
2393 }
2394
2395 names = (char *) (s + count);
2396
2397 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2398 {
2399 asymbol *sym;
2400
2401 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2402 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2403 ++r;
2404
2405 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2406 break;
2407
2408 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2409 continue;
2410
2411 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2412 continue;
2413
2414 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2415 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2416 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2417 {
2418 size_t len;
2419
2420 *s = *syms[i];
2421 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2422 s->section = sym->section;
2423 s->value = sym->value + r->addend;
2424 s->name = names;
2425 *names++ = '.';
2426 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2427 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2428 names += len + 1;
2429 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2430 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2431 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2432 s++;
2433 }
2434 }
2435 }
2436 else
2437 {
2438 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
2439 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
2440 size_t size;
2441 size_t plt_count = 0;
2442 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0, resolv_vma = 0;
2443 asection *dynamic, *glink = NULL, *relplt = NULL;
2444 arelent *p;
2445
2446 if (opd != NULL && !bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, opd, &contents))
2447 {
2448 free_contents_and_exit_err:
2449 count = -1;
2450 free_contents_and_exit:
2451 free (contents);
2452 goto done;
2453 }
2454
2455 size = 0;
2456 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2457 {
2458 bfd_vma ent;
2459
2460 /* Ignore bogus symbols. */
2461 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2462 continue;
2463
2464 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2465 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2466 {
2467 ++count;
2468 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2469 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2470 }
2471 }
2472
2473 /* Get start of .glink stubs from DT_PPC64_GLINK. */
2474 if (dyn_count != 0
2475 && (dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")) != NULL)
2476 {
2477 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
2478 size_t extdynsize;
2479 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
2480
2481 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
2482 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2483
2484 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
2485 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
2486
2487 extdyn = dynbuf;
2488 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
2489 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
2490 {
2491 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
2492 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
2493
2494 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
2495 break;
2496
2497 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC64_GLINK)
2498 {
2499 /* The first glink stub starts at DT_PPC64_GLINK plus 32.
2500 See comment in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections. */
2501 glink_vma = dyn.d_un.d_val + 8 * 4;
2502 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
2503 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
2504 glink stubs now reside. */
2505 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma,
2506 &glink_vma);
2507 break;
2508 }
2509 }
2510
2511 free (dynbuf);
2512 }
2513
2514 if (glink != NULL)
2515 {
2516 /* Determine __glink trampoline by reading the relative branch
2517 from the first glink stub. */
2518 bfd_byte buf[4];
2519 unsigned int off = 0;
2520
2521 while (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
2522 glink_vma + off - glink->vma, 4))
2523 {
2524 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
2525 insn ^= B_DOT;
2526 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
2527 {
2528 resolv_vma
2529 = glink_vma + off + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
2530 break;
2531 }
2532 off += 4;
2533 if (off > 4)
2534 break;
2535 }
2536
2537 if (resolv_vma)
2538 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2539
2540 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
2541 if (relplt != NULL)
2542 {
2543 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2544 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dyn_syms, true))
2545 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2546
2547 plt_count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
2548 size += plt_count * sizeof (asymbol);
2549
2550 p = relplt->relocation;
2551 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2552 {
2553 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
2554 if (p->addend != 0)
2555 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 16;
2556 }
2557 }
2558 }
2559
2560 if (size == 0)
2561 goto free_contents_and_exit;
2562 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2563 if (s == NULL)
2564 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2565
2566 names = (char *) (s + count + plt_count + (resolv_vma != 0));
2567
2568 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2569 {
2570 bfd_vma ent;
2571
2572 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2573 continue;
2574
2575 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2576 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2577 {
2578 size_t lo, hi;
2579 size_t len;
2580 asection *sec = abfd->sections;
2581
2582 *s = *syms[i];
2583 lo = codesecsym;
2584 hi = codesecsymend;
2585 while (lo < hi)
2586 {
2587 size_t mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2588 if (syms[mid]->section->vma < ent)
2589 lo = mid + 1;
2590 else if (syms[mid]->section->vma > ent)
2591 hi = mid;
2592 else
2593 {
2594 sec = syms[mid]->section;
2595 break;
2596 }
2597 }
2598
2599 if (lo >= hi && lo > codesecsym)
2600 sec = syms[lo - 1]->section;
2601
2602 for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2603 {
2604 if (sec->vma > ent)
2605 break;
2606 /* SEC_LOAD may not be set if SEC is from a separate debug
2607 info file. */
2608 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2609 break;
2610 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2611 s->section = sec;
2612 }
2613 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2614 s->value = ent - s->section->vma;
2615 s->name = names;
2616 *names++ = '.';
2617 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2618 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2619 names += len + 1;
2620 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2621 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2622 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2623 s++;
2624 }
2625 }
2626 free (contents);
2627
2628 if (glink != NULL && relplt != NULL)
2629 {
2630 if (resolv_vma)
2631 {
2632 /* Add a symbol for the main glink trampoline. */
2633 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2634 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2635 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2636 s->section = glink;
2637 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2638 s->name = names;
2639 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve",
2640 sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2641 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2642 s++;
2643 count++;
2644 }
2645
2646 /* FIXME: It would be very much nicer to put sym@plt on the
2647 stub rather than on the glink branch table entry. The
2648 objdump disassembler would then use a sensible symbol
2649 name on plt calls. The difficulty in doing so is
2650 a) finding the stubs, and,
2651 b) matching stubs against plt entries, and,
2652 c) there can be multiple stubs for a given plt entry.
2653
2654 Solving (a) could be done by code scanning, but older
2655 ppc64 binaries used different stubs to current code.
2656 (b) is the tricky one since you need to known the toc
2657 pointer for at least one function that uses a pic stub to
2658 be able to calculate the plt address referenced.
2659 (c) means gdb would need to set multiple breakpoints (or
2660 find the glink branch itself) when setting breakpoints
2661 for pending shared library loads. */
2662 p = relplt->relocation;
2663 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2664 {
2665 size_t len;
2666
2667 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
2668 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
2669 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
2670 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
2671 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
2672 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2673 s->section = glink;
2674 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2675 s->name = names;
2676 s->udata.p = NULL;
2677 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
2678 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
2679 names += len;
2680 if (p->addend != 0)
2681 {
2682 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
2683 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
2684 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
2685 names += strlen (names);
2686 }
2687 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
2688 names += sizeof ("@plt");
2689 s++;
2690 if (abi < 2)
2691 {
2692 glink_vma += 8;
2693 if (i >= 0x8000)
2694 glink_vma += 4;
2695 }
2696 else
2697 glink_vma += 4;
2698 }
2699 count += plt_count;
2700 }
2701 }
2702
2703 done:
2704 free (syms);
2705 return count;
2706 }
2707 \f
2708 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2709 functions above are used generally. Those named ppc64_elf_* are
2710 called by the main ELF linker code. They appear in this file more
2711 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2712 ppc64_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2713 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2714 called.
2715
2716 PowerPC64-ELF uses a similar scheme to PowerPC64-XCOFF in that
2717 functions have both a function code symbol and a function descriptor
2718 symbol. A call to foo in a relocatable object file looks like:
2719
2720 . .text
2721 . x:
2722 . bl .foo
2723 . nop
2724
2725 The function definition in another object file might be:
2726
2727 . .section .opd
2728 . foo: .quad .foo
2729 . .quad .TOC.@tocbase
2730 . .quad 0
2731 .
2732 . .text
2733 . .foo: blr
2734
2735 When the linker resolves the call during a static link, the branch
2736 unsurprisingly just goes to .foo and the .opd information is unused.
2737 If the function definition is in a shared library, things are a little
2738 different: The call goes via a plt call stub, the opd information gets
2739 copied to the plt, and the linker patches the nop.
2740
2741 . x:
2742 . bl .foo_stub
2743 . ld 2,40(1)
2744 .
2745 .
2746 . .foo_stub:
2747 . std 2,40(1) # in practice, the call stub
2748 . addis 11,2,Lfoo@toc@ha # is slightly optimized, but
2749 . addi 11,11,Lfoo@toc@l # this is the general idea
2750 . ld 12,0(11)
2751 . ld 2,8(11)
2752 . mtctr 12
2753 . ld 11,16(11)
2754 . bctr
2755 .
2756 . .section .plt
2757 . Lfoo: reloc (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, foo)
2758
2759 The "reloc ()" notation is supposed to indicate that the linker emits
2760 an R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT reloc against foo. The dynamic linker does the opd
2761 copying.
2762
2763 What are the difficulties here? Well, firstly, the relocations
2764 examined by the linker in check_relocs are against the function code
2765 sym .foo, while the dynamic relocation in the plt is emitted against
2766 the function descriptor symbol, foo. Somewhere along the line, we need
2767 to carefully copy dynamic link information from one symbol to the other.
2768 Secondly, the generic part of the elf linker will make .foo a dynamic
2769 symbol as is normal for most other backends. We need foo dynamic
2770 instead, at least for an application final link. However, when
2771 creating a shared library containing foo, we need to have both symbols
2772 dynamic so that references to .foo are satisfied during the early
2773 stages of linking. Otherwise the linker might decide to pull in a
2774 definition from some other object, eg. a static library.
2775
2776 Update: As of August 2004, we support a new convention. Function
2777 calls may use the function descriptor symbol, ie. "bl foo". This
2778 behaves exactly as "bl .foo". */
2779
2780 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2781 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2782 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2783
2784 static int
2785 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2786 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
2787 {
2788 switch (r_type)
2789 {
2790 default:
2791 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2792 address isn't fixed. DTPREL64 is excluded because the
2793 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2794 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC64_OPT_TLS is set. */
2795 return 1;
2796
2797 case R_PPC64_REL32:
2798 case R_PPC64_REL64:
2799 case R_PPC64_REL30:
2800 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
2801 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
2802 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
2803 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
2804 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
2805 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
2806 return 0;
2807
2808 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
2809 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
2810 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
2811 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
2812 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
2813 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
2814 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
2815 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
2816 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
2817 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
2818 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
2819 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
2820 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
2821 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
2822 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2823 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2824 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2825 }
2826 }
2827
2828 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2829 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's .dynbss
2830 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2831 shared lib. With code that gcc generates it is vital that this be
2832 enabled; In the PowerPC64 ELFv1 ABI the address of a function is
2833 actually the address of a function descriptor which resides in the
2834 .opd section. gcc uses the descriptor directly rather than going
2835 via the GOT as some other ABIs do, which means that initialized
2836 function pointers reference the descriptor. Thus, a function
2837 pointer initialized to the address of a function in a shared
2838 library will either require a .dynbss copy and a copy reloc, or a
2839 dynamic reloc. Using a .dynbss copy redefines the function
2840 descriptor symbol to point to the copy. This presents a problem as
2841 a PLT entry for that function is also initialized from the function
2842 descriptor symbol and the copy may not be initialized first. */
2843 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2844
2845 /* Section name for stubs is the associated section name plus this
2846 string. */
2847 #define STUB_SUFFIX ".stub"
2848
2849 /* Linker stubs.
2850 ppc_stub_long_branch:
2851 Used when a 14 bit branch (or even a 24 bit branch) can't reach its
2852 destination, but a 24 bit branch in a stub section will reach.
2853 . b dest
2854
2855 ppc_stub_plt_branch:
2856 Similar to the above, but a 24 bit branch in the stub section won't
2857 reach its destination.
2858 . addis %r12,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2859 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r12)
2860 . mtctr %r12
2861 . bctr
2862
2863 ppc_stub_plt_call:
2864 Used to call a function in a shared library. If it so happens that
2865 the plt entry referenced crosses a 64k boundary, then an extra
2866 "addi %r11,%r11,xxx@toc@l" will be inserted before the "mtctr".
2867 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save starts with "std %r2,40(%r1)".
2868 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2869 . ld %r12,xxx+0@toc@l(%r11)
2870 . mtctr %r12
2871 . ld %r2,xxx+8@toc@l(%r11)
2872 . ld %r11,xxx+16@toc@l(%r11)
2873 . bctr
2874
2875 ppc_stub_long_branch and ppc_stub_plt_branch may also have additional
2876 code to adjust the value and save r2 to support multiple toc sections.
2877 A ppc_stub_long_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2878 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2879 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2880 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2881 . b dest
2882
2883 A ppc_stub_plt_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2884 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2885 . addis %r12,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2886 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r12)
2887 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2888 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2889 . mtctr %r12
2890 . bctr
2891
2892 All of the above stubs are shown as their ELFv1 variants. ELFv2
2893 variants exist too, simpler for plt calls since a new toc pointer
2894 and static chain are not loaded by the stub. In addition, ELFv2
2895 has some more complex stubs to handle calls marked with NOTOC
2896 relocs from functions where r2 is not a valid toc pointer. These
2897 come in two flavours, the ones shown below, and _both variants that
2898 start with "std %r2,24(%r1)" to save r2 in the unlikely event that
2899 one call is from a function where r2 is used as the toc pointer but
2900 needs a toc adjusting stub for small-model multi-toc, and another
2901 call is from a function where r2 is not valid.
2902 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2903 . mflr %r12
2904 . bcl 20,31,1f
2905 . 1:
2906 . mflr %r11
2907 . mtlr %r12
2908 . addis %r12,%r11,dest-1b@ha
2909 . addi %r12,%r12,dest-1b@l
2910 . b dest
2911
2912 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2913 . mflr %r12
2914 . bcl 20,31,1f
2915 . 1:
2916 . mflr %r11
2917 . mtlr %r12
2918 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2919 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2920 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2921 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2922 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2923 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2924 . mtctr %r12
2925 . bctr
2926
2927 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2928 . mflr %r12
2929 . bcl 20,31,1f
2930 . 1:
2931 . mflr %r11
2932 . mtlr %r12
2933 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2934 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2935 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2936 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2937 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2938 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2939 . mtctr %r12
2940 . bctr
2941
2942 There are also ELFv1 power10 variants of these stubs.
2943 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2944 . pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2945 . b dest
2946 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2947 . lis %r11,(dest-1f)@highesta34
2948 . ori %r11,%r11,(dest-1f)@highera34
2949 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2950 . 1: pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2951 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2952 . mtctr %r12
2953 . bctr
2954 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2955 . lis %r11,(xxx-1f)@highesta34
2956 . ori %r11,%r11,(xxx-1f)@highera34
2957 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2958 . 1: pla %r12,xxx@pcrel
2959 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2960 . mtctr %r12
2961 . bctr
2962
2963 In cases where the high instructions would add zero, they are
2964 omitted and following instructions modified in some cases.
2965 For example, a power10 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc might simplify down
2966 to
2967 . pld %r12,xxx@pcrel
2968 . mtctr %r12
2969 . bctr
2970
2971 For a given stub group (a set of sections all using the same toc
2972 pointer value) there will be just one stub type used for any
2973 particular function symbol. For example, if printf is called from
2974 code with the tocsave optimization (ie. r2 saved in function
2975 prologue) and therefore calls use a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub,
2976 and from other code without the tocsave optimization requiring a
2977 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save linkage stub, a single stub of the latter
2978 type will be created. Calls with the tocsave optimization will
2979 enter this stub after the instruction saving r2. A similar
2980 situation exists when calls are marked with R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
2981 relocations. These require a ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub
2982 to call an external function like printf. If other calls to printf
2983 require a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub then a single
2984 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub will be used for both types of
2985 call. If other calls to printf require a ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
2986 linkage stub then a single ppc_stub_plt_call_both linkage stub will
2987 be created and calls not requiring r2 to be saved will enter the
2988 stub after the r2 save instruction. There is an analogous
2989 hierarchy of long branch and plt branch stubs for local call
2990 linkage. */
2991
2992 enum ppc_stub_type
2993 {
2994 ppc_stub_none,
2995 ppc_stub_long_branch,
2996 ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off,
2997 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc,
2998 ppc_stub_long_branch_both, /* r2off and notoc variants both needed. */
2999 ppc_stub_plt_branch,
3000 ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off,
3001 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc,
3002 ppc_stub_plt_branch_both,
3003 ppc_stub_plt_call,
3004 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save,
3005 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc,
3006 ppc_stub_plt_call_both,
3007 ppc_stub_global_entry,
3008 ppc_stub_save_res
3009 };
3010
3011 /* Information on stub grouping. */
3012 struct map_stub
3013 {
3014 /* The stub section. */
3015 asection *stub_sec;
3016 /* This is the section to which stubs in the group will be attached. */
3017 asection *link_sec;
3018 /* Next group. */
3019 struct map_stub *next;
3020 /* Whether to emit a copy of register save/restore functions in this
3021 group. */
3022 int needs_save_res;
3023 /* Current offset within stubs after the insn restoring lr in a
3024 _notoc or _both stub using bcl for pc-relative addressing, or
3025 after the insn restoring lr in a __tls_get_addr_opt plt stub. */
3026 unsigned int lr_restore;
3027 /* Accumulated size of EH info emitted to describe return address
3028 if stubs modify lr. Does not include 17 byte FDE header. */
3029 unsigned int eh_size;
3030 /* Offset in glink_eh_frame to the start of EH info for this group. */
3031 unsigned int eh_base;
3032 };
3033
3034 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry
3035 {
3036 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
3037 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3038
3039 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
3040
3041 /* Group information. */
3042 struct map_stub *group;
3043
3044 /* Offset within stub_sec of the beginning of this stub. */
3045 bfd_vma stub_offset;
3046
3047 /* Given the symbol's value and its section we can determine its final
3048 value when building the stubs (so the stub knows where to jump. */
3049 bfd_vma target_value;
3050 asection *target_section;
3051
3052 /* The symbol table entry, if any, that this was derived from. */
3053 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
3054 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
3055
3056 /* Symbol type. */
3057 unsigned char symtype;
3058
3059 /* Symbol st_other. */
3060 unsigned char other;
3061 };
3062
3063 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry
3064 {
3065 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
3066 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3067
3068 /* Offset within branch lookup table. */
3069 unsigned int offset;
3070
3071 /* Generation marker. */
3072 unsigned int iter;
3073 };
3074
3075 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
3076 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
3077 {
3078 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
3079
3080 /* The input section of the reloc. */
3081 asection *sec;
3082
3083 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
3084 unsigned int count : 31;
3085
3086 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
3087 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
3088 };
3089
3090 struct ppc_link_hash_entry
3091 {
3092 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
3093
3094 union
3095 {
3096 /* A pointer to the most recently used stub hash entry against this
3097 symbol. */
3098 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_cache;
3099
3100 /* A pointer to the next symbol starting with a '.' */
3101 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *next_dot_sym;
3102 } u;
3103
3104 /* Link between function code and descriptor symbols. */
3105 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *oh;
3106
3107 /* Flag function code and descriptor symbols. */
3108 unsigned int is_func:1;
3109 unsigned int is_func_descriptor:1;
3110 unsigned int fake:1;
3111
3112 /* Whether global opd/toc sym has been adjusted or not.
3113 After ppc64_elf_edit_opd/ppc64_elf_edit_toc has run, this flag
3114 should be set for all globals defined in any opd/toc section. */
3115 unsigned int adjust_done:1;
3116
3117 /* Set if this is an out-of-line register save/restore function,
3118 with non-standard calling convention. */
3119 unsigned int save_res:1;
3120
3121 /* Set if a duplicate symbol with non-zero localentry is detected,
3122 even when the duplicate symbol does not provide a definition. */
3123 unsigned int non_zero_localentry:1;
3124
3125 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT (or TOC).
3126 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
3127 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
3128 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
3129 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
3130 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
3131 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
3132 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
3133 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
3134 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
3135 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
3136 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
3137 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
3138 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
3139 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
3140 #define TLS_EXPLICIT 256 /* TOC section TLS reloc, not stored. */
3141 unsigned char tls_mask;
3142
3143 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
3144 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
3145 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
3146 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
3147 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
3148 };
3149
3150 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3151 ppc_elf_hash_entry (struct elf_link_hash_entry *ent)
3152 {
3153 return (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) ent;
3154 }
3155
3156 static inline struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3157 elf_hash_entry (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *ent)
3158 {
3159 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) ent;
3160 }
3161
3162 /* ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3163
3164 struct ppc_link_hash_table
3165 {
3166 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
3167
3168 /* The stub hash table. */
3169 struct bfd_hash_table stub_hash_table;
3170
3171 /* Another hash table for plt_branch stubs. */
3172 struct bfd_hash_table branch_hash_table;
3173
3174 /* Hash table for function prologue tocsave. */
3175 htab_t tocsave_htab;
3176
3177 /* Various options and other info passed from the linker. */
3178 struct ppc64_elf_params *params;
3179
3180 /* The size of sec_info below. */
3181 unsigned int sec_info_arr_size;
3182
3183 /* Per-section array of extra section info. Done this way rather
3184 than as part of ppc64_elf_section_data so we have the info for
3185 non-ppc64 sections. */
3186 struct
3187 {
3188 /* Along with elf_gp, specifies the TOC pointer used by this section. */
3189 bfd_vma toc_off;
3190
3191 union
3192 {
3193 /* The section group that this section belongs to. */
3194 struct map_stub *group;
3195 /* A temp section list pointer. */
3196 asection *list;
3197 } u;
3198 } *sec_info;
3199
3200 /* Linked list of groups. */
3201 struct map_stub *group;
3202
3203 /* Temp used when calculating TOC pointers. */
3204 bfd_vma toc_curr;
3205 bfd *toc_bfd;
3206 asection *toc_first_sec;
3207
3208 /* Used when adding symbols. */
3209 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *dot_syms;
3210
3211 /* Shortcuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
3212 asection *glink;
3213 asection *global_entry;
3214 asection *sfpr;
3215 asection *pltlocal;
3216 asection *relpltlocal;
3217 asection *brlt;
3218 asection *relbrlt;
3219 asection *glink_eh_frame;
3220
3221 /* Shortcut to .__tls_get_addr and __tls_get_addr. */
3222 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
3223 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr_fd;
3224 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tga_desc;
3225 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tga_desc_fd;
3226 struct map_stub *tga_group;
3227
3228 /* The size of reliplt used by got entry relocs. */
3229 bfd_size_type got_reli_size;
3230
3231 /* Statistics. */
3232 unsigned long stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry];
3233
3234 /* Number of stubs against global syms. */
3235 unsigned long stub_globals;
3236
3237 /* Set if we're linking code with function descriptors. */
3238 unsigned int opd_abi:1;
3239
3240 /* Support for multiple toc sections. */
3241 unsigned int do_multi_toc:1;
3242 unsigned int multi_toc_needed:1;
3243 unsigned int second_toc_pass:1;
3244 unsigned int do_toc_opt:1;
3245
3246 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
3247 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
3248
3249 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
3250 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
3251
3252 /* Set on error. */
3253 unsigned int stub_error:1;
3254
3255 /* Whether func_desc_adjust needs to be run over symbols. */
3256 unsigned int need_func_desc_adj:1;
3257
3258 /* Whether plt calls for ELFv2 localentry:0 funcs have been optimized. */
3259 unsigned int has_plt_localentry0:1;
3260
3261 /* Whether calls are made via the PLT from NOTOC functions. */
3262 unsigned int notoc_plt:1;
3263
3264 /* Whether any code linked seems to be Power10. */
3265 unsigned int has_power10_relocs:1;
3266
3267 /* Incremented every time we size stubs. */
3268 unsigned int stub_iteration;
3269 };
3270
3271 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
3272 are used here. */
3273
3274 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
3275 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
3276
3277 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
3278 relocations. */
3279 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
3280
3281 /* Nonzero if this section has any toc or got relocs. */
3282 #define has_toc_reloc sec_flg2
3283
3284 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to another section that uses
3285 the toc or got. */
3286 #define makes_toc_func_call sec_flg3
3287
3288 /* Recursion protection when determining above flag. */
3289 #define call_check_in_progress sec_flg4
3290 #define call_check_done sec_flg5
3291
3292 /* Get the ppc64 ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
3293
3294 #define ppc_hash_table(p) \
3295 ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \
3296 && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC64_ELF_DATA) \
3297 ? (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
3298
3299 #define ppc_stub_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3300 ((struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) \
3301 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3302
3303 #define ppc_branch_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3304 ((struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) \
3305 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3306
3307 /* Create an entry in the stub hash table. */
3308
3309 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3310 stub_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3311 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3312 const char *string)
3313 {
3314 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3315 subclass. */
3316 if (entry == NULL)
3317 {
3318 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry));
3319 if (entry == NULL)
3320 return entry;
3321 }
3322
3323 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3324 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3325 if (entry != NULL)
3326 {
3327 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *eh;
3328
3329 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3330 eh = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry;
3331 eh->stub_type = ppc_stub_none;
3332 eh->group = NULL;
3333 eh->stub_offset = 0;
3334 eh->target_value = 0;
3335 eh->target_section = NULL;
3336 eh->h = NULL;
3337 eh->plt_ent = NULL;
3338 eh->other = 0;
3339 }
3340
3341 return entry;
3342 }
3343
3344 /* Create an entry in the branch hash table. */
3345
3346 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3347 branch_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3348 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3349 const char *string)
3350 {
3351 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3352 subclass. */
3353 if (entry == NULL)
3354 {
3355 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry));
3356 if (entry == NULL)
3357 return entry;
3358 }
3359
3360 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3361 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3362 if (entry != NULL)
3363 {
3364 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *eh;
3365
3366 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3367 eh = (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) entry;
3368 eh->offset = 0;
3369 eh->iter = 0;
3370 }
3371
3372 return entry;
3373 }
3374
3375 /* Create an entry in a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3376
3377 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3378 link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3379 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3380 const char *string)
3381 {
3382 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3383 subclass. */
3384 if (entry == NULL)
3385 {
3386 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry));
3387 if (entry == NULL)
3388 return entry;
3389 }
3390
3391 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3392 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3393 if (entry != NULL)
3394 {
3395 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) entry;
3396
3397 memset (&eh->u.stub_cache, 0,
3398 (sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry)
3399 - offsetof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry, u.stub_cache)));
3400
3401 /* When making function calls, old ABI code references function entry
3402 points (dot symbols), while new ABI code references the function
3403 descriptor symbol. We need to make any combination of reference and
3404 definition work together, without breaking archive linking.
3405
3406 For a defined function "foo" and an undefined call to "bar":
3407 An old object defines "foo" and ".foo", references ".bar" (possibly
3408 "bar" too).
3409 A new object defines "foo" and references "bar".
3410
3411 A new object thus has no problem with its undefined symbols being
3412 satisfied by definitions in an old object. On the other hand, the
3413 old object won't have ".bar" satisfied by a new object.
3414
3415 Keep a list of newly added dot-symbols. */
3416
3417 if (string[0] == '.')
3418 {
3419 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3420
3421 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) table;
3422 eh->u.next_dot_sym = htab->dot_syms;
3423 htab->dot_syms = eh;
3424 }
3425 }
3426
3427 return entry;
3428 }
3429
3430 struct tocsave_entry
3431 {
3432 asection *sec;
3433 bfd_vma offset;
3434 };
3435
3436 static hashval_t
3437 tocsave_htab_hash (const void *p)
3438 {
3439 const struct tocsave_entry *e = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p;
3440 return ((bfd_vma) (intptr_t) e->sec ^ e->offset) >> 3;
3441 }
3442
3443 static int
3444 tocsave_htab_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3445 {
3446 const struct tocsave_entry *e1 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p1;
3447 const struct tocsave_entry *e2 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p2;
3448 return e1->sec == e2->sec && e1->offset == e2->offset;
3449 }
3450
3451 /* Destroy a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3452
3453 static void
3454 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (bfd *obfd)
3455 {
3456 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3457
3458 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) obfd->link.hash;
3459 if (htab->tocsave_htab)
3460 htab_delete (htab->tocsave_htab);
3461 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->branch_hash_table);
3462 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3463 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (obfd);
3464 }
3465
3466 /* Create a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3467
3468 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
3469 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
3470 {
3471 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3472 size_t amt = sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_table);
3473
3474 htab = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
3475 if (htab == NULL)
3476 return NULL;
3477
3478 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&htab->elf, abfd, link_hash_newfunc,
3479 sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry),
3480 PPC64_ELF_DATA))
3481 {
3482 free (htab);
3483 return NULL;
3484 }
3485
3486 /* Init the stub hash table too. */
3487 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_hash_newfunc,
3488 sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry)))
3489 {
3490 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3491 return NULL;
3492 }
3493
3494 /* And the branch hash table. */
3495 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->branch_hash_table, branch_hash_newfunc,
3496 sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry)))
3497 {
3498 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3499 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3500 return NULL;
3501 }
3502
3503 htab->tocsave_htab = htab_try_create (1024,
3504 tocsave_htab_hash,
3505 tocsave_htab_eq,
3506 NULL);
3507 if (htab->tocsave_htab == NULL)
3508 {
3509 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3510 return NULL;
3511 }
3512 htab->elf.root.hash_table_free = ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free;
3513
3514 /* Initializing two fields of the union is just cosmetic. We really
3515 only care about glist, but when compiled on a 32-bit host the
3516 bfd_vma fields are larger. Setting the bfd_vma to zero makes
3517 debugger inspection of these fields look nicer. */
3518 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.refcount = 0;
3519 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.glist = NULL;
3520 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
3521 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
3522 htab->elf.init_got_offset.offset = 0;
3523 htab->elf.init_got_offset.glist = NULL;
3524 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
3525 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
3526
3527 return &htab->elf.root;
3528 }
3529
3530 /* Create sections for linker generated code. */
3531
3532 static bool
3533 create_linkage_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3534 {
3535 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3536 flagword flags;
3537
3538 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3539
3540 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY
3541 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3542 if (htab->params->save_restore_funcs)
3543 {
3544 /* Create .sfpr for code to save and restore fp regs. */
3545 htab->sfpr = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".sfpr",
3546 flags);
3547 if (htab->sfpr == NULL
3548 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->sfpr, 2))
3549 return false;
3550 }
3551
3552 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
3553 return true;
3554
3555 /* Create .glink for lazy dynamic linking support. */
3556 htab->glink = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3557 flags);
3558 if (htab->glink == NULL
3559 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 3))
3560 return false;
3561
3562 /* The part of .glink used by global entry stubs, separate so that
3563 it can be aligned appropriately without affecting htab->glink. */
3564 htab->global_entry = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3565 flags);
3566 if (htab->global_entry == NULL
3567 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->global_entry, 2))
3568 return false;
3569
3570 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
3571 {
3572 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3573 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3574 htab->glink_eh_frame = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj,
3575 ".eh_frame",
3576 flags);
3577 if (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
3578 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink_eh_frame, 2))
3579 return false;
3580 }
3581
3582 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
3583 htab->elf.iplt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".iplt", flags);
3584 if (htab->elf.iplt == NULL
3585 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.iplt, 3))
3586 return false;
3587
3588 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3589 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3590 htab->elf.irelplt
3591 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.iplt", flags);
3592 if (htab->elf.irelplt == NULL
3593 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.irelplt, 3))
3594 return false;
3595
3596 /* Create branch lookup table for plt_branch stubs. */
3597 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
3598 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3599 htab->brlt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3600 flags);
3601 if (htab->brlt == NULL
3602 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->brlt, 3))
3603 return false;
3604
3605 /* Local plt entries, put in .branch_lt but a separate section for
3606 convenience. */
3607 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3608 flags);
3609 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
3610 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 3))
3611 return false;
3612
3613 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
3614 return true;
3615
3616 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3617 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3618 htab->relbrlt
3619 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3620 if (htab->relbrlt == NULL
3621 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relbrlt, 3))
3622 return false;
3623
3624 htab->relpltlocal
3625 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3626 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
3627 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 3))
3628 return false;
3629
3630 return true;
3631 }
3632
3633 /* Satisfy the ELF linker by filling in some fields in our fake bfd. */
3634
3635 bool
3636 ppc64_elf_init_stub_bfd (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3637 struct ppc64_elf_params *params)
3638 {
3639 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3640
3641 elf_elfheader (params->stub_bfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = ELFCLASS64;
3642
3643 /* Always hook our dynamic sections into the first bfd, which is the
3644 linker created stub bfd. This ensures that the GOT header is at
3645 the start of the output TOC section. */
3646 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3647 htab->elf.dynobj = params->stub_bfd;
3648 htab->params = params;
3649
3650 return create_linkage_sections (htab->elf.dynobj, info);
3651 }
3652
3653 /* Build a name for an entry in the stub hash table. */
3654
3655 static char *
3656 ppc_stub_name (const asection *input_section,
3657 const asection *sym_sec,
3658 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3659 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
3660 {
3661 char *stub_name;
3662 ssize_t len;
3663
3664 /* rel->r_addend is actually 64 bit, but who uses more than +/- 2^31
3665 offsets from a sym as a branch target? In fact, we could
3666 probably assume the addend is always zero. */
3667 BFD_ASSERT (((int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff) == rel->r_addend);
3668
3669 if (h)
3670 {
3671 len = 8 + 1 + strlen (h->elf.root.root.string) + 1 + 8 + 1;
3672 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3673 if (stub_name == NULL)
3674 return stub_name;
3675
3676 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%s+%x",
3677 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3678 h->elf.root.root.string,
3679 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3680 }
3681 else
3682 {
3683 len = 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1;
3684 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3685 if (stub_name == NULL)
3686 return stub_name;
3687
3688 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%x:%x+%x",
3689 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3690 sym_sec->id & 0xffffffff,
3691 (int) ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info) & 0xffffffff,
3692 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3693 }
3694 if (len > 2 && stub_name[len - 2] == '+' && stub_name[len - 1] == '0')
3695 stub_name[len - 2] = 0;
3696 return stub_name;
3697 }
3698
3699 /* If mixing power10 with non-power10 code and --power10-stubs is not
3700 specified (or is auto) then calls using @notoc relocations that
3701 need a stub will utilize power10 instructions in the stub, and
3702 calls without @notoc relocations will not use power10 instructions.
3703 The two classes of stubs are stored in separate stub_hash_table
3704 entries having the same key string. The two entries will always be
3705 adjacent on entry->root.next chain, even if hash table resizing
3706 occurs. This function selects the correct entry to use. */
3707
3708 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3709 select_alt_stub (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *entry, bool notoc)
3710 {
3711 bool have_notoc;
3712
3713 have_notoc = (entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
3714 || entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
3715 || entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
3716
3717 if (have_notoc != notoc)
3718 {
3719 const char *stub_name = entry->root.string;
3720
3721 entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry->root.next;
3722 if (entry != NULL
3723 && entry->root.string != stub_name)
3724 entry = NULL;
3725 }
3726
3727 return entry;
3728 }
3729
3730 /* Look up an entry in the stub hash. Stub entries are cached because
3731 creating the stub name takes a bit of time. */
3732
3733 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3734 ppc_get_stub_entry (const asection *input_section,
3735 const asection *sym_sec,
3736 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3737 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
3738 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3739 {
3740 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3741 struct map_stub *group;
3742
3743 /* If this input section is part of a group of sections sharing one
3744 stub section, then use the id of the first section in the group.
3745 Stub names need to include a section id, as there may well be
3746 more than one stub used to reach say, printf, and we need to
3747 distinguish between them. */
3748 group = htab->sec_info[input_section->id].u.group;
3749 if (group == NULL)
3750 return NULL;
3751
3752 if (h != NULL && h->u.stub_cache != NULL
3753 && h->u.stub_cache->h == h
3754 && h->u.stub_cache->group == group)
3755 {
3756 stub_entry = h->u.stub_cache;
3757 }
3758 else
3759 {
3760 char *stub_name;
3761
3762 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (group->link_sec, sym_sec, h, rel);
3763 if (stub_name == NULL)
3764 return NULL;
3765
3766 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
3767 stub_name, false, false);
3768 if (h != NULL)
3769 h->u.stub_cache = stub_entry;
3770
3771 free (stub_name);
3772 }
3773
3774 if (stub_entry != NULL && htab->params->power10_stubs == -1)
3775 {
3776 bool notoc = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
3777
3778 stub_entry = select_alt_stub (stub_entry, notoc);
3779 }
3780
3781 return stub_entry;
3782 }
3783
3784 /* Add a new stub entry to the stub hash. Not all fields of the new
3785 stub entry are initialised. */
3786
3787 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3788 ppc_add_stub (const char *stub_name,
3789 asection *section,
3790 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3791 {
3792 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3793 struct map_stub *group;
3794 asection *link_sec;
3795 asection *stub_sec;
3796 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3797
3798 group = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group;
3799 link_sec = group->link_sec;
3800 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
3801 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3802 {
3803 size_t namelen;
3804 bfd_size_type len;
3805 char *s_name;
3806
3807 namelen = strlen (link_sec->name);
3808 len = namelen + sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX);
3809 s_name = bfd_alloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, len);
3810 if (s_name == NULL)
3811 return NULL;
3812
3813 memcpy (s_name, link_sec->name, namelen);
3814 memcpy (s_name + namelen, STUB_SUFFIX, sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX));
3815 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (s_name, link_sec);
3816 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3817 return NULL;
3818 group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
3819 }
3820
3821 /* Enter this entry into the linker stub hash table. */
3822 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
3823 true, false);
3824 if (stub_entry == NULL)
3825 {
3826 /* xgettext:c-format */
3827 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
3828 section->owner, stub_name);
3829 return NULL;
3830 }
3831
3832 stub_entry->group = group;
3833 stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
3834 return stub_entry;
3835 }
3836
3837 /* Create .got and .rela.got sections in ABFD, and .got in dynobj if
3838 not already done. */
3839
3840 static bool
3841 create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3842 {
3843 asection *got, *relgot;
3844 flagword flags;
3845 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3846
3847 if (!is_ppc64_elf (abfd))
3848 return false;
3849 if (htab == NULL)
3850 return false;
3851
3852 if (!htab->elf.sgot
3853 && !_bfd_elf_create_got_section (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3854 return false;
3855
3856 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3857 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3858
3859 got = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3860 if (!got
3861 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (got, 3))
3862 return false;
3863
3864 relgot = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.got",
3865 flags | SEC_READONLY);
3866 if (!relgot
3867 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (relgot, 3))
3868 return false;
3869
3870 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got = got;
3871 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->relgot = relgot;
3872 return true;
3873 }
3874
3875 /* Follow indirect and warning symbol links. */
3876
3877 static inline struct bfd_link_hash_entry *
3878 follow_link (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h)
3879 {
3880 while (h->type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3881 || h->type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3882 h = h->u.i.link;
3883 return h;
3884 }
3885
3886 static inline struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3887 elf_follow_link (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3888 {
3889 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->root);
3890 }
3891
3892 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3893 ppc_follow_link (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h)
3894 {
3895 return ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_follow_link (&h->elf));
3896 }
3897
3898 /* Merge PLT info on FROM with that on TO. */
3899
3900 static void
3901 move_plt_plist (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *from,
3902 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *to)
3903 {
3904 if (from->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3905 {
3906 if (to->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3907 {
3908 struct plt_entry **entp;
3909 struct plt_entry *ent;
3910
3911 for (entp = &from->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3912 {
3913 struct plt_entry *dent;
3914
3915 for (dent = to->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3916 if (dent->addend == ent->addend)
3917 {
3918 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
3919 *entp = ent->next;
3920 break;
3921 }
3922 if (dent == NULL)
3923 entp = &ent->next;
3924 }
3925 *entp = to->elf.plt.plist;
3926 }
3927
3928 to->elf.plt.plist = from->elf.plt.plist;
3929 from->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
3930 }
3931 }
3932
3933 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
3934
3935 static void
3936 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3937 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
3938 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
3939 {
3940 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
3941
3942 edir = ppc_elf_hash_entry (dir);
3943 eind = ppc_elf_hash_entry (ind);
3944
3945 edir->is_func |= eind->is_func;
3946 edir->is_func_descriptor |= eind->is_func_descriptor;
3947 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
3948 if (eind->oh != NULL)
3949 edir->oh = ppc_follow_link (eind->oh);
3950
3951 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
3952 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
3953 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
3954 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
3955 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
3956 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
3957 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
3958
3959 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, don't copy
3960 dyn_relocs, plt/got info, or dynindx. We used to copy dyn_relocs
3961 in order to simplify readonly_dynrelocs and save a field in the
3962 symbol hash entry, but that means dyn_relocs can't be used in any
3963 tests about a specific symbol, or affect other symbol flags which
3964 are then tested. */
3965 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3966 return;
3967
3968 /* Copy over any dynamic relocs we may have on the indirect sym. */
3969 if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3970 {
3971 if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3972 {
3973 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3974 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3975
3976 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
3977 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
3978 for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3979 {
3980 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
3981
3982 for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
3983 if (q->sec == p->sec)
3984 {
3985 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
3986 q->count += p->count;
3987 *pp = p->next;
3988 break;
3989 }
3990 if (q == NULL)
3991 pp = &p->next;
3992 }
3993 *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
3994 }
3995
3996 dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
3997 ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3998 }
3999
4000 /* Copy over got entries that we may have already seen to the
4001 symbol which just became indirect. */
4002 if (eind->elf.got.glist != NULL)
4003 {
4004 if (edir->elf.got.glist != NULL)
4005 {
4006 struct got_entry **entp;
4007 struct got_entry *ent;
4008
4009 for (entp = &eind->elf.got.glist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
4010 {
4011 struct got_entry *dent;
4012
4013 for (dent = edir->elf.got.glist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
4014 if (dent->addend == ent->addend
4015 && dent->owner == ent->owner
4016 && dent->tls_type == ent->tls_type)
4017 {
4018 dent->got.refcount += ent->got.refcount;
4019 *entp = ent->next;
4020 break;
4021 }
4022 if (dent == NULL)
4023 entp = &ent->next;
4024 }
4025 *entp = edir->elf.got.glist;
4026 }
4027
4028 edir->elf.got.glist = eind->elf.got.glist;
4029 eind->elf.got.glist = NULL;
4030 }
4031
4032 /* And plt entries. */
4033 move_plt_plist (eind, edir);
4034
4035 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
4036 {
4037 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
4038 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4039 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
4040 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
4041 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
4042 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
4043 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
4044 }
4045 }
4046
4047 /* Find the function descriptor hash entry from the given function code
4048 hash entry FH. Link the entries via their OH fields. */
4049
4050 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
4051 lookup_fdh (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
4052 {
4053 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = fh->oh;
4054
4055 if (fdh == NULL)
4056 {
4057 const char *fd_name = fh->elf.root.root.string + 1;
4058
4059 fdh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, fd_name,
4060 false, false, false));
4061 if (fdh == NULL)
4062 return fdh;
4063
4064 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4065 fdh->oh = fh;
4066 fh->is_func = 1;
4067 fh->oh = fdh;
4068 }
4069
4070 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
4071 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4072 fdh->oh = fh;
4073 return fdh;
4074 }
4075
4076 /* Make a fake function descriptor sym for the undefined code sym FH. */
4077
4078 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
4079 make_fdh (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4080 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
4081 {
4082 bfd *abfd = fh->elf.root.u.undef.abfd;
4083 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
4084 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4085 flagword flags = (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
4086 ? BSF_WEAK
4087 : BSF_GLOBAL);
4088
4089 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, abfd,
4090 fh->elf.root.root.string + 1,
4091 flags, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
4092 NULL, false, false, &bh))
4093 return NULL;
4094
4095 fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4096 fdh->elf.non_elf = 0;
4097 fdh->fake = 1;
4098 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4099 fdh->oh = fh;
4100 fh->is_func = 1;
4101 fh->oh = fdh;
4102 return fdh;
4103 }
4104
4105 /* Fix function descriptor symbols defined in .opd sections to be
4106 function type. */
4107
4108 static bool
4109 ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *ibfd,
4110 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4111 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4112 const char **name,
4113 flagword *flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4114 asection **sec,
4115 bfd_vma *value)
4116 {
4117 if (*sec != NULL
4118 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".opd") == 0)
4119 {
4120 asection *code_sec;
4121
4122 if (!(ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4123 || ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC))
4124 isym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (isym->st_info), STT_FUNC);
4125
4126 /* If the symbol is a function defined in .opd, and the function
4127 code is in a discarded group, let it appear to be undefined. */
4128 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4129 && (*sec)->reloc_count != 0
4130 && opd_entry_value (*sec, *value, &code_sec, NULL,
4131 false) != (bfd_vma) -1
4132 && discarded_section (code_sec))
4133 {
4134 *sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4135 isym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
4136 }
4137 }
4138 else if (*sec != NULL
4139 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".toc") == 0
4140 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_OBJECT)
4141 {
4142 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4143 if (htab != NULL)
4144 htab->params->object_in_toc = 1;
4145 }
4146
4147 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4148 {
4149 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4150 set_abiversion (ibfd, 2);
4151 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 1)
4152 {
4153 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol '%s' has invalid st_other"
4154 " for ABI version 1"), *name);
4155 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4156 return false;
4157 }
4158 }
4159
4160 return true;
4161 }
4162
4163 /* Merge non-visibility st_other attributes: local entry point. */
4164
4165 static void
4166 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4167 unsigned int st_other,
4168 bool definition,
4169 bool dynamic)
4170 {
4171 if (definition && (!dynamic || !h->def_regular))
4172 h->other = ((st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1))
4173 | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other));
4174 }
4175
4176 /* Hook called on merging a symbol. We use this to clear "fake" since
4177 we now have a real symbol. */
4178
4179 static bool
4180 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4181 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4182 asection **psec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4183 bool newdef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4184 bool olddef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4185 bfd *oldbfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4186 const asection *oldsec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4187 {
4188 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->fake = 0;
4189 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4190 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->non_zero_localentry = 1;
4191 return true;
4192 }
4193
4194 /* This function makes an old ABI object reference to ".bar" cause the
4195 inclusion of a new ABI object archive that defines "bar".
4196 NAME is a symbol defined in an archive. Return a symbol in the hash
4197 table that might be satisfied by the archive symbols. */
4198
4199 static struct bfd_link_hash_entry *
4200 ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (bfd *abfd,
4201 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4202 const char *name)
4203 {
4204 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4205 char *dot_name;
4206 size_t len;
4207
4208 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, name);
4209 if (h != NULL
4210 && ppc_hash_table (info) != NULL
4211 /* Don't return this sym if it is a fake function descriptor
4212 created by add_symbol_adjust. */
4213 && !((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->fake)
4214 return h;
4215
4216 if (name[0] == '.')
4217 return h;
4218
4219 len = strlen (name);
4220 dot_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
4221 if (dot_name == NULL)
4222 return (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) -1;
4223 dot_name[0] = '.';
4224 memcpy (dot_name + 1, name, len + 1);
4225 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, dot_name);
4226 bfd_release (abfd, dot_name);
4227 if (h != NULL)
4228 return h;
4229
4230 if (strcmp (name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
4231 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, "__tls_get_addr_desc");
4232 return h;
4233 }
4234
4235 /* This function satisfies all old ABI object references to ".bar" if a
4236 new ABI object defines "bar". Well, at least, undefined dot symbols
4237 are made weak. This stops later archive searches from including an
4238 object if we already have a function descriptor definition. It also
4239 prevents the linker complaining about undefined symbols.
4240 We also check and correct mismatched symbol visibility here. The
4241 most restrictive visibility of the function descriptor and the
4242 function entry symbol is used. */
4243
4244 static bool
4245 add_symbol_adjust (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4246 {
4247 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4248 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4249
4250 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4251 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.root.u.i.link;
4252
4253 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
4254 return true;
4255
4256 if (eh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.')
4257 abort ();
4258
4259 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4260 if (htab == NULL)
4261 return false;
4262
4263 fdh = lookup_fdh (eh, htab);
4264 if (fdh == NULL
4265 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4266 && (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
4267 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4268 && eh->elf.ref_regular)
4269 {
4270 /* Make an undefined function descriptor sym, in order to
4271 pull in an --as-needed shared lib. Archives are handled
4272 elsewhere. */
4273 fdh = make_fdh (info, eh);
4274 if (fdh == NULL)
4275 return false;
4276 }
4277
4278 if (fdh != NULL)
4279 {
4280 unsigned entry_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) - 1;
4281 unsigned descr_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (fdh->elf.other) - 1;
4282
4283 /* Make both descriptor and entry symbol have the most
4284 constraining visibility of either symbol. */
4285 if (entry_vis < descr_vis)
4286 fdh->elf.other += entry_vis - descr_vis;
4287 else if (entry_vis > descr_vis)
4288 eh->elf.other += descr_vis - entry_vis;
4289
4290 /* Propagate reference flags from entry symbol to function
4291 descriptor symbol. */
4292 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular;
4293 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic;
4294 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= eh->elf.ref_regular;
4295 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
4296
4297 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
4298 && fdh->elf.dynindx == -1
4299 && fdh->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden
4300 && (bfd_link_dll (info)
4301 || fdh->elf.def_dynamic
4302 || fdh->elf.ref_dynamic)
4303 && (eh->elf.ref_regular
4304 || eh->elf.def_regular))
4305 {
4306 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
4307 return false;
4308 }
4309 }
4310
4311 return true;
4312 }
4313
4314 /* Set up opd section info and abiversion for IBFD, and process list
4315 of dot-symbols we made in link_hash_newfunc. */
4316
4317 static bool
4318 ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4319 {
4320 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4321 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **p, *eh;
4322 asection *opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
4323
4324 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0)
4325 {
4326 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type == sec_normal);
4327 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type = sec_opd;
4328
4329 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4330 set_abiversion (ibfd, 1);
4331 else if (abiversion (ibfd) >= 2)
4332 {
4333 /* xgettext:c-format */
4334 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB .opd not allowed in ABI version %d"),
4335 ibfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4336 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4337 return false;
4338 }
4339 }
4340
4341 if (is_ppc64_elf (info->output_bfd))
4342 {
4343 /* For input files without an explicit abiversion in e_flags
4344 we should have flagged any with symbol st_other bits set
4345 as ELFv1 and above flagged those with .opd as ELFv2.
4346 Set the output abiversion if not yet set, and for any input
4347 still ambiguous, take its abiversion from the output.
4348 Differences in ABI are reported later. */
4349 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 0)
4350 set_abiversion (info->output_bfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4351 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4352 set_abiversion (ibfd, abiversion (info->output_bfd));
4353 }
4354
4355 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4356 if (htab == NULL)
4357 return true;
4358
4359 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0
4360 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0
4361 && (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0
4362 && opd->reloc_count != 0
4363 && !bfd_is_abs_section (opd->output_section)
4364 && info->gc_sections)
4365 {
4366 /* Garbage collection needs some extra help with .opd sections.
4367 We don't want to necessarily keep everything referenced by
4368 relocs in .opd, as that would keep all functions. Instead,
4369 if we reference an .opd symbol (a function descriptor), we
4370 want to keep the function code symbol's section. This is
4371 easy for global symbols, but for local syms we need to keep
4372 information about the associated function section. */
4373 bfd_size_type amt;
4374 asection **opd_sym_map;
4375 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4376 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, *rel_end, *rel;
4377
4378 amt = OPD_NDX (opd->size) * sizeof (*opd_sym_map);
4379 opd_sym_map = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, amt);
4380 if (opd_sym_map == NULL)
4381 return false;
4382 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->u.opd.func_sec = opd_sym_map;
4383 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, opd, NULL, NULL,
4384 info->keep_memory);
4385 if (relocs == NULL)
4386 return false;
4387 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4388 rel_end = relocs + opd->reloc_count - 1;
4389 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4390 {
4391 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4392 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4393
4394 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
4395 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC
4396 && r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4397 {
4398 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4399 asection *s;
4400
4401 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, ibfd,
4402 r_symndx);
4403 if (isym == NULL)
4404 {
4405 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4406 free (relocs);
4407 return false;
4408 }
4409
4410 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, isym->st_shndx);
4411 if (s != NULL && s != opd)
4412 opd_sym_map[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = s;
4413 }
4414 }
4415 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4416 free (relocs);
4417 }
4418
4419 p = &htab->dot_syms;
4420 while ((eh = *p) != NULL)
4421 {
4422 *p = NULL;
4423 if (&eh->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
4424 ;
4425 else if (htab->elf.hgot == NULL
4426 && strcmp (eh->elf.root.root.string, ".TOC.") == 0)
4427 htab->elf.hgot = &eh->elf;
4428 else if (abiversion (ibfd) <= 1)
4429 {
4430 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 1;
4431 if (!add_symbol_adjust (eh, info))
4432 return false;
4433 }
4434 p = &eh->u.next_dot_sym;
4435 }
4436 return true;
4437 }
4438
4439 /* Undo hash table changes when an --as-needed input file is determined
4440 not to be needed. */
4441
4442 static bool
4443 ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed (bfd *ibfd,
4444 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4445 enum notice_asneeded_action act)
4446 {
4447 if (act == notice_not_needed)
4448 {
4449 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4450
4451 if (htab == NULL)
4452 return false;
4453
4454 htab->dot_syms = NULL;
4455 }
4456 return _bfd_elf_notice_as_needed (ibfd, info, act);
4457 }
4458
4459 /* If --just-symbols against a final linked binary, then assume we need
4460 toc adjusting stubs when calling functions defined there. */
4461
4462 static void
4463 ppc64_elf_link_just_syms (asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4464 {
4465 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
4466 && (sec->owner->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0
4467 && is_ppc64_elf (sec->owner))
4468 {
4469 if (abiversion (sec->owner) >= 2
4470 || bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".opd") != NULL)
4471 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4472 }
4473 _bfd_elf_link_just_syms (sec, info);
4474 }
4475
4476 static struct plt_entry **
4477 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
4478 unsigned long r_symndx, bfd_vma r_addend, int tls_type)
4479 {
4480 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (abfd);
4481 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4482 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
4483
4484 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4485 {
4486 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4487
4488 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_ents)
4489 + sizeof (*local_plt)
4490 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
4491 local_got_ents = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
4492 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4493 return NULL;
4494 elf_local_got_ents (abfd) = local_got_ents;
4495 }
4496
4497 if ((tls_type & (NON_GOT | TLS_EXPLICIT)) == 0)
4498 {
4499 struct got_entry *ent;
4500
4501 for (ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4502 if (ent->addend == r_addend
4503 && ent->owner == abfd
4504 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4505 break;
4506 if (ent == NULL)
4507 {
4508 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
4509 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4510 if (ent == NULL)
4511 return false;
4512 ent->next = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
4513 ent->addend = r_addend;
4514 ent->owner = abfd;
4515 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4516 ent->is_indirect = false;
4517 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4518 local_got_ents[r_symndx] = ent;
4519 }
4520 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4521 }
4522
4523 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4524 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4525 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
4526
4527 return local_plt + r_symndx;
4528 }
4529
4530 static bool
4531 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist, bfd_vma addend)
4532 {
4533 struct plt_entry *ent;
4534
4535 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4536 if (ent->addend == addend)
4537 break;
4538 if (ent == NULL)
4539 {
4540 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
4541 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4542 if (ent == NULL)
4543 return false;
4544 ent->next = *plist;
4545 ent->addend = addend;
4546 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
4547 *plist = ent;
4548 }
4549 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
4550 return true;
4551 }
4552
4553 static bool
4554 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4555 {
4556 return (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
4557 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
4558 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
4559 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
4560 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
4561 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR24
4562 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14
4563 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
4564 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
4565 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
4566 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC);
4567 }
4568
4569 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
4570
4571 static bool
4572 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4573 {
4574 return (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
4575 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
4576 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
4577 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS
4578 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
4579 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC
4580 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ
4581 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC);
4582 }
4583
4584 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
4585 calculate needed space in the global offset table, procedure
4586 linkage table, and dynamic reloc sections. */
4587
4588 static bool
4589 ppc64_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4590 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
4591 {
4592 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4593 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4594 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4595 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
4596 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
4597 asection *sreloc;
4598 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *dottga;
4599 bool is_opd;
4600
4601 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
4602 return true;
4603
4604 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (abfd));
4605
4606 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4607 if (htab == NULL)
4608 return false;
4609
4610 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4611 false, false, true);
4612 dottga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
4613 false, false, true);
4614 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4615 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
4616 sreloc = NULL;
4617 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd;
4618 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
4619 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4620 {
4621 unsigned long r_symndx;
4622 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4623 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
4624 int tls_type;
4625 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *ppc64_sec;
4626 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
4627
4628 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4629 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4630 h = NULL;
4631 else
4632 {
4633 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4634 h = elf_follow_link (h);
4635
4636 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
4637 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4638 }
4639
4640 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4641 switch (r_type)
4642 {
4643 case R_PPC64_D34:
4644 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
4645 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
4646 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
4647 case R_PPC64_D28:
4648 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
4649 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
4650 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
4651 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4652 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
4653 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
4654 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
4655 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
4656 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4657 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4658 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
4659 htab->has_power10_relocs = 1;
4660 break;
4661 default:
4662 break;
4663 }
4664
4665 switch (r_type)
4666 {
4667 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4668 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4669 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4670 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4671 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4672 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4673 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4674 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4675 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4676 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4677 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4678 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4679 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4680 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4681 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4682 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4683 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4684 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4685 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_optrel = 1;
4686 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel = 1;
4687 break;
4688 default:
4689 break;
4690 }
4691
4692 ifunc = NULL;
4693 if (h != NULL)
4694 {
4695 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4696 {
4697 h->needs_plt = 1;
4698 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
4699 }
4700 }
4701 else
4702 {
4703 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
4704 abfd, r_symndx);
4705 if (isym == NULL)
4706 return false;
4707
4708 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4709 {
4710 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4711 rel->r_addend,
4712 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
4713 if (ifunc == NULL)
4714 return false;
4715 }
4716 }
4717
4718 tls_type = 0;
4719 switch (r_type)
4720 {
4721 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
4722 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
4723 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
4724 its parameter symbol. */
4725 if (h != NULL)
4726 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
4727 else
4728 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4729 rel->r_addend,
4730 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4731 return false;
4732 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4733 break;
4734
4735 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
4736 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4737 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4738 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4739 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
4740 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4741 goto dogottls;
4742
4743 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
4744 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4745 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4746 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4747 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
4748 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4749 goto dogottls;
4750
4751 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
4752 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4753 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4754 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4755 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
4756 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4757 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4758 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4759 goto dogottls;
4760
4761 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
4762 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4763 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
4764 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4765 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
4766 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4767 dogottls:
4768 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4769 goto dogot;
4770
4771 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
4772 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4773 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
4774 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4775 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
4776 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4777 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4778 dogot:
4779 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
4780 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4781 if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16
4782 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16
4783 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS
4784 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS
4785 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16
4786 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_DS)
4787 {
4788 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4789 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4790 }
4791
4792 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got == NULL
4793 && !create_got_section (abfd, info))
4794 return false;
4795
4796 if (h != NULL)
4797 {
4798 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4799 struct got_entry *ent;
4800
4801 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4802 for (ent = eh->elf.got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4803 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
4804 && ent->owner == abfd
4805 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4806 break;
4807 if (ent == NULL)
4808 {
4809 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
4810 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4811 if (ent == NULL)
4812 return false;
4813 ent->next = eh->elf.got.glist;
4814 ent->addend = rel->r_addend;
4815 ent->owner = abfd;
4816 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4817 ent->is_indirect = false;
4818 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4819 eh->elf.got.glist = ent;
4820 }
4821 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4822 eh->tls_mask |= tls_type;
4823 }
4824 else
4825 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
4826 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4827 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4828 return false;
4829 break;
4830
4831 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4832 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
4833 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4834 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4835 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4836 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4837 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
4838 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
4839 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
4840 plt_list = ifunc;
4841 if (h != NULL)
4842 {
4843 h->needs_plt = 1;
4844 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4845 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4846 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
4847 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
4848 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4849 }
4850 if (plt_list == NULL)
4851 plt_list = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4852 rel->r_addend,
4853 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
4854 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4855 return false;
4856 break;
4857
4858 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
4859 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
4860 section relative. */
4861 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
4862 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
4863 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
4864 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
4865 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
4866 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
4867 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
4868 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
4869 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
4870 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
4871 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
4872 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4873 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
4874 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
4875 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
4876 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
4877 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
4878 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
4879 break;
4880
4881 /* Nor do these. */
4882 case R_PPC64_REL16:
4883 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
4884 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
4885 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
4886 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
4887 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
4888 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
4889 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
4890 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
4891 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
4892 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
4893 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
4894 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
4895 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
4896 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
4897 break;
4898
4899 /* Not supported as a dynamic relocation. */
4900 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
4901 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4902 {
4903 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
4904 ppc_howto_init ();
4905 /* xgettext:c-format */
4906 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%H: %s reloc unsupported "
4907 "in shared libraries and PIEs\n"),
4908 abfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
4909 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
4910 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4911 return false;
4912 }
4913 break;
4914
4915 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
4916 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
4917 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4918 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4919 /* Fall through. */
4920 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4921 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
4922 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4923 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4924 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4925 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
4926 {
4927 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
4928 h->non_got_ref = 1;
4929 /* Strongly prefer a copy reloc over a dynamic reloc.
4930 glibc ld.so as of 2019-08 will error out if one of
4931 these relocations is emitted. */
4932 h->needs_copy = 1;
4933 goto dodyn;
4934 }
4935 break;
4936
4937 /* Marker reloc. */
4938 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
4939 break;
4940
4941 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
4942 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
4943 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4944 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
4945 return false;
4946 break;
4947
4948 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
4949 used. Record for later use during GC. */
4950 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
4951 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
4952 return false;
4953 break;
4954
4955 case R_PPC64_REL14:
4956 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
4957 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
4958 {
4959 asection *dest = NULL;
4960
4961 /* Heuristic: If jumping outside our section, chances are
4962 we are going to need a stub. */
4963 if (h != NULL)
4964 {
4965 /* If the sym is weak it may be overridden later, so
4966 don't assume we know where a weak sym lives. */
4967 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
4968 dest = h->root.u.def.section;
4969 }
4970 else
4971 {
4972 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4973
4974 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
4975 abfd, r_symndx);
4976 if (isym == NULL)
4977 return false;
4978
4979 dest = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4980 }
4981
4982 if (dest != sec)
4983 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_14bit_branch = 1;
4984 }
4985 goto rel24;
4986
4987 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
4988 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
4989 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall = 1;
4990 /* Fall through. */
4991
4992 case R_PPC64_REL24:
4993 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
4994 rel24:
4995 plt_list = ifunc;
4996 if (h != NULL)
4997 {
4998 h->needs_plt = 1;
4999 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
5000 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
5001 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
5002
5003 if (h == tga || h == dottga)
5004 {
5005 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
5006 if (rel != relocs
5007 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSGD
5008 || ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
5009 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with
5010 a marker reloc. */
5011 ;
5012 else
5013 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
5014 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
5015 }
5016 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
5017 }
5018
5019 /* We may need a .plt entry if the function this reloc
5020 refers to is in a shared lib. */
5021 if (plt_list
5022 && !update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
5023 return false;
5024 break;
5025
5026 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
5027 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
5028 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
5029 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
5030 goto dodyn;
5031
5032 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
5033 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
5034 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5035 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
5036 goto dotlstoc;
5037
5038 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
5039 if (rel + 1 < rel_end
5040 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
5041 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
5042 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
5043 else
5044 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
5045 goto dotlstoc;
5046
5047 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
5048 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
5049 if (rel != relocs
5050 && rel[-1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64)
5051 && rel[-1].r_offset == rel->r_offset - 8)
5052 /* This is the second reloc of a dtpmod, dtprel pair.
5053 Don't mark with TLS_DTPREL. */
5054 goto dodyn;
5055
5056 dotlstoc:
5057 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
5058 if (h != NULL)
5059 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type & 0xff;
5060 else
5061 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
5062 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
5063 return false;
5064
5065 ppc64_sec = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec);
5066 if (ppc64_sec->sec_type != sec_toc)
5067 {
5068 bfd_size_type amt;
5069
5070 /* One extra to simplify get_tls_mask. */
5071 amt = sec->size * sizeof (unsigned) / 8 + sizeof (unsigned);
5072 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5073 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx == NULL)
5074 return false;
5075 amt = sec->size * sizeof (bfd_vma) / 8;
5076 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5077 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.add == NULL)
5078 return false;
5079 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_sec->sec_type == sec_normal);
5080 ppc64_sec->sec_type = sec_toc;
5081 }
5082 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset % 8 == 0);
5083 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8] = r_symndx;
5084 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add[rel->r_offset / 8] = rel->r_addend;
5085
5086 /* Mark the second slot of a GD or LD entry.
5087 -1 to indicate GD and -2 to indicate LD. */
5088 if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
5089 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -1;
5090 else if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5091 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -2;
5092 goto dodyn;
5093
5094 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
5095 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
5096 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
5097 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
5098 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
5099 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
5100 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
5101 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
5102 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
5103 /* Fall through. */
5104 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
5105 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
5106 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
5107 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
5108 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
5109 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5110 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
5111 goto dodyn;
5112
5113 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
5114 if (is_opd
5115 && rel + 1 < rel_end
5116 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5117 {
5118 if (h != NULL)
5119 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
5120 }
5121 /* Fall through. */
5122
5123 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
5124 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
5125 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
5126 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
5127 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
5128 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
5129 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
5130 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
5131 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
5132 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
5133 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
5134 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
5135 case R_PPC64_D34:
5136 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
5137 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
5138 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
5139 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
5140 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
5141 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
5142 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
5143 case R_PPC64_D28:
5144 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1
5145 && rel->r_addend == 0)
5146 {
5147 /* We may need a .plt entry if this reloc refers to a
5148 function in a shared lib. */
5149 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, 0))
5150 return false;
5151 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
5152 }
5153 /* Fall through. */
5154
5155 case R_PPC64_REL30:
5156 case R_PPC64_REL32:
5157 case R_PPC64_REL64:
5158 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
5159 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
5160 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
5161 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
5162 case R_PPC64_TOC:
5163 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
5164 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
5165 h->non_got_ref = 1;
5166
5167 /* Don't propagate .opd relocs. */
5168 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
5169 break;
5170
5171 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
5172 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
5173 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
5174 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
5175 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
5176 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
5177 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
5178 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
5179 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
5180 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
5181 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
5182 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
5183 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
5184 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
5185 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
5186 symbol local.
5187
5188 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
5189 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
5190 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
5191 symbol. */
5192 dodyn:
5193 if ((h != NULL
5194 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
5195 || !h->def_regular))
5196 || (h != NULL
5197 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
5198 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
5199 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
5200 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5201 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5202 && ifunc != NULL))
5203 {
5204 /* We must copy these reloc types into the output file.
5205 Create a reloc section in dynobj and make room for
5206 this reloc. */
5207 if (sreloc == NULL)
5208 {
5209 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
5210 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 3, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
5211
5212 if (sreloc == NULL)
5213 return false;
5214 }
5215
5216 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
5217 relocations we need for this symbol. */
5218 if (h != NULL)
5219 {
5220 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5221 struct elf_dyn_relocs **head;
5222
5223 head = &h->dyn_relocs;
5224 p = *head;
5225 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
5226 {
5227 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5228 if (p == NULL)
5229 return false;
5230 p->next = *head;
5231 *head = p;
5232 p->sec = sec;
5233 p->count = 0;
5234 p->pc_count = 0;
5235 }
5236 p->count += 1;
5237 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5238 p->pc_count += 1;
5239 }
5240 else
5241 {
5242 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
5243 We really need local syms available to do this
5244 easily. Oh well. */
5245 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5246 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **head;
5247 bool is_ifunc;
5248 asection *s;
5249 void *vpp;
5250 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5251
5252 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
5253 abfd, r_symndx);
5254 if (isym == NULL)
5255 return false;
5256
5257 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
5258 if (s == NULL)
5259 s = sec;
5260
5261 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
5262 head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
5263 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
5264 p = *head;
5265 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5266 p = p->next;
5267 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5268 {
5269 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5270 if (p == NULL)
5271 return false;
5272 p->next = *head;
5273 *head = p;
5274 p->sec = sec;
5275 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
5276 p->count = 0;
5277 }
5278 p->count += 1;
5279 }
5280 }
5281 break;
5282
5283 default:
5284 break;
5285 }
5286 }
5287
5288 return true;
5289 }
5290
5291 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
5292 object file when linking. */
5293
5294 static bool
5295 ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5296 {
5297 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
5298 unsigned long iflags, oflags;
5299
5300 if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
5301 return true;
5302
5303 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc64_elf (obfd))
5304 return true;
5305
5306 if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
5307 return false;
5308
5309 iflags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
5310 oflags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
5311
5312 if (iflags & ~EF_PPC64_ABI)
5313 {
5314 _bfd_error_handler
5315 /* xgettext:c-format */
5316 (_("%pB uses unknown e_flags 0x%lx"), ibfd, iflags);
5317 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5318 return false;
5319 }
5320 else if (iflags != oflags && iflags != 0)
5321 {
5322 _bfd_error_handler
5323 /* xgettext:c-format */
5324 (_("%pB: ABI version %ld is not compatible with ABI version %ld output"),
5325 ibfd, iflags, oflags);
5326 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5327 return false;
5328 }
5329
5330 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
5331 return false;
5332
5333 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
5334 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
5335 }
5336
5337 static bool
5338 ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
5339 {
5340 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
5341 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
5342
5343 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags != 0)
5344 {
5345 FILE *file = ptr;
5346
5347 fprintf (file, _("private flags = 0x%lx:"),
5348 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
5349
5350 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI) != 0)
5351 fprintf (file, _(" [abiv%ld]"),
5352 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI);
5353 fputc ('\n', file);
5354 }
5355
5356 return true;
5357 }
5358
5359 /* OFFSET in OPD_SEC specifies a function descriptor. Return the address
5360 of the code entry point, and its section, which must be in the same
5361 object as OPD_SEC. Returns (bfd_vma) -1 on error. */
5362
5363 static bfd_vma
5364 opd_entry_value (asection *opd_sec,
5365 bfd_vma offset,
5366 asection **code_sec,
5367 bfd_vma *code_off,
5368 bool in_code_sec)
5369 {
5370 bfd *opd_bfd = opd_sec->owner;
5371 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
5372 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi, *look;
5373 bfd_vma val;
5374
5375 /* No relocs implies we are linking a --just-symbols object, or looking
5376 at a final linked executable with addr2line or somesuch. */
5377 if (opd_sec->reloc_count == 0)
5378 {
5379 bfd_byte *contents = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents;
5380
5381 if (contents == NULL)
5382 {
5383 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (opd_bfd, opd_sec, &contents))
5384 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5385 ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents = contents;
5386 }
5387
5388 /* PR 17512: file: 64b9dfbb. */
5389 if (offset + 7 >= opd_sec->size || offset + 7 < offset)
5390 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5391
5392 val = bfd_get_64 (opd_bfd, contents + offset);
5393 if (code_sec != NULL)
5394 {
5395 asection *sec, *likely = NULL;
5396
5397 if (in_code_sec)
5398 {
5399 sec = *code_sec;
5400 if (sec->vma <= val
5401 && val < sec->vma + sec->size)
5402 likely = sec;
5403 else
5404 val = -1;
5405 }
5406 else
5407 for (sec = opd_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
5408 if (sec->vma <= val
5409 && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5410 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5411 likely = sec;
5412 if (likely != NULL)
5413 {
5414 *code_sec = likely;
5415 if (code_off != NULL)
5416 *code_off = val - likely->vma;
5417 }
5418 }
5419 return val;
5420 }
5421
5422 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (opd_bfd));
5423
5424 relocs = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.relocs;
5425 if (relocs == NULL)
5426 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (opd_bfd, opd_sec, NULL, NULL, true);
5427 /* PR 17512: file: df8e1fd6. */
5428 if (relocs == NULL)
5429 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5430
5431 /* Go find the opd reloc at the sym address. */
5432 lo = relocs;
5433 hi = lo + opd_sec->reloc_count - 1; /* ignore last reloc */
5434 val = (bfd_vma) -1;
5435 while (lo < hi)
5436 {
5437 look = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
5438 if (look->r_offset < offset)
5439 lo = look + 1;
5440 else if (look->r_offset > offset)
5441 hi = look;
5442 else
5443 {
5444 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (opd_bfd);
5445
5446 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (look->r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
5447 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((look + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5448 {
5449 unsigned long symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (look->r_info);
5450 asection *sec = NULL;
5451
5452 if (symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info
5453 && elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd) != NULL)
5454 {
5455 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5456 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rh;
5457
5458 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd);
5459 rh = sym_hashes[symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
5460 if (rh != NULL)
5461 {
5462 rh = elf_follow_link (rh);
5463 if (rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5464 && rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5465 break;
5466 if (rh->root.u.def.section->owner == opd_bfd)
5467 {
5468 val = rh->root.u.def.value;
5469 sec = rh->root.u.def.section;
5470 }
5471 }
5472 }
5473
5474 if (sec == NULL)
5475 {
5476 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5477
5478 if (symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
5479 {
5480 sym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5481 if (sym == NULL)
5482 {
5483 size_t symcnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5484 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5485 symcnt, 0,
5486 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5487 if (sym == NULL)
5488 break;
5489 symtab_hdr->contents = (bfd_byte *) sym;
5490 }
5491 sym += symndx;
5492 }
5493 else
5494 {
5495 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5496 1, symndx,
5497 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5498 if (sym == NULL)
5499 break;
5500 }
5501 sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (opd_bfd, sym->st_shndx);
5502 if (sec == NULL)
5503 break;
5504 BFD_ASSERT ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) == 0);
5505 val = sym->st_value;
5506 }
5507
5508 val += look->r_addend;
5509 if (code_off != NULL)
5510 *code_off = val;
5511 if (code_sec != NULL)
5512 {
5513 if (in_code_sec && *code_sec != sec)
5514 return -1;
5515 else
5516 *code_sec = sec;
5517 }
5518 if (sec->output_section != NULL)
5519 val += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5520 }
5521 break;
5522 }
5523 }
5524
5525 return val;
5526 }
5527
5528 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
5529 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
5530 otherwise return zero. */
5531
5532 static bfd_size_type
5533 ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
5534 bfd_vma *code_off)
5535 {
5536 bfd_size_type size;
5537 elf_symbol_type * elf_sym = (elf_symbol_type *) sym;
5538
5539 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
5540 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0)
5541 return 0;
5542
5543 size = (sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC) ? 0 : elf_sym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5544
5545 /* In theory we should check that the symbol's type satisfies
5546 _bfd_elf_is_function_type(), but there are some function-like
5547 symbols which would fail this test. (eg _start). Instead
5548 we check for hidden, local, notype symbols with zero size.
5549 This type of symbol is generated by the annobin plugin for gcc
5550 and clang, and should not be considered to be a function symbol. */
5551 if (size == 0
5552 && ((sym->flags & (BSF_SYNTHETIC | BSF_LOCAL)) == BSF_LOCAL)
5553 && ELF_ST_TYPE (elf_sym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_NOTYPE
5554 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (elf_sym->internal_elf_sym.st_other) == STV_HIDDEN)
5555 return 0;
5556
5557 if (strcmp (sym->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
5558 {
5559 struct _opd_sec_data *opd = get_opd_info (sym->section);
5560 bfd_vma symval = sym->value;
5561
5562 if (opd != NULL
5563 && opd->adjust != NULL
5564 && elf_section_data (sym->section)->relocs != NULL)
5565 {
5566 /* opd_entry_value will use cached relocs that have been
5567 adjusted, but with raw symbols. That means both local
5568 and global symbols need adjusting. */
5569 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (symval)];
5570 if (adjust == -1)
5571 return 0;
5572 symval += adjust;
5573 }
5574
5575 if (opd_entry_value (sym->section, symval,
5576 &sec, code_off, true) == (bfd_vma) -1)
5577 return 0;
5578 /* An old ABI binary with dot-syms has a size of 24 on the .opd
5579 symbol. This size has nothing to do with the code size of the
5580 function, which is what we're supposed to return, but the
5581 code size isn't available without looking up the dot-sym.
5582 However, doing that would be a waste of time particularly
5583 since elf_find_function will look at the dot-sym anyway.
5584 Now, elf_find_function will keep the largest size of any
5585 function sym found at the code address of interest, so return
5586 1 here to avoid it incorrectly caching a larger function size
5587 for a small function. This does mean we return the wrong
5588 size for a new-ABI function of size 24, but all that does is
5589 disable caching for such functions. */
5590 if (size == 24)
5591 size = 1;
5592 }
5593 else
5594 {
5595 if (sym->section != sec)
5596 return 0;
5597 *code_off = sym->value;
5598 }
5599
5600 /* Do not return 0 for the function's size. */
5601 return size ? size : 1;
5602 }
5603
5604 /* Return true if symbol is a strong function defined in an ELFv2
5605 object with st_other localentry bits of zero, ie. its local entry
5606 point coincides with its global entry point. */
5607
5608 static bool
5609 is_elfv2_localentry0 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5610 {
5611 return (h != NULL
5612 && h->type == STT_FUNC
5613 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5614 && (STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & h->other) == 0
5615 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->non_zero_localentry
5616 && is_ppc64_elf (h->root.u.def.section->owner)
5617 && abiversion (h->root.u.def.section->owner) >= 2);
5618 }
5619
5620 /* Return true if symbol is defined in a regular object file. */
5621
5622 static bool
5623 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5624 {
5625 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5626 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5627 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
5628 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
5629 }
5630
5631 /* If FDH is a function descriptor symbol, return the associated code
5632 entry symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5633
5634 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5635 defined_code_entry (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh)
5636 {
5637 if (fdh->is_func_descriptor)
5638 {
5639 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (fdh->oh);
5640 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5641 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5642 return fh;
5643 }
5644 return NULL;
5645 }
5646
5647 /* If FH is a function code entry symbol, return the associated
5648 function descriptor symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5649
5650 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5651 defined_func_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
5652 {
5653 if (fh->oh != NULL
5654 && fh->oh->is_func_descriptor)
5655 {
5656 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = ppc_follow_link (fh->oh);
5657 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5658 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5659 return fdh;
5660 }
5661 return NULL;
5662 }
5663
5664 /* Given H is a symbol that satisfies is_static_defined, return the
5665 value in the output file. */
5666
5667 static bfd_vma
5668 defined_sym_val (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5669 {
5670 return (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
5671 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
5672 + h->root.u.def.value);
5673 }
5674
5675 /* Return true if H matches __tls_get_addr or one of its variants. */
5676
5677 static bool
5678 is_tls_get_addr (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5679 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
5680 {
5681 return (h == elf_hash_entry (htab->tls_get_addr_fd)
5682 || h == elf_hash_entry (htab->tga_desc_fd)
5683 || h == elf_hash_entry (htab->tls_get_addr)
5684 || h == elf_hash_entry (htab->tga_desc));
5685 }
5686
5687 static bool func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
5688
5689 /* Garbage collect sections, after first dealing with dot-symbols. */
5690
5691 static bool
5692 ppc64_elf_gc_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5693 {
5694 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5695
5696 if (htab != NULL && htab->need_func_desc_adj)
5697 {
5698 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
5699 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
5700 }
5701 return bfd_elf_gc_sections (abfd, info);
5702 }
5703
5704 /* Mark all our entry sym sections, both opd and code section. */
5705
5706 static void
5707 ppc64_elf_gc_keep (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5708 {
5709 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5710 struct bfd_sym_chain *sym;
5711
5712 if (htab == NULL)
5713 return;
5714
5715 for (sym = info->gc_sym_list; sym != NULL; sym = sym->next)
5716 {
5717 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh;
5718 asection *sec;
5719
5720 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym->name,
5721 false, false, true));
5722 if (eh == NULL)
5723 continue;
5724 if (eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5725 && eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5726 continue;
5727
5728 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5729 if (fh != NULL)
5730 {
5731 sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5732 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5733 }
5734 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5735 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5736 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5737 &sec, NULL, false) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5738 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5739
5740 sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5741 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5742 }
5743 }
5744
5745 /* Mark sections containing dynamically referenced symbols. When
5746 building shared libraries, we must assume that any visible symbol is
5747 referenced. */
5748
5749 static bool
5750 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5751 {
5752 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
5753 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
5754 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
5755 struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list *d = info->dynamic_list;
5756
5757 /* Dynamic linking info is on the func descriptor sym. */
5758 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5759 if (fdh != NULL)
5760 eh = fdh;
5761
5762 if ((eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5763 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5764 && (!eh->elf.start_stop
5765 || eh->elf.root.ldscript_def
5766 || !info->start_stop_gc)
5767 && ((eh->elf.ref_dynamic && !eh->elf.forced_local)
5768 || ((eh->elf.def_regular || ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (&eh->elf))
5769 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_INTERNAL
5770 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_HIDDEN
5771 && (!bfd_link_executable (info)
5772 || info->gc_keep_exported
5773 || info->export_dynamic
5774 || (eh->elf.dynamic
5775 && d != NULL
5776 && (*d->match) (&d->head, NULL,
5777 eh->elf.root.root.string)))
5778 && (eh->elf.versioned >= versioned
5779 || !bfd_hide_sym_by_version (info->version_info,
5780 eh->elf.root.root.string)))))
5781 {
5782 asection *code_sec;
5783 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
5784
5785 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5786
5787 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5788 function code sym section to be marked. */
5789 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5790 if (fh != NULL)
5791 {
5792 code_sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5793 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5794 }
5795 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5796 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5797 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5798 &code_sec, NULL, false) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5799 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5800 }
5801
5802 return true;
5803 }
5804
5805 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
5806 relocation. */
5807
5808 static asection *
5809 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
5810 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5811 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
5812 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5813 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
5814 {
5815 asection *rsec;
5816
5817 /* Syms return NULL if we're marking .opd, so we avoid marking all
5818 function sections, as all functions are referenced in .opd. */
5819 rsec = NULL;
5820 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
5821 return rsec;
5822
5823 if (h != NULL)
5824 {
5825 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
5826 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh, *fdh;
5827
5828 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
5829 switch (r_type)
5830 {
5831 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5832 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
5833 break;
5834
5835 default:
5836 switch (h->root.type)
5837 {
5838 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
5839 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
5840 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
5841 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5842 if (fdh != NULL)
5843 {
5844 /* -mcall-aixdesc code references the dot-symbol on
5845 a call reloc. Mark the function descriptor too
5846 against garbage collection. */
5847 fdh->elf.mark = 1;
5848 if (fdh->elf.is_weakalias)
5849 weakdef (&fdh->elf)->mark = 1;
5850 eh = fdh;
5851 }
5852
5853 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5854 function code sym section to be marked. */
5855 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5856 if (fh != NULL)
5857 {
5858 /* They also mark their opd section. */
5859 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5860
5861 rsec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5862 }
5863 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5864 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5865 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5866 &rsec, NULL, false) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5867 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5868 else
5869 rsec = h->root.u.def.section;
5870 break;
5871
5872 case bfd_link_hash_common:
5873 rsec = h->root.u.c.p->section;
5874 break;
5875
5876 default:
5877 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
5878 }
5879 }
5880 }
5881 else
5882 {
5883 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
5884
5885 rsec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
5886 opd = get_opd_info (rsec);
5887 if (opd != NULL && opd->func_sec != NULL)
5888 {
5889 rsec->gc_mark = 1;
5890
5891 rsec = opd->func_sec[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value + rel->r_addend)];
5892 }
5893 }
5894
5895 return rsec;
5896 }
5897
5898 /* The maximum size of .sfpr. */
5899 #define SFPR_MAX (218*4)
5900
5901 struct sfpr_def_parms
5902 {
5903 const char name[12];
5904 unsigned char lo, hi;
5905 bfd_byte *(*write_ent) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5906 bfd_byte *(*write_tail) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5907 };
5908
5909 /* Auto-generate _save*, _rest* functions in .sfpr.
5910 If STUB_SEC is non-null, define alias symbols in STUB_SEC
5911 instead. */
5912
5913 static bool
5914 sfpr_define (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5915 const struct sfpr_def_parms *parm,
5916 asection *stub_sec)
5917 {
5918 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5919 unsigned int i;
5920 size_t len = strlen (parm->name);
5921 bool writing = false;
5922 char sym[16];
5923
5924 if (htab == NULL)
5925 return false;
5926
5927 memcpy (sym, parm->name, len);
5928 sym[len + 2] = 0;
5929
5930 for (i = parm->lo; i <= parm->hi; i++)
5931 {
5932 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
5933
5934 sym[len + 0] = i / 10 + '0';
5935 sym[len + 1] = i % 10 + '0';
5936 h = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym,
5937 writing, true, true));
5938 if (stub_sec != NULL)
5939 {
5940 if (h != NULL
5941 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5942 && h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
5943 {
5944 struct elf_link_hash_entry *s;
5945 char buf[32];
5946 sprintf (buf, "%08x.%s", stub_sec->id & 0xffffffff, sym);
5947 s = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, buf, true, true, false);
5948 if (s == NULL)
5949 return false;
5950 if (s->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5951 {
5952 s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5953 s->root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
5954 s->root.u.def.value = (stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
5955 + h->elf.root.u.def.value);
5956 s->ref_regular = 1;
5957 s->def_regular = 1;
5958 s->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5959 s->forced_local = 1;
5960 s->non_elf = 0;
5961 s->root.linker_def = 1;
5962 }
5963 }
5964 continue;
5965 }
5966 if (h != NULL)
5967 {
5968 h->save_res = 1;
5969 if (!h->elf.def_regular)
5970 {
5971 h->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5972 h->elf.root.u.def.section = htab->sfpr;
5973 h->elf.root.u.def.value = htab->sfpr->size;
5974 h->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
5975 h->elf.def_regular = 1;
5976 h->elf.non_elf = 0;
5977 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->elf, true);
5978 writing = true;
5979 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5980 {
5981 htab->sfpr->contents
5982 = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, SFPR_MAX);
5983 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5984 return false;
5985 }
5986 }
5987 }
5988 if (writing)
5989 {
5990 bfd_byte *p = htab->sfpr->contents + htab->sfpr->size;
5991 if (i != parm->hi)
5992 p = (*parm->write_ent) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5993 else
5994 p = (*parm->write_tail) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5995 htab->sfpr->size = p - htab->sfpr->contents;
5996 }
5997 }
5998
5999 return true;
6000 }
6001
6002 static bfd_byte *
6003 savegpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6004 {
6005 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6006 return p + 4;
6007 }
6008
6009 static bfd_byte *
6010 savegpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6011 {
6012 p = savegpr0 (abfd, p, r);
6013 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6014 p = p + 4;
6015 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6016 return p + 4;
6017 }
6018
6019 static bfd_byte *
6020 restgpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6021 {
6022 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6023 return p + 4;
6024 }
6025
6026 static bfd_byte *
6027 restgpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6028 {
6029 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6030 p = p + 4;
6031 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, r);
6032 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6033 p = p + 4;
6034 if (r == 29)
6035 {
6036 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 30);
6037 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 31);
6038 }
6039 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6040 return p + 4;
6041 }
6042
6043 static bfd_byte *
6044 savegpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6045 {
6046 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6047 return p + 4;
6048 }
6049
6050 static bfd_byte *
6051 savegpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6052 {
6053 p = savegpr1 (abfd, p, r);
6054 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6055 return p + 4;
6056 }
6057
6058 static bfd_byte *
6059 restgpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6060 {
6061 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6062 return p + 4;
6063 }
6064
6065 static bfd_byte *
6066 restgpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6067 {
6068 p = restgpr1 (abfd, p, r);
6069 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6070 return p + 4;
6071 }
6072
6073 static bfd_byte *
6074 savefpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6075 {
6076 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6077 return p + 4;
6078 }
6079
6080 static bfd_byte *
6081 savefpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6082 {
6083 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
6084 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6085 p = p + 4;
6086 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6087 return p + 4;
6088 }
6089
6090 static bfd_byte *
6091 restfpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6092 {
6093 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6094 return p + 4;
6095 }
6096
6097 static bfd_byte *
6098 restfpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6099 {
6100 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6101 p = p + 4;
6102 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6103 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6104 p = p + 4;
6105 if (r == 29)
6106 {
6107 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 30);
6108 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 31);
6109 }
6110 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6111 return p + 4;
6112 }
6113
6114 static bfd_byte *
6115 savefpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6116 {
6117 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
6118 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6119 return p + 4;
6120 }
6121
6122 static bfd_byte *
6123 restfpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6124 {
6125 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6126 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6127 return p + 4;
6128 }
6129
6130 static bfd_byte *
6131 savevr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6132 {
6133 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6134 p = p + 4;
6135 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6136 return p + 4;
6137 }
6138
6139 static bfd_byte *
6140 savevr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6141 {
6142 p = savevr (abfd, p, r);
6143 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6144 return p + 4;
6145 }
6146
6147 static bfd_byte *
6148 restvr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6149 {
6150 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6151 p = p + 4;
6152 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6153 return p + 4;
6154 }
6155
6156 static bfd_byte *
6157 restvr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6158 {
6159 p = restvr (abfd, p, r);
6160 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6161 return p + 4;
6162 }
6163
6164 #define STDU_R1_0R1 0xf8210001
6165 #define ADDI_R1_R1 0x38210000
6166
6167 /* Emit prologue of wrapper preserving regs around a call to
6168 __tls_get_addr_opt. */
6169
6170 static bfd_byte *
6171 tls_get_addr_prologue (bfd *obfd, bfd_byte *p, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
6172 {
6173 unsigned int i;
6174
6175 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R0, p);
6176 p += 4;
6177 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R0_0R1 + 16, p);
6178 p += 4;
6179
6180 if (htab->opd_abi)
6181 {
6182 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6183 {
6184 bfd_put_32 (obfd,
6185 STD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (-(13 - i) * 8 & 0xffff), p);
6186 p += 4;
6187 }
6188 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STDU_R1_0R1 | (-128 & 0xffff), p);
6189 p += 4;
6190 }
6191 else
6192 {
6193 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6194 {
6195 bfd_put_32 (obfd,
6196 STD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (-(12 - i) * 8 & 0xffff), p);
6197 p += 4;
6198 }
6199 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STDU_R1_0R1 | (-96 & 0xffff), p);
6200 p += 4;
6201 }
6202 return p;
6203 }
6204
6205 /* Emit epilogue of wrapper preserving regs around a call to
6206 __tls_get_addr_opt. */
6207
6208 static bfd_byte *
6209 tls_get_addr_epilogue (bfd *obfd, bfd_byte *p, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
6210 {
6211 unsigned int i;
6212
6213 if (htab->opd_abi)
6214 {
6215 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6216 {
6217 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (128 - (13 - i) * 8), p);
6218 p += 4;
6219 }
6220 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R1_R1 | 128, p);
6221 p += 4;
6222 }
6223 else
6224 {
6225 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6226 {
6227 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (96 - (12 - i) * 8), p);
6228 p += 4;
6229 }
6230 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R1_R1 | 96, p);
6231 p += 4;
6232 }
6233 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | 16, p);
6234 p += 4;
6235 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6236 p += 4;
6237 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p);
6238 p += 4;
6239 return p;
6240 }
6241
6242 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to transfer dynamic linking
6243 information on function code symbol entries to their corresponding
6244 function descriptor symbol entries. */
6245
6246 static bool
6247 func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
6248 {
6249 struct bfd_link_info *info;
6250 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6251 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
6252 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
6253 bool force_local;
6254
6255 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6256 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6257 return true;
6258
6259 if (!fh->is_func)
6260 return true;
6261
6262 if (fh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.'
6263 || fh->elf.root.root.string[1] == '\0')
6264 return true;
6265
6266 info = inf;
6267 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6268 if (htab == NULL)
6269 return false;
6270
6271 /* Find the corresponding function descriptor symbol. */
6272 fdh = lookup_fdh (fh, htab);
6273
6274 /* Resolve undefined references to dot-symbols as the value
6275 in the function descriptor, if we have one in a regular object.
6276 This is to satisfy cases like ".quad .foo". Calls to functions
6277 in dynamic objects are handled elsewhere. */
6278 if ((fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6279 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6280 && (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6281 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6282 && get_opd_info (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
6283 && opd_entry_value (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6284 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value,
6285 &fh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6286 &fh->elf.root.u.def.value, false) != (bfd_vma) -1)
6287 {
6288 fh->elf.root.type = fdh->elf.root.type;
6289 fh->elf.forced_local = 1;
6290 fh->elf.def_regular = fdh->elf.def_regular;
6291 fh->elf.def_dynamic = fdh->elf.def_dynamic;
6292 }
6293
6294 if (!fh->elf.dynamic)
6295 {
6296 struct plt_entry *ent;
6297
6298 for (ent = fh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6299 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6300 break;
6301 if (ent == NULL)
6302 return true;
6303 }
6304
6305 /* Create a descriptor as undefined if necessary. */
6306 if (fdh == NULL
6307 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
6308 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6309 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
6310 {
6311 fdh = make_fdh (info, fh);
6312 if (fdh == NULL)
6313 return false;
6314 }
6315
6316 /* We can't support overriding of symbols on a fake descriptor. */
6317 if (fdh != NULL
6318 && fdh->fake
6319 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6320 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
6321 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fdh->elf, true);
6322
6323 /* Transfer dynamic linking information to the function descriptor. */
6324 if (fdh != NULL)
6325 {
6326 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= fh->elf.ref_regular;
6327 fdh->elf.ref_dynamic |= fh->elf.ref_dynamic;
6328 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= fh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
6329 fdh->elf.non_got_ref |= fh->elf.non_got_ref;
6330 fdh->elf.dynamic |= fh->elf.dynamic;
6331 fdh->elf.needs_plt |= (fh->elf.needs_plt
6332 || fh->elf.type == STT_FUNC
6333 || fh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
6334 move_plt_plist (fh, fdh);
6335
6336 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
6337 && fh->elf.dynindx != -1)
6338 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
6339 return false;
6340 }
6341
6342 /* Now that the info is on the function descriptor, clear the
6343 function code sym info. Any function code syms for which we
6344 don't have a definition in a regular file, we force local.
6345 This prevents a shared library from exporting syms that have
6346 been imported from another library. Function code syms that
6347 are really in the library we must leave global to prevent the
6348 linker dragging in a definition from a static library. */
6349 force_local = (!fh->elf.def_regular
6350 || fdh == NULL
6351 || !fdh->elf.def_regular
6352 || fdh->elf.forced_local);
6353 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6354
6355 return true;
6356 }
6357
6358 static const struct sfpr_def_parms save_res_funcs[] =
6359 {
6360 { "_savegpr0_", 14, 31, savegpr0, savegpr0_tail },
6361 { "_restgpr0_", 14, 29, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6362 { "_restgpr0_", 30, 31, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6363 { "_savegpr1_", 14, 31, savegpr1, savegpr1_tail },
6364 { "_restgpr1_", 14, 31, restgpr1, restgpr1_tail },
6365 { "_savefpr_", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr0_tail },
6366 { "_restfpr_", 14, 29, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6367 { "_restfpr_", 30, 31, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6368 { "._savef", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr1_tail },
6369 { "._restf", 14, 31, restfpr, restfpr1_tail },
6370 { "_savevr_", 20, 31, savevr, savevr_tail },
6371 { "_restvr_", 20, 31, restvr, restvr_tail }
6372 };
6373
6374 /* Called near the start of bfd_elf_size_dynamic_sections. We use
6375 this hook to a) run the edit functions in this file, b) provide
6376 some gcc support functions, and c) transfer dynamic linking
6377 information gathered so far on function code symbol entries, to
6378 their corresponding function descriptor symbol entries. */
6379
6380 static bool
6381 ppc64_elf_edit (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, struct bfd_link_info *info)
6382 {
6383 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6384
6385 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6386 if (htab == NULL)
6387 return false;
6388
6389 /* Call back into the linker, which then runs the edit functions. */
6390 htab->params->edit ();
6391
6392 /* Provide any missing _save* and _rest* functions. */
6393 if (htab->sfpr != NULL)
6394 {
6395 unsigned int i;
6396
6397 htab->sfpr->size = 0;
6398 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
6399 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], NULL))
6400 return false;
6401 if (htab->sfpr->size == 0)
6402 htab->sfpr->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6403 }
6404
6405 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
6406 return true;
6407
6408 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6409 {
6410 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, htab->elf.hgot, true);
6411 /* Make .TOC. defined so as to prevent it being made dynamic.
6412 The wrong value here is fixed later in ppc64_elf_set_toc. */
6413 if (!htab->elf.hgot->def_regular
6414 || htab->elf.hgot->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined)
6415 {
6416 htab->elf.hgot->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6417 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = 0;
6418 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6419 htab->elf.hgot->def_regular = 1;
6420 htab->elf.hgot->root.linker_def = 1;
6421 }
6422 htab->elf.hgot->type = STT_OBJECT;
6423 htab->elf.hgot->other
6424 = (htab->elf.hgot->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
6425 }
6426
6427 if (htab->need_func_desc_adj)
6428 {
6429 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
6430 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
6431 }
6432
6433 return true;
6434 }
6435
6436 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
6437 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
6438 size_dynamic_sections. */
6439
6440 static bool
6441 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6442 {
6443 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6444 do
6445 {
6446 if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
6447 return true;
6448 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
6449 }
6450 while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
6451
6452 return false;
6453 }
6454
6455 /* Return whether EH has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
6456
6457 static bool
6458 pc_dynrelocs (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh)
6459 {
6460 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6461
6462 for (p = eh->elf.dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
6463 if (p->pc_count != 0)
6464 return true;
6465 return false;
6466 }
6467
6468 /* Return true if a global entry stub will be created for H. Valid
6469 for ELFv2 before plt entries have been allocated. */
6470
6471 static bool
6472 global_entry_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6473 {
6474 struct plt_entry *pent;
6475
6476 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6477 || h->def_regular)
6478 return false;
6479
6480 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
6481 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0
6482 && pent->addend == 0)
6483 return true;
6484
6485 return false;
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6489 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6490 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6491 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6492 understand. */
6493
6494 static bool
6495 ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6496 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6497 {
6498 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6499 asection *s, *srel;
6500
6501 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6502 if (htab == NULL)
6503 return false;
6504
6505 /* Deal with function syms. */
6506 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6507 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6508 || h->needs_plt)
6509 {
6510 bool local = (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->save_res
6511 || SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
6512 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
6513 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
6514 function symbol is local and not an ifunc. We keep dynamic
6515 relocs for ifuncs when local rather than always emitting a
6516 plt call stub for them and defining the symbol on the call
6517 stub. We can't do that for ELFv1 anyway (a function symbol
6518 is defined on a descriptor, not code) and it can be faster at
6519 run-time due to not needing to bounce through a stub. The
6520 dyn_relocs for ifuncs will be applied even in a static
6521 executable. */
6522 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
6523 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6524 && local)
6525 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6526
6527 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
6528 won't need a .plt entry. */
6529 struct plt_entry *ent;
6530 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6531 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6532 break;
6533 if (ent == NULL
6534 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6535 && local
6536 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
6537 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
6538 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
6539 {
6540 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6541 h->needs_plt = 0;
6542 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6543 }
6544 else if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) >= 2)
6545 {
6546 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
6547 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
6548 executable on a global entry stub. A dynamic reloc can
6549 be used instead. The reason we prefer a few more dynamic
6550 relocs is that calling via a global entry stub costs a
6551 few more instructions, and pointer_equality_needed causes
6552 extra work in ld.so when resolving these symbols. */
6553 if (global_entry_stub (h))
6554 {
6555 if (!_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6556 {
6557 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6558 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
6559 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6560 if (!h->needs_plt)
6561 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6562 }
6563 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
6564 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
6565 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
6566 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6567 }
6568
6569 /* ELFv2 function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
6570 return true;
6571 }
6572 else if (!h->needs_plt
6573 && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6574 {
6575 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol isn't an
6576 ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6577 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6578 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6579 return true;
6580 }
6581 }
6582 else
6583 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6584
6585 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6586 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6587 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
6588 if (h->is_weakalias)
6589 {
6590 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
6591 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6592 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
6593 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
6594 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
6595 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
6596 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6597 return true;
6598 }
6599
6600 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
6601 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
6602 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
6603 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
6604 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
6605 return true;
6606
6607 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
6608 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
6609 if (!h->non_got_ref)
6610 return true;
6611
6612 /* Don't generate a copy reloc for symbols defined in the executable. */
6613 if (!h->def_dynamic || !h->ref_regular || h->def_regular
6614
6615 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, don't generate them either. */
6616 || info->nocopyreloc
6617
6618 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
6619 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc. */
6620 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
6621 && !h->needs_copy
6622 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6623
6624 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
6625 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
6626 definition for the variable. Text relocations are preferable
6627 to an incorrect program. */
6628 || h->protected_def)
6629 return true;
6630
6631 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6632 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
6633 {
6634 /* .dynbss copies of function symbols only work if we have
6635 ELFv1 dot-symbols. ELFv1 compilers since 2004 default to not
6636 use dot-symbols and set the function symbol size to the text
6637 size of the function rather than the size of the descriptor.
6638 That's wrong for copying a descriptor. */
6639 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->oh == NULL
6640 || !(h->size == 24 || h->size == 16))
6641 return true;
6642
6643 /* We should never get here, but unfortunately there are old
6644 versions of gcc (circa gcc-3.2) that improperly for the
6645 ELFv1 ABI put initialized function pointers, vtable refs and
6646 suchlike in read-only sections. Allow them to proceed, but
6647 warn that this might break at runtime. */
6648 info->callbacks->einfo
6649 (_("%P: copy reloc against `%pT' requires lazy plt linking; "
6650 "avoid setting LD_BIND_NOW=1 or upgrade gcc\n"),
6651 h->root.root.string);
6652 }
6653
6654 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6655 is not a function. */
6656
6657 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
6658 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
6659 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
6660 object will contain position independent code, so all references
6661 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
6662 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
6663 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
6664 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
6665 same memory location for the variable. */
6666 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6667 {
6668 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
6669 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
6670 }
6671 else
6672 {
6673 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
6674 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
6675 }
6676 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
6677 {
6678 /* We must generate a R_PPC64_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
6679 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
6680 and into the runtime process image. */
6681 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
6682 h->needs_copy = 1;
6683 }
6684
6685 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
6686 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6687 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
6688 }
6689
6690 /* If given a function descriptor symbol, hide both the function code
6691 sym and the descriptor. */
6692 static void
6693 ppc64_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6694 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6695 bool force_local)
6696 {
6697 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6698 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
6699
6700 if (ppc_hash_table (info) == NULL)
6701 return;
6702
6703 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6704 if (eh->is_func_descriptor)
6705 {
6706 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = eh->oh;
6707
6708 if (fh == NULL)
6709 {
6710 const char *p, *q;
6711 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
6712 char save;
6713
6714 /* We aren't supposed to use alloca in BFD because on
6715 systems which do not have alloca the version in libiberty
6716 calls xmalloc, which might cause the program to crash
6717 when it runs out of memory. This function doesn't have a
6718 return status, so there's no way to gracefully return an
6719 error. So cheat. We know that string[-1] can be safely
6720 accessed; It's either a string in an ELF string table,
6721 or allocated in an objalloc structure. */
6722
6723 p = eh->elf.root.root.string - 1;
6724 save = *p;
6725 *(char *) p = '.';
6726 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, false,
6727 false, false));
6728 *(char *) p = save;
6729
6730 /* Unfortunately, if it so happens that the string we were
6731 looking for was allocated immediately before this string,
6732 then we overwrote the string terminator. That's the only
6733 reason the lookup should fail. */
6734 if (fh == NULL)
6735 {
6736 q = eh->elf.root.root.string + strlen (eh->elf.root.root.string);
6737 while (q >= eh->elf.root.root.string && *q == *p)
6738 --q, --p;
6739 if (q < eh->elf.root.root.string && *p == '.')
6740 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, false,
6741 false, false));
6742 }
6743 if (fh != NULL)
6744 {
6745 eh->oh = fh;
6746 fh->oh = eh;
6747 }
6748 }
6749 if (fh != NULL)
6750 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6751 }
6752 }
6753
6754 static bool
6755 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
6756 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
6757 asection **symsecp,
6758 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6759 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6760 unsigned long r_symndx,
6761 bfd *ibfd)
6762 {
6763 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
6764
6765 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6766 {
6767 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
6768 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6769
6770 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6771 h = elf_follow_link (h);
6772
6773 if (hp != NULL)
6774 *hp = h;
6775
6776 if (symp != NULL)
6777 *symp = NULL;
6778
6779 if (symsecp != NULL)
6780 {
6781 asection *symsec = NULL;
6782 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6783 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6784 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
6785 *symsecp = symsec;
6786 }
6787
6788 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6789 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
6790 }
6791 else
6792 {
6793 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6794 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
6795
6796 if (locsyms == NULL)
6797 {
6798 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6799 if (locsyms == NULL)
6800 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
6801 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
6802 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
6803 if (locsyms == NULL)
6804 return false;
6805 *locsymsp = locsyms;
6806 }
6807 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
6808
6809 if (hp != NULL)
6810 *hp = NULL;
6811
6812 if (symp != NULL)
6813 *symp = sym;
6814
6815 if (symsecp != NULL)
6816 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
6817
6818 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6819 {
6820 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
6821 unsigned char *tls_mask;
6822
6823 tls_mask = NULL;
6824 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
6825 if (lgot_ents != NULL)
6826 {
6827 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6828 (lgot_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6829 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
6830 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6831 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
6832 }
6833 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
6834 }
6835 }
6836 return true;
6837 }
6838
6839 /* Returns TLS_MASKP for the given REL symbol. Function return is 0 on
6840 error, 2 on a toc GD type suitable for optimization, 3 on a toc LD
6841 type suitable for optimization, and 1 otherwise. */
6842
6843 static int
6844 get_tls_mask (unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6845 unsigned long *toc_symndx,
6846 bfd_vma *toc_addend,
6847 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6848 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6849 bfd *ibfd)
6850 {
6851 unsigned long r_symndx;
6852 int next_r;
6853 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6854 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6855 asection *sec;
6856 bfd_vma off;
6857
6858 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6859 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6860 return 0;
6861
6862 if ((*tls_maskp != NULL
6863 && (**tls_maskp & TLS_TLS) != 0
6864 && **tls_maskp != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
6865 || sec == NULL
6866 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) == NULL
6867 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type != sec_toc)
6868 return 1;
6869
6870 /* Look inside a TOC section too. */
6871 if (h != NULL)
6872 {
6873 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6874 off = h->root.u.def.value;
6875 }
6876 else
6877 off = sym->st_value;
6878 off += rel->r_addend;
6879 BFD_ASSERT (off % 8 == 0);
6880 r_symndx = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8];
6881 next_r = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8 + 1];
6882 if (toc_symndx != NULL)
6883 *toc_symndx = r_symndx;
6884 if (toc_addend != NULL)
6885 *toc_addend = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.add[off / 8];
6886 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6887 return 0;
6888 if ((h == NULL || is_static_defined (h))
6889 && (next_r == -1 || next_r == -2))
6890 return 1 - next_r;
6891 return 1;
6892 }
6893
6894 /* Find (or create) an entry in the tocsave hash table. */
6895
6896 static struct tocsave_entry *
6897 tocsave_find (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
6898 enum insert_option insert,
6899 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6900 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irela,
6901 bfd *ibfd)
6902 {
6903 unsigned long r_indx;
6904 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6905 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6906 struct tocsave_entry ent, *p;
6907 hashval_t hash;
6908 struct tocsave_entry **slot;
6909
6910 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
6911 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &ent.sec, NULL, local_syms, r_indx, ibfd))
6912 return NULL;
6913 if (ent.sec == NULL || ent.sec->output_section == NULL)
6914 {
6915 _bfd_error_handler
6916 (_("%pB: undefined symbol on R_PPC64_TOCSAVE relocation"), ibfd);
6917 return NULL;
6918 }
6919
6920 if (h != NULL)
6921 ent.offset = h->root.u.def.value;
6922 else
6923 ent.offset = sym->st_value;
6924 ent.offset += irela->r_addend;
6925
6926 hash = tocsave_htab_hash (&ent);
6927 slot = ((struct tocsave_entry **)
6928 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab->tocsave_htab, &ent, hash, insert));
6929 if (slot == NULL)
6930 return NULL;
6931
6932 if (*slot == NULL)
6933 {
6934 p = (struct tocsave_entry *) bfd_alloc (ibfd, sizeof (*p));
6935 if (p == NULL)
6936 return NULL;
6937 *p = ent;
6938 *slot = p;
6939 }
6940 return *slot;
6941 }
6942
6943 /* Adjust all global syms defined in opd sections. In gcc generated
6944 code for the old ABI, these will already have been done. */
6945
6946 static bool
6947 adjust_opd_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6948 {
6949 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6950 asection *sym_sec;
6951 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
6952
6953 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6954 return true;
6955
6956 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6957 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6958 return true;
6959
6960 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6961 if (eh->adjust_done)
6962 return true;
6963
6964 sym_sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
6965 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
6966 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
6967 {
6968 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (eh->elf.root.u.def.value)];
6969 if (adjust == -1)
6970 {
6971 /* This entry has been deleted. */
6972 asection *dsec = ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section;
6973 if (dsec == NULL)
6974 {
6975 for (dsec = sym_sec->owner->sections; dsec; dsec = dsec->next)
6976 if (discarded_section (dsec))
6977 {
6978 ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section = dsec;
6979 break;
6980 }
6981 }
6982 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
6983 eh->elf.root.u.def.section = dsec;
6984 }
6985 else
6986 eh->elf.root.u.def.value += adjust;
6987 eh->adjust_done = 1;
6988 }
6989 return true;
6990 }
6991
6992 /* Handles decrementing dynamic reloc counts for the reloc specified by
6993 R_INFO in section SEC. If LOCAL_SYMS is NULL, then H and SYM
6994 have already been determined. */
6995
6996 static bool
6997 dec_dynrel_count (bfd_vma r_info,
6998 asection *sec,
6999 struct bfd_link_info *info,
7000 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
7001 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
7002 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
7003 {
7004 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7005 asection *sym_sec = NULL;
7006
7007 /* Can this reloc be dynamic? This switch, and later tests here
7008 should be kept in sync with the code in check_relocs. */
7009 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (r_info);
7010 switch (r_type)
7011 {
7012 default:
7013 return true;
7014
7015 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
7016 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
7017 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
7018 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
7019 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
7020 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
7021 if (h == NULL)
7022 return true;
7023 break;
7024
7025 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
7026 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
7027 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
7028 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
7029 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
7030 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
7031 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
7032 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
7033 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
7034 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
7035 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
7036 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
7037 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
7038 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
7039 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
7040 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
7041 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
7042 case R_PPC64_REL30:
7043 case R_PPC64_REL32:
7044 case R_PPC64_REL64:
7045 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
7046 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7047 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7048 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
7049 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
7050 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
7051 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
7052 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
7053 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
7054 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
7055 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
7056 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
7057 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
7058 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
7059 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
7060 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
7061 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
7062 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
7063 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
7064 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
7065 case R_PPC64_TOC:
7066 case R_PPC64_D34:
7067 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
7068 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
7069 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
7070 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
7071 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
7072 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
7073 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
7074 case R_PPC64_D28:
7075 break;
7076 }
7077
7078 if (local_syms != NULL)
7079 {
7080 unsigned long r_symndx;
7081 bfd *ibfd = sec->owner;
7082
7083 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (r_info);
7084 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, local_syms, r_symndx, ibfd))
7085 return false;
7086 }
7087
7088 if ((h != NULL
7089 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
7090 || !h->def_regular))
7091 || (h != NULL
7092 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
7093 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
7094 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7095 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
7096 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7097 && (h != NULL
7098 ? h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
7099 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)))
7100 ;
7101 else
7102 return true;
7103
7104 if (h != NULL)
7105 {
7106 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
7107 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
7108 pp = &h->dyn_relocs;
7109
7110 /* elf_gc_sweep may have already removed all dyn relocs associated
7111 with local syms for a given section. Also, symbol flags are
7112 changed by elf_gc_sweep_symbol, confusing the test above. Don't
7113 report a dynreloc miscount. */
7114 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
7115 return true;
7116
7117 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
7118 {
7119 if (p->sec == sec)
7120 {
7121 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
7122 p->pc_count -= 1;
7123 p->count -= 1;
7124 if (p->count == 0)
7125 *pp = p->next;
7126 return true;
7127 }
7128 pp = &p->next;
7129 }
7130 }
7131 else
7132 {
7133 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
7134 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **pp;
7135 void *vpp;
7136 bool is_ifunc;
7137
7138 if (local_syms == NULL)
7139 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
7140 if (sym_sec == NULL)
7141 sym_sec = sec;
7142
7143 vpp = &elf_section_data (sym_sec)->local_dynrel;
7144 pp = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
7145
7146 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
7147 return true;
7148
7149 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7150 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
7151 {
7152 if (p->sec == sec && p->ifunc == is_ifunc)
7153 {
7154 p->count -= 1;
7155 if (p->count == 0)
7156 *pp = p->next;
7157 return true;
7158 }
7159 pp = &p->next;
7160 }
7161 }
7162
7163 /* xgettext:c-format */
7164 _bfd_error_handler (_("dynreloc miscount for %pB, section %pA"),
7165 sec->owner, sec);
7166 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7167 return false;
7168 }
7169
7170 /* Remove unused Official Procedure Descriptor entries. Currently we
7171 only remove those associated with functions in discarded link-once
7172 sections, or weakly defined functions that have been overridden. It
7173 would be possible to remove many more entries for statically linked
7174 applications. */
7175
7176 bool
7177 ppc64_elf_edit_opd (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7178 {
7179 bfd *ibfd;
7180 bool some_edited = false;
7181 asection *need_pad = NULL;
7182 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7183
7184 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7185 if (htab == NULL)
7186 return false;
7187
7188 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7189 {
7190 asection *sec;
7191 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7192 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7193 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7194 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
7195 bool need_edit, add_aux_fields, broken;
7196 bfd_size_type cnt_16b = 0;
7197
7198 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7199 continue;
7200
7201 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
7202 if (sec == NULL || sec->size == 0)
7203 continue;
7204
7205 if (sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS)
7206 continue;
7207
7208 if (sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7209 continue;
7210
7211 /* Look through the section relocs. */
7212 if ((sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0 || sec->reloc_count == 0)
7213 continue;
7214
7215 local_syms = NULL;
7216 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7217
7218 /* Read the relocations. */
7219 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7220 info->keep_memory);
7221 if (relstart == NULL)
7222 return false;
7223
7224 /* First run through the relocs to check they are sane, and to
7225 determine whether we need to edit this opd section. */
7226 need_edit = false;
7227 broken = false;
7228 need_pad = sec;
7229 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7230 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7231 {
7232 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7233 unsigned long r_symndx;
7234 asection *sym_sec;
7235 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7236 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7237 bfd_vma offset;
7238
7239 /* .opd contains an array of 16 or 24 byte entries. We're
7240 only interested in the reloc pointing to a function entry
7241 point. */
7242 offset = rel->r_offset;
7243 if (rel + 1 == relend
7244 || rel[1].r_offset != offset + 8)
7245 {
7246 /* If someone messes with .opd alignment then after a
7247 "ld -r" we might have padding in the middle of .opd.
7248 Also, there's nothing to prevent someone putting
7249 something silly in .opd with the assembler. No .opd
7250 optimization for them! */
7251 broken_opd:
7252 _bfd_error_handler
7253 (_("%pB: .opd is not a regular array of opd entries"), ibfd);
7254 broken = true;
7255 break;
7256 }
7257
7258 if ((r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) != R_PPC64_ADDR64
7259 || (r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info)) != R_PPC64_TOC)
7260 {
7261 _bfd_error_handler
7262 /* xgettext:c-format */
7263 (_("%pB: unexpected reloc type %u in .opd section"),
7264 ibfd, r_type);
7265 broken = true;
7266 break;
7267 }
7268
7269 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7270 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7271 r_symndx, ibfd))
7272 goto error_ret;
7273
7274 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec->owner == NULL)
7275 {
7276 const char *sym_name;
7277 if (h != NULL)
7278 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7279 else
7280 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym,
7281 sym_sec);
7282
7283 _bfd_error_handler
7284 /* xgettext:c-format */
7285 (_("%pB: undefined sym `%s' in .opd section"),
7286 ibfd, sym_name);
7287 broken = true;
7288 break;
7289 }
7290
7291 /* opd entries are always for functions defined in the
7292 current input bfd. If the symbol isn't defined in the
7293 input bfd, then we won't be using the function in this
7294 bfd; It must be defined in a linkonce section in another
7295 bfd, or is weak. It's also possible that we are
7296 discarding the function due to a linker script /DISCARD/,
7297 which we test for via the output_section. */
7298 if (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7299 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7300 need_edit = true;
7301
7302 rel += 2;
7303 if (rel + 1 == relend
7304 || (rel + 2 < relend
7305 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7306 ++rel;
7307
7308 if (rel == relend)
7309 {
7310 if (sec->size == offset + 24)
7311 {
7312 need_pad = NULL;
7313 break;
7314 }
7315 if (sec->size == offset + 16)
7316 {
7317 cnt_16b++;
7318 break;
7319 }
7320 goto broken_opd;
7321 }
7322 else if (rel + 1 < relend
7323 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[0].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
7324 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
7325 {
7326 if (rel[0].r_offset == offset + 16)
7327 cnt_16b++;
7328 else if (rel[0].r_offset != offset + 24)
7329 goto broken_opd;
7330 }
7331 else
7332 goto broken_opd;
7333 }
7334
7335 add_aux_fields = htab->params->non_overlapping_opd && cnt_16b > 0;
7336
7337 if (!broken && (need_edit || add_aux_fields))
7338 {
7339 Elf_Internal_Rela *write_rel;
7340 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7341 bfd_byte *rptr, *wptr;
7342 bfd_byte *new_contents;
7343 bfd_size_type amt;
7344
7345 new_contents = NULL;
7346 amt = OPD_NDX (sec->size) * sizeof (long);
7347 opd = &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
7348 opd->adjust = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner, amt);
7349 if (opd->adjust == NULL)
7350 return false;
7351
7352 /* This seems a waste of time as input .opd sections are all
7353 zeros as generated by gcc, but I suppose there's no reason
7354 this will always be so. We might start putting something in
7355 the third word of .opd entries. */
7356 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7357 {
7358 bfd_byte *loc;
7359 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, sec, &loc))
7360 {
7361 free (loc);
7362 error_ret:
7363 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7364 free (local_syms);
7365 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7366 free (relstart);
7367 return false;
7368 }
7369 sec->contents = loc;
7370 sec->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7371 }
7372
7373 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
7374
7375 new_contents = sec->contents;
7376 if (add_aux_fields)
7377 {
7378 new_contents = bfd_malloc (sec->size + cnt_16b * 8);
7379 if (new_contents == NULL)
7380 return false;
7381 need_pad = NULL;
7382 }
7383 wptr = new_contents;
7384 rptr = sec->contents;
7385 write_rel = relstart;
7386 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7387 {
7388 unsigned long r_symndx;
7389 asection *sym_sec;
7390 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7391 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = NULL;
7392 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7393 long opd_ent_size;
7394 Elf_Internal_Rela *next_rel;
7395 bool skip;
7396
7397 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7398 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7399 r_symndx, ibfd))
7400 goto error_ret;
7401
7402 next_rel = rel + 2;
7403 if (next_rel + 1 == relend
7404 || (next_rel + 2 < relend
7405 && ELF64_R_TYPE (next_rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7406 ++next_rel;
7407
7408 /* See if the .opd entry is full 24 byte or
7409 16 byte (with fd_aux entry overlapped with next
7410 fd_func). */
7411 opd_ent_size = 24;
7412 if (next_rel == relend)
7413 {
7414 if (sec->size == rel->r_offset + 16)
7415 opd_ent_size = 16;
7416 }
7417 else if (next_rel->r_offset == rel->r_offset + 16)
7418 opd_ent_size = 16;
7419
7420 if (h != NULL
7421 && h->root.root.string[0] == '.')
7422 {
7423 fdh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->oh;
7424 if (fdh != NULL)
7425 {
7426 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
7427 if (fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
7428 && fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7429 fdh = NULL;
7430 }
7431 }
7432
7433 skip = (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7434 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr);
7435 if (skip)
7436 {
7437 if (fdh != NULL && sym_sec->owner == ibfd)
7438 {
7439 /* Arrange for the function descriptor sym
7440 to be dropped. */
7441 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
7442 fdh->elf.root.u.def.section = sym_sec;
7443 }
7444 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = -1;
7445
7446 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS || bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7447 rel = next_rel;
7448 else
7449 while (1)
7450 {
7451 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
7452 NULL, h, sym))
7453 goto error_ret;
7454
7455 if (++rel == next_rel)
7456 break;
7457
7458 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7459 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7460 r_symndx, ibfd))
7461 goto error_ret;
7462 }
7463 }
7464 else
7465 {
7466 /* We'll be keeping this opd entry. */
7467 long adjust;
7468
7469 if (fdh != NULL)
7470 {
7471 /* Redefine the function descriptor symbol to
7472 this location in the opd section. It is
7473 necessary to update the value here rather
7474 than using an array of adjustments as we do
7475 for local symbols, because various places
7476 in the generic ELF code use the value
7477 stored in u.def.value. */
7478 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = wptr - new_contents;
7479 fdh->adjust_done = 1;
7480 }
7481
7482 /* Local syms are a bit tricky. We could
7483 tweak them as they can be cached, but
7484 we'd need to look through the local syms
7485 for the function descriptor sym which we
7486 don't have at the moment. So keep an
7487 array of adjustments. */
7488 adjust = (wptr - new_contents) - (rptr - sec->contents);
7489 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = adjust;
7490
7491 if (wptr != rptr)
7492 memcpy (wptr, rptr, opd_ent_size);
7493 wptr += opd_ent_size;
7494 if (add_aux_fields && opd_ent_size == 16)
7495 {
7496 memset (wptr, '\0', 8);
7497 wptr += 8;
7498 }
7499
7500 /* We need to adjust any reloc offsets to point to the
7501 new opd entries. */
7502 for ( ; rel != next_rel; ++rel)
7503 {
7504 rel->r_offset += adjust;
7505 if (write_rel != rel)
7506 memcpy (write_rel, rel, sizeof (*rel));
7507 ++write_rel;
7508 }
7509 }
7510
7511 rptr += opd_ent_size;
7512 }
7513
7514 sec->size = wptr - new_contents;
7515 sec->reloc_count = write_rel - relstart;
7516 if (add_aux_fields)
7517 {
7518 free (sec->contents);
7519 sec->contents = new_contents;
7520 }
7521
7522 /* Fudge the header size too, as this is used later in
7523 elf_bfd_final_link if we are emitting relocs. */
7524 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (sec);
7525 rel_hdr->sh_size = sec->reloc_count * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
7526 some_edited = true;
7527 }
7528 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7529 free (relstart);
7530
7531 if (local_syms != NULL
7532 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7533 {
7534 if (!info->keep_memory)
7535 free (local_syms);
7536 else
7537 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7538 }
7539 }
7540
7541 if (some_edited)
7542 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_opd_syms, NULL);
7543
7544 /* If we are doing a final link and the last .opd entry is just 16 byte
7545 long, add a 8 byte padding after it. */
7546 if (need_pad != NULL && !bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7547 {
7548 bfd_byte *p;
7549
7550 if ((need_pad->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7551 {
7552 BFD_ASSERT (need_pad->size > 0);
7553
7554 p = bfd_malloc (need_pad->size + 8);
7555 if (p == NULL)
7556 return false;
7557
7558 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (need_pad->owner, need_pad,
7559 p, 0, need_pad->size))
7560 return false;
7561
7562 need_pad->contents = p;
7563 need_pad->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7564 }
7565 else
7566 {
7567 p = bfd_realloc (need_pad->contents, need_pad->size + 8);
7568 if (p == NULL)
7569 return false;
7570
7571 need_pad->contents = p;
7572 }
7573
7574 memset (need_pad->contents + need_pad->size, 0, 8);
7575 need_pad->size += 8;
7576 }
7577
7578 return true;
7579 }
7580
7581 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
7582 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
7583
7584 bool
7585 ppc64_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7586 {
7587 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7588 bfd *ibfd;
7589 asection *sec;
7590 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
7591
7592 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7593 if (htab == NULL)
7594 return false;
7595
7596 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
7597 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
7598 between the call and its destination. */
7599 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
7600 {
7601 limit = -htab->params->group_size;
7602 if (limit == 1)
7603 limit = 0x1e00000;
7604 }
7605 else
7606 {
7607 limit = htab->params->group_size;
7608 if (limit == 1)
7609 limit = 0x1c00000;
7610 }
7611
7612 low_vma = -1;
7613 high_vma = 0;
7614 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7615 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
7616 {
7617 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
7618 low_vma = sec->vma;
7619 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
7620 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
7621 }
7622
7623 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
7624 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
7625 is local. */
7626 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
7627 {
7628 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
7629 return true;
7630 }
7631
7632 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
7633 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
7634 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
7635 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
7636 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
7637 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
7638 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
7639 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
7640 particular R_PPC64_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
7641 call, for each of the R_PPC64_PLTSEQ and R_PPC64_PLT16* insns in
7642 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
7643 together except their symbol. */
7644
7645 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7646 {
7647 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7648 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7649
7650 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7651 continue;
7652
7653 local_syms = NULL;
7654 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7655
7656 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7657 if (ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall
7658 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7659 {
7660 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7661
7662 /* Read the relocations. */
7663 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7664 info->keep_memory);
7665 if (relstart == NULL)
7666 return false;
7667
7668 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7669 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
7670 {
7671 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7672 unsigned long r_symndx;
7673 asection *sym_sec;
7674 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7675 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7676 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
7677
7678 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7679 if (r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
7680 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
7681 continue;
7682
7683 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7684 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
7685 r_symndx, ibfd))
7686 {
7687 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7688 free (relstart);
7689 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (bfd_byte *) local_syms)
7690 free (local_syms);
7691 return false;
7692 }
7693
7694 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7695 {
7696 bfd_vma from, to;
7697 if (h != NULL)
7698 to = h->root.u.def.value;
7699 else
7700 to = sym->st_value;
7701 to += (rel->r_addend
7702 + sym_sec->output_offset
7703 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
7704 from = (rel->r_offset
7705 + sec->output_offset
7706 + sec->output_section->vma);
7707 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit
7708 && !(r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC
7709 && (((h ? h->other : sym->st_other)
7710 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
7711 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
7712 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
7713 }
7714 }
7715 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7716 free (relstart);
7717 }
7718
7719 if (local_syms != NULL
7720 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7721 {
7722 if (!info->keep_memory)
7723 free (local_syms);
7724 else
7725 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7726 }
7727 }
7728
7729 return true;
7730 }
7731
7732 /* Set htab->tls_get_addr and various other info specific to TLS.
7733 This needs to run before dynamic symbols are processed in
7734 bfd_elf_size_dynamic_sections. */
7735
7736 bool
7737 ppc64_elf_tls_setup (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7738 {
7739 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7740 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *tga_fd, *desc, *desc_fd;
7741
7742 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7743 if (htab == NULL)
7744 return false;
7745
7746 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 1)
7747 htab->opd_abi = 1;
7748
7749 if (htab->params->no_multi_toc)
7750 htab->do_multi_toc = 0;
7751 else if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
7752 htab->params->no_multi_toc = 1;
7753
7754 /* Default to --no-plt-localentry, as this option can cause problems
7755 with symbol interposition. For example, glibc libpthread.so and
7756 libc.so duplicate many pthread symbols, with a fallback
7757 implementation in libc.so. In some cases the fallback does more
7758 work than the pthread implementation. __pthread_condattr_destroy
7759 is one such symbol: the libpthread.so implementation is
7760 localentry:0 while the libc.so implementation is localentry:8.
7761 An app that "cleverly" uses dlopen to only load necessary
7762 libraries at runtime may omit loading libpthread.so when not
7763 running multi-threaded, which then results in the libc.so
7764 fallback symbols being used and ld.so complaining. Now there
7765 are workarounds in ld (see non_zero_localentry) to detect the
7766 pthread situation, but that may not be the only case where
7767 --plt-localentry can cause trouble. */
7768 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0 < 0)
7769 htab->params->plt_localentry0 = 0;
7770 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0 && htab->has_power10_relocs)
7771 {
7772 /* The issue is that __glink_PLTresolve saves r2, which is done
7773 because glibc ld.so _dl_runtime_resolve restores r2 to support
7774 a glibc plt call optimisation where global entry code is
7775 skipped on calls that resolve to the same binary. The
7776 __glink_PLTresolve save of r2 is incompatible with code
7777 making tail calls, because the tail call might go via the
7778 resolver and thus overwrite the proper saved r2. */
7779 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: --plt-localentry is incompatible with "
7780 "power10 pc-relative code"));
7781 htab->params->plt_localentry0 = 0;
7782 }
7783 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0
7784 && elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "GLIBC_2.26",
7785 false, false, false) == NULL)
7786 _bfd_error_handler
7787 (_("warning: --plt-localentry is especially dangerous without "
7788 "ld.so support to detect ABI violations"));
7789
7790 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
7791 false, false, true);
7792 htab->tls_get_addr = ppc_elf_hash_entry (tga);
7793
7794 /* Move dynamic linking info to the function descriptor sym. */
7795 if (tga != NULL)
7796 func_desc_adjust (tga, info);
7797 tga_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
7798 false, false, true);
7799 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (tga_fd);
7800
7801 desc = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_desc",
7802 false, false, true);
7803 htab->tga_desc = ppc_elf_hash_entry (desc);
7804 if (desc != NULL)
7805 func_desc_adjust (desc, info);
7806 desc_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_desc",
7807 false, false, true);
7808 htab->tga_desc_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (desc_fd);
7809
7810 if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
7811 {
7812 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *opt_fd;
7813
7814 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_opt",
7815 false, false, true);
7816 if (opt != NULL)
7817 func_desc_adjust (opt, info);
7818 opt_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
7819 false, false, true);
7820 if (opt_fd != NULL
7821 && (opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7822 || opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
7823 {
7824 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
7825 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
7826 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
7827 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
7828 if (!(htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7829 && tga_fd != NULL
7830 && (tga_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7831 || tga_fd->needs_plt)
7832 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga_fd)
7833 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga_fd))))
7834 tga_fd = NULL;
7835 if (!(htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7836 && desc_fd != NULL
7837 && (desc_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7838 || desc_fd->needs_plt)
7839 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, desc_fd)
7840 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, desc_fd))))
7841 desc_fd = NULL;
7842
7843 if (tga_fd != NULL || desc_fd != NULL)
7844 {
7845 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
7846
7847 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7848 for (ent = tga_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7849 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7850 break;
7851 if (ent == NULL && desc_fd != NULL)
7852 for (ent = desc_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7853 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7854 break;
7855 if (ent != NULL)
7856 {
7857 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7858 {
7859 tga_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7860 tga_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7861 tga_fd->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7862 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, tga_fd);
7863 }
7864 if (desc_fd != NULL)
7865 {
7866 desc_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7867 desc_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7868 desc_fd->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7869 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, desc_fd);
7870 }
7871 opt_fd->mark = 1;
7872 if (opt_fd->dynindx != -1)
7873 {
7874 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
7875 opt_fd->dynindx = -1;
7876 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
7877 opt_fd->dynstr_index);
7878 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt_fd))
7879 return false;
7880 }
7881 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7882 {
7883 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt_fd);
7884 tga = elf_hash_entry (htab->tls_get_addr);
7885 if (opt != NULL && tga != NULL)
7886 {
7887 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7888 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7889 tga->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7890 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
7891 opt->mark = 1;
7892 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7893 tga->forced_local);
7894 htab->tls_get_addr = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt);
7895 }
7896 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->oh = htab->tls_get_addr;
7897 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7898 if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7899 {
7900 htab->tls_get_addr->oh = htab->tls_get_addr_fd;
7901 htab->tls_get_addr->is_func = 1;
7902 }
7903 }
7904 if (desc_fd != NULL)
7905 {
7906 htab->tga_desc_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt_fd);
7907 if (opt != NULL && desc != NULL)
7908 {
7909 desc->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7910 desc->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7911 desc->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7912 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, desc);
7913 opt->mark = 1;
7914 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7915 desc->forced_local);
7916 htab->tga_desc = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt);
7917 }
7918 htab->tga_desc_fd->oh = htab->tga_desc;
7919 htab->tga_desc_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7920 if (htab->tga_desc != NULL)
7921 {
7922 htab->tga_desc->oh = htab->tga_desc_fd;
7923 htab->tga_desc->is_func = 1;
7924 }
7925 }
7926 }
7927 }
7928 }
7929 else if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt < 0)
7930 htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt = 0;
7931 }
7932
7933 if (htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
7934 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
7935 && htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave == -1)
7936 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave = 0;
7937
7938 return true;
7939 }
7940
7941 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
7942 any of HASH1, HASH2, HASH3, or HASH4. */
7943
7944 static bool
7945 branch_reloc_hash_match (bfd *ibfd,
7946 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7947 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash1,
7948 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash2,
7949 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash3,
7950 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash4)
7951 {
7952 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7953 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7954 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7955
7956 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7957 {
7958 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
7959 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7960
7961 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
7962 h = elf_follow_link (h);
7963 if (h == elf_hash_entry (hash1)
7964 || h == elf_hash_entry (hash2)
7965 || h == elf_hash_entry (hash3)
7966 || h == elf_hash_entry (hash4))
7967 return true;
7968 }
7969 return false;
7970 }
7971
7972 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
7973 opportunities. The linker has been hacked (see ppc64elf.em) to do
7974 a preliminary section layout so that we know the TLS segment
7975 offsets. We can't optimize earlier because some optimizations need
7976 to know the tp offset, and we need to optimize before allocating
7977 dynamic relocations. */
7978
7979 bool
7980 ppc64_elf_tls_optimize (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7981 {
7982 bfd *ibfd;
7983 asection *sec;
7984 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7985 unsigned char *toc_ref;
7986 int pass;
7987
7988 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
7989 return true;
7990
7991 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7992 if (htab == NULL)
7993 return false;
7994
7995 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
7996
7997 /* Make two passes over the relocs. On the first pass, mark toc
7998 entries involved with tls relocs, and check that tls relocs
7999 involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed followed by
8000 such a call. If they are not, we can't do any tls optimization.
8001 On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to notify
8002 relocate_section that optimization can be done, and adjust got
8003 and plt refcounts. */
8004 toc_ref = NULL;
8005 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
8006 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
8007 {
8008 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = NULL;
8009 asection *toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
8010
8011 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8012 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
8013 {
8014 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
8015 bool found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
8016
8017 /* Read the relocations. */
8018 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8019 info->keep_memory);
8020 if (relstart == NULL)
8021 {
8022 free (toc_ref);
8023 return false;
8024 }
8025
8026 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
8027 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
8028 {
8029 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8030 unsigned long r_symndx;
8031 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8032 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8033 asection *sym_sec;
8034 unsigned char *tls_mask;
8035 unsigned int tls_set, tls_clear, tls_type = 0;
8036 bfd_vma value;
8037 bool ok_tprel, is_local;
8038 long toc_ref_index = 0;
8039 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
8040 bool ret = false;
8041
8042 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8043 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_mask, &locsyms,
8044 r_symndx, ibfd))
8045 {
8046 err_free_rel:
8047 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8048 free (relstart);
8049 free (toc_ref);
8050 if (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents
8051 != (unsigned char *) locsyms)
8052 free (locsyms);
8053 return ret;
8054 }
8055
8056 if (h != NULL)
8057 {
8058 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8059 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8060 value = h->root.u.def.value;
8061 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8062 value = 0;
8063 else
8064 {
8065 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
8066 continue;
8067 }
8068 }
8069 else
8070 /* Symbols referenced by TLS relocs must be of type
8071 STT_TLS. So no need for .opd local sym adjust. */
8072 value = sym->st_value;
8073
8074 ok_tprel = false;
8075 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
8076 if (is_local)
8077 {
8078 if (h != NULL
8079 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8080 ok_tprel = true;
8081 else if (sym_sec != NULL
8082 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
8083 {
8084 value += sym_sec->output_offset;
8085 value += sym_sec->output_section->vma;
8086 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8087 /* Note that even though the prefix insns
8088 allow a 1<<33 offset we use the same test
8089 as for addis;addi. There may be a mix of
8090 pcrel and non-pcrel code and the decision
8091 to optimise is per symbol, not per TLS
8092 sequence. */
8093 ok_tprel = value + 0x80008000ULL < 1ULL << 32;
8094 }
8095 }
8096
8097 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8098 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8099 without marker relocs, then check that each
8100 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
8101 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
8102 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
8103 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
8104 if (pass == 0
8105 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
8106 && h != NULL
8107 && is_tls_get_addr (h, htab)
8108 && !found_tls_get_addr_arg
8109 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
8110 {
8111 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
8112 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8113 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8114 ret = true;
8115 goto err_free_rel;
8116 }
8117
8118 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
8119 switch (r_type)
8120 {
8121 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
8122 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8123 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
8124 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
8125 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8126 /* Fall through. */
8127
8128 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
8129 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8130 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
8131 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
8132 that turns out to be the case. */
8133 if (!is_local)
8134 continue;
8135
8136 /* LD -> LE */
8137 tls_set = 0;
8138 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8139 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
8140 break;
8141
8142 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
8143 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8144 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
8145 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
8146 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8147 /* Fall through. */
8148
8149 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
8150 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8151 if (ok_tprel)
8152 /* GD -> LE */
8153 tls_set = 0;
8154 else
8155 /* GD -> IE */
8156 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
8157 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8158 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
8159 break;
8160
8161 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
8162 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
8163 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
8164 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
8165 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8166 if (ok_tprel)
8167 {
8168 /* IE -> LE */
8169 tls_set = 0;
8170 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
8171 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
8172 break;
8173 }
8174 continue;
8175
8176 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
8177 if (!is_local)
8178 continue;
8179 /* Fall through. */
8180 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
8181 if (rel + 1 < relend
8182 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
8183 {
8184 if (pass != 0
8185 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
8186 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ)
8187 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
8188 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC))
8189 {
8190 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
8191 if (!get_sym_h (&h, NULL, NULL, NULL, &locsyms,
8192 r_symndx, ibfd))
8193 goto err_free_rel;
8194 if (h != NULL)
8195 {
8196 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8197
8198 for (ent = h->plt.plist;
8199 ent != NULL;
8200 ent = ent->next)
8201 if (ent->addend == rel[1].r_addend)
8202 break;
8203
8204 if (ent != NULL
8205 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8206 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8207 }
8208 }
8209 continue;
8210 }
8211 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8212 /* Fall through. */
8213
8214 case R_PPC64_TLS:
8215 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8216 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8217 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec != toc)
8218 continue;
8219
8220 /* Mark this toc entry as referenced by a TLS
8221 code sequence. We can do that now in the
8222 case of R_PPC64_TLS, and after checking for
8223 tls_get_addr for the TOC16 relocs. */
8224 if (toc_ref == NULL)
8225 toc_ref
8226 = bfd_zmalloc (toc->output_section->rawsize / 8);
8227 if (toc_ref == NULL)
8228 goto err_free_rel;
8229
8230 if (h != NULL)
8231 value = h->root.u.def.value;
8232 else
8233 value = sym->st_value;
8234 value += rel->r_addend;
8235 if (value % 8 != 0)
8236 continue;
8237 BFD_ASSERT (value < toc->size
8238 && toc->output_offset % 8 == 0);
8239 toc_ref_index = (value + toc->output_offset) / 8;
8240 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
8241 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
8242 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD)
8243 {
8244 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8245 continue;
8246 }
8247
8248 if (pass != 0 && toc_ref[toc_ref_index] == 0)
8249 continue;
8250
8251 tls_set = 0;
8252 tls_clear = 0;
8253 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
8254 break;
8255
8256 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
8257 if (pass == 0
8258 || sec != toc
8259 || toc_ref == NULL
8260 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8261 continue;
8262 if (ok_tprel)
8263 {
8264 /* IE -> LE */
8265 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8266 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
8267 break;
8268 }
8269 continue;
8270
8271 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
8272 if (pass == 0
8273 || sec != toc
8274 || toc_ref == NULL
8275 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8276 continue;
8277 if (rel + 1 < relend
8278 && (rel[1].r_info
8279 == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64))
8280 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
8281 {
8282 if (ok_tprel)
8283 /* GD -> LE */
8284 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD;
8285 else
8286 /* GD -> IE */
8287 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD | TLS_GDIE;
8288 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8289 }
8290 else
8291 {
8292 if (!is_local)
8293 continue;
8294
8295 /* LD -> LE */
8296 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8297 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8298 }
8299 break;
8300
8301 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
8302 if (pass == 0)
8303 {
8304 unsigned char buf[4];
8305 unsigned int insn;
8306 bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
8307 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
8308 off, 4))
8309 goto err_free_rel;
8310 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
8311 /* addis rt,13,imm */
8312 if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
8313 != ((15u << 26) | (13 << 16)))
8314 {
8315 /* xgettext:c-format */
8316 info->callbacks->minfo
8317 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
8318 ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA", insn);
8319 htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
8320 }
8321 }
8322 continue;
8323
8324 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
8325 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
8326 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
8327 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
8328 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
8329 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
8330 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
8331 /* These can all be used in sequences along with
8332 TPREL16_LO or TPREL16_LO_DS in ways we aren't
8333 able to verify easily. */
8334 htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
8335 continue;
8336
8337 default:
8338 continue;
8339 }
8340
8341 if (pass == 0)
8342 {
8343 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
8344 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
8345 continue;
8346
8347 if (rel + 1 < relend
8348 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
8349 htab->tls_get_addr_fd,
8350 htab->tga_desc_fd,
8351 htab->tls_get_addr,
8352 htab->tga_desc))
8353 {
8354 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
8355 {
8356 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
8357 unsigned char *toc_tls;
8358 int retval;
8359
8360 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, NULL, NULL,
8361 &locsyms,
8362 rel, ibfd);
8363 if (retval == 0)
8364 goto err_free_rel;
8365 if (toc_tls != NULL)
8366 {
8367 if ((*toc_tls & TLS_TLS) != 0
8368 && ((*toc_tls & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0))
8369 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8370 if (retval > 1)
8371 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8372 }
8373 }
8374 continue;
8375 }
8376
8377 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
8378 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
8379 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
8380 the entire optimization. */
8381 /* xgettext:c-format */
8382 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
8383 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8384 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8385 ret = true;
8386 goto err_free_rel;
8387 }
8388
8389 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8390 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
8391 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
8392 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
8393 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
8394 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
8395 Disable optimization in this case. */
8396 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
8397 && (tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0
8398 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
8399 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
8400 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
8401 continue;
8402
8403 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
8404 {
8405 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8406
8407 if (htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL)
8408 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8409 ent != NULL;
8410 ent = ent->next)
8411 if (ent->addend == 0)
8412 break;
8413
8414 if (ent == NULL && htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL)
8415 for (ent = htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8416 ent != NULL;
8417 ent = ent->next)
8418 if (ent->addend == 0)
8419 break;
8420
8421 if (ent == NULL && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
8422 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr->elf.plt.plist;
8423 ent != NULL;
8424 ent = ent->next)
8425 if (ent->addend == 0)
8426 break;
8427
8428 if (ent == NULL && htab->tga_desc != NULL)
8429 for (ent = htab->tga_desc->elf.plt.plist;
8430 ent != NULL;
8431 ent = ent->next)
8432 if (ent->addend == 0)
8433 break;
8434
8435 if (ent != NULL
8436 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8437 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8438 }
8439
8440 if (tls_clear == 0)
8441 continue;
8442
8443 if ((tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0)
8444 {
8445 struct got_entry *ent;
8446
8447 /* Adjust got entry for this reloc. */
8448 if (h != NULL)
8449 ent = h->got.glist;
8450 else
8451 ent = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd)[r_symndx];
8452
8453 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
8454 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
8455 && ent->owner == ibfd
8456 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
8457 break;
8458 if (ent == NULL)
8459 abort ();
8460
8461 if (tls_set == 0)
8462 {
8463 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
8464 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
8465 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
8466 }
8467 }
8468 else
8469 {
8470 /* If we got rid of a DTPMOD/DTPREL reloc pair then
8471 we'll lose one or two dyn relocs. */
8472 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
8473 NULL, h, sym))
8474 return false;
8475
8476 if (tls_set == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD))
8477 {
8478 if (!dec_dynrel_count ((rel + 1)->r_info, sec, info,
8479 NULL, h, sym))
8480 return false;
8481 }
8482 }
8483
8484 *tls_mask |= tls_set & 0xff;
8485 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
8486 }
8487
8488 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8489 free (relstart);
8490 }
8491
8492 if (locsyms != NULL
8493 && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
8494 {
8495 if (!info->keep_memory)
8496 free (locsyms);
8497 else
8498 elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents = (unsigned char *) locsyms;
8499 }
8500 }
8501
8502 free (toc_ref);
8503 return true;
8504 }
8505
8506 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_edit_toc to adjust
8507 the values of any global symbols in a toc section that has been
8508 edited. Globals in toc sections should be a rarity, so this function
8509 sets a flag if any are found in toc sections other than the one just
8510 edited, so that further hash table traversals can be avoided. */
8511
8512 struct adjust_toc_info
8513 {
8514 asection *toc;
8515 unsigned long *skip;
8516 bool global_toc_syms;
8517 };
8518
8519 enum toc_skip_enum { ref_from_discarded = 1, can_optimize = 2 };
8520
8521 static bool
8522 adjust_toc_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8523 {
8524 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
8525 struct adjust_toc_info *toc_inf = (struct adjust_toc_info *) inf;
8526 unsigned long i;
8527
8528 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
8529 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8530 return true;
8531
8532 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
8533 if (eh->adjust_done)
8534 return true;
8535
8536 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.section == toc_inf->toc)
8537 {
8538 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.value > toc_inf->toc->rawsize)
8539 i = toc_inf->toc->rawsize >> 3;
8540 else
8541 i = eh->elf.root.u.def.value >> 3;
8542
8543 if ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
8544 {
8545 _bfd_error_handler
8546 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"), eh->elf.root.root.string);
8547 do
8548 ++i;
8549 while ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0);
8550 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
8551 }
8552
8553 eh->elf.root.u.def.value -= toc_inf->skip[i];
8554 eh->adjust_done = 1;
8555 }
8556 else if (strcmp (eh->elf.root.u.def.section->name, ".toc") == 0)
8557 toc_inf->global_toc_syms = true;
8558
8559 return true;
8560 }
8561
8562 /* Return TRUE iff INSN with a relocation of R_TYPE is one we expect
8563 on a _LO variety toc/got reloc. */
8564
8565 static bool
8566 ok_lo_toc_insn (unsigned int insn, enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
8567 {
8568 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */
8569 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
8570 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
8571 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
8572 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
8573 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
8574 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
8575 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
8576 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
8577 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
8578 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
8579 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
8580 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
8581 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
8582 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
8583 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq,lfq */
8584 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lxsd,lxssp,lfdp */
8585 /* Exclude lfqu by testing reloc. If relocs are ever
8586 defined for the reduced D field in psq_lu then those
8587 will need testing too. */
8588 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8589 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,lwa */
8590 && (insn & 1) == 0)
8591 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 60u << 26 /* stfq */
8592 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* lxv,stx{v,sd,ssp},stfdp */
8593 /* Exclude stfqu. psq_stu as above for psq_lu. */
8594 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8595 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stq */
8596 && (insn & 1) == 0));
8597 }
8598
8599 /* PCREL_OPT in one instance flags to the linker that a pair of insns:
8600 pld ra,symbol@got@pcrel
8601 load/store rt,off(ra)
8602 or
8603 pla ra,symbol@pcrel
8604 load/store rt,off(ra)
8605 may be translated to
8606 pload/pstore rt,symbol+off@pcrel
8607 nop.
8608 This function returns true if the optimization is possible, placing
8609 the prefix insn in *PINSN1, a NOP in *PINSN2 and the offset in *POFF.
8610
8611 On entry to this function, the linker has already determined that
8612 the pld can be replaced with pla: *PINSN1 is that pla insn,
8613 while *PINSN2 is the second instruction. */
8614
8615 static bool
8616 xlate_pcrel_opt (uint64_t *pinsn1, uint64_t *pinsn2, bfd_signed_vma *poff)
8617 {
8618 uint64_t insn1 = *pinsn1;
8619 uint64_t insn2 = *pinsn2;
8620 bfd_signed_vma off;
8621
8622 if ((insn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
8623 {
8624 /* Check that regs match. */
8625 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8626 return false;
8627
8628 /* P8LS or PMLS form, non-pcrel. */
8629 if ((insn2 & (-1ULL << 50) & ~(1ULL << 56)) != (1ULL << 58))
8630 return false;
8631
8632 *pinsn1 = (insn2 & ~(31 << 16) & ~0x3ffff0000ffffULL) | (1ULL << 52);
8633 *pinsn2 = PNOP;
8634 off = ((insn2 >> 16) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) | (insn2 & 0xffff);
8635 *poff = (off ^ 0x200000000ULL) - 0x200000000ULL;
8636 return true;
8637 }
8638
8639 insn2 >>= 32;
8640
8641 /* Check that regs match. */
8642 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8643 return false;
8644
8645 switch ((insn2 >> 26) & 63)
8646 {
8647 default:
8648 return false;
8649
8650 case 32: /* lwz */
8651 case 34: /* lbz */
8652 case 36: /* stw */
8653 case 38: /* stb */
8654 case 40: /* lhz */
8655 case 42: /* lha */
8656 case 44: /* sth */
8657 case 48: /* lfs */
8658 case 50: /* lfd */
8659 case 52: /* stfs */
8660 case 54: /* stfd */
8661 /* These are the PMLS cases, where we just need to tack a prefix
8662 on the insn. */
8663 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
8664 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8665 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8666 break;
8667
8668 case 58: /* lwa, ld */
8669 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8670 return false;
8671 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8672 | (insn2 & 2 ? 41ULL << 26 : 57ULL << 26)
8673 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8674 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8675 break;
8676
8677 case 57: /* lxsd, lxssp */
8678 if ((insn2 & 3) < 2)
8679 return false;
8680 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8681 | ((40ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8682 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8683 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8684 break;
8685
8686 case 61: /* stxsd, stxssp, lxv, stxv */
8687 if ((insn2 & 3) == 0)
8688 return false;
8689 else if ((insn2 & 3) >= 2)
8690 {
8691 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8692 | ((44ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8693 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8694 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8695 }
8696 else
8697 {
8698 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8699 | ((50ULL | (insn2 & 4) | ((insn2 & 8) >> 3)) << 26)
8700 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8701 off = insn2 & 0xfff0;
8702 }
8703 break;
8704
8705 case 56: /* lq */
8706 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8707 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8708 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8709 break;
8710
8711 case 6: /* lxvp, stxvp */
8712 if ((insn2 & 0xe) != 0)
8713 return false;
8714 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8715 | ((insn2 & 1) == 0 ? 58ULL << 26 : 62ULL << 26)
8716 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8717 off = insn2 & 0xfff0;
8718 break;
8719
8720 case 62: /* std, stq */
8721 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8722 return false;
8723 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8724 | ((insn2 & 2) == 0 ? 61ULL << 26 : 60ULL << 26)
8725 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8726 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8727 break;
8728 }
8729
8730 *pinsn1 = insn1;
8731 *pinsn2 = (uint64_t) NOP << 32;
8732 *poff = (off ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8733 return true;
8734 }
8735
8736 /* Examine all relocs referencing .toc sections in order to remove
8737 unused .toc entries. */
8738
8739 bool
8740 ppc64_elf_edit_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
8741 {
8742 bfd *ibfd;
8743 struct adjust_toc_info toc_inf;
8744 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8745
8746 htab->do_toc_opt = 1;
8747 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = true;
8748 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
8749 {
8750 asection *toc, *sec;
8751 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8752 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
8753 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *toc_relocs;
8754 unsigned long *skip, *drop;
8755 unsigned char *used;
8756 unsigned char *keep, last, some_unused;
8757
8758 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
8759 continue;
8760
8761 toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
8762 if (toc == NULL
8763 || toc->size == 0
8764 || toc->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS
8765 || discarded_section (toc))
8766 continue;
8767
8768 toc_relocs = NULL;
8769 local_syms = NULL;
8770 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
8771
8772 /* Look at sections dropped from the final link. */
8773 skip = NULL;
8774 relstart = NULL;
8775 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8776 {
8777 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8778 || !discarded_section (sec)
8779 || get_opd_info (sec)
8780 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8781 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8782 continue;
8783
8784 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, false);
8785 if (relstart == NULL)
8786 goto error_ret;
8787
8788 /* Run through the relocs to see which toc entries might be
8789 unused. */
8790 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8791 {
8792 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8793 unsigned long r_symndx;
8794 asection *sym_sec;
8795 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8796 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8797 bfd_vma val;
8798
8799 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8800 switch (r_type)
8801 {
8802 default:
8803 continue;
8804
8805 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8806 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8807 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8808 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8809 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8810 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8811 break;
8812 }
8813
8814 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8815 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8816 r_symndx, ibfd))
8817 goto error_ret;
8818
8819 if (sym_sec != toc)
8820 continue;
8821
8822 if (h != NULL)
8823 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8824 else
8825 val = sym->st_value;
8826 val += rel->r_addend;
8827
8828 if (val >= toc->size)
8829 continue;
8830
8831 /* Anything in the toc ought to be aligned to 8 bytes.
8832 If not, don't mark as unused. */
8833 if (val & 7)
8834 continue;
8835
8836 if (skip == NULL)
8837 {
8838 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8839 if (skip == NULL)
8840 goto error_ret;
8841 }
8842
8843 skip[val >> 3] = ref_from_discarded;
8844 }
8845
8846 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8847 free (relstart);
8848 }
8849
8850 /* For largetoc loads of address constants, we can convert
8851 . addis rx,2,addr@got@ha
8852 . ld ry,addr@got@l(rx)
8853 to
8854 . addis rx,2,addr@toc@ha
8855 . addi ry,rx,addr@toc@l
8856 when addr is within 2G of the toc pointer. This then means
8857 that the word storing "addr" in the toc is no longer needed. */
8858
8859 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_small_toc_reloc
8860 && toc->output_section->rawsize < (bfd_vma) 1 << 31
8861 && toc->reloc_count != 0)
8862 {
8863 /* Read toc relocs. */
8864 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8865 info->keep_memory);
8866 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8867 goto error_ret;
8868
8869 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8870 {
8871 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8872 unsigned long r_symndx;
8873 asection *sym_sec;
8874 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8875 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8876 bfd_vma val, addr;
8877
8878 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8879 if (r_type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
8880 continue;
8881
8882 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8883 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8884 r_symndx, ibfd))
8885 goto error_ret;
8886
8887 if (sym_sec == NULL
8888 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
8889 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
8890 continue;
8891
8892 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8893 continue;
8894
8895 if (h != NULL)
8896 {
8897 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8898 continue;
8899 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8900 }
8901 else
8902 {
8903 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8904 continue;
8905 val = sym->st_value;
8906 }
8907 val += rel->r_addend;
8908 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
8909
8910 /* We don't yet know the exact toc pointer value, but we
8911 know it will be somewhere in the toc section. Don't
8912 optimize if the difference from any possible toc
8913 pointer is outside [ff..f80008000, 7fff7fff]. */
8914 addr = toc->output_section->vma + TOC_BASE_OFF;
8915 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8916 continue;
8917
8918 addr = toc->output_section->vma + toc->output_section->rawsize;
8919 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8920 continue;
8921
8922 if (skip == NULL)
8923 {
8924 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8925 if (skip == NULL)
8926 goto error_ret;
8927 }
8928
8929 skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8930 |= can_optimize | ((rel - toc_relocs) << 2);
8931 }
8932 }
8933
8934 if (skip == NULL)
8935 continue;
8936
8937 used = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*used) * (toc->size + 7) / 8);
8938 if (used == NULL)
8939 {
8940 error_ret:
8941 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8942 free (local_syms);
8943 if (sec != NULL
8944 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8945 free (relstart);
8946 if (elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8947 free (toc_relocs);
8948 free (skip);
8949 return false;
8950 }
8951
8952 /* Now check all kept sections that might reference the toc.
8953 Check the toc itself last. */
8954 for (sec = (ibfd->sections == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8955 : ibfd->sections);
8956 sec != NULL;
8957 sec = (sec == toc ? NULL
8958 : sec->next == NULL ? toc
8959 : sec->next == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8960 : sec->next))
8961 {
8962 int repeat;
8963
8964 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8965 || discarded_section (sec)
8966 || get_opd_info (sec)
8967 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8968 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8969 continue;
8970
8971 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8972 info->keep_memory);
8973 if (relstart == NULL)
8974 {
8975 free (used);
8976 goto error_ret;
8977 }
8978
8979 /* Mark toc entries referenced as used. */
8980 do
8981 {
8982 repeat = 0;
8983 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8984 {
8985 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8986 unsigned long r_symndx;
8987 asection *sym_sec;
8988 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8989 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8990 bfd_vma val;
8991
8992 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8993 switch (r_type)
8994 {
8995 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8996 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8997 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8998 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8999 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
9000 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9001 /* In case we're taking addresses of toc entries. */
9002 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
9003 break;
9004
9005 default:
9006 continue;
9007 }
9008
9009 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9010 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9011 r_symndx, ibfd))
9012 {
9013 free (used);
9014 goto error_ret;
9015 }
9016
9017 if (sym_sec != toc)
9018 continue;
9019
9020 if (h != NULL)
9021 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9022 else
9023 val = sym->st_value;
9024 val += rel->r_addend;
9025
9026 if (val >= toc->size)
9027 continue;
9028
9029 if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
9030 {
9031 bfd_vma off;
9032 unsigned char opc;
9033
9034 switch (r_type)
9035 {
9036 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9037 break;
9038
9039 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9040 off = rel->r_offset;
9041 off += (bfd_big_endian (ibfd) ? -2 : 3);
9042 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, &opc,
9043 off, 1))
9044 {
9045 free (used);
9046 goto error_ret;
9047 }
9048 if ((opc & (0x3f << 2)) == (58u << 2))
9049 break;
9050 /* Fall through. */
9051
9052 default:
9053 /* Wrong sort of reloc, or not a ld. We may
9054 as well clear ref_from_discarded too. */
9055 skip[val >> 3] = 0;
9056 }
9057 }
9058
9059 if (sec != toc)
9060 used[val >> 3] = 1;
9061 /* For the toc section, we only mark as used if this
9062 entry itself isn't unused. */
9063 else if ((used[rel->r_offset >> 3]
9064 || !(skip[rel->r_offset >> 3] & ref_from_discarded))
9065 && !used[val >> 3])
9066 {
9067 /* Do all the relocs again, to catch reference
9068 chains. */
9069 repeat = 1;
9070 used[val >> 3] = 1;
9071 }
9072 }
9073 }
9074 while (repeat);
9075
9076 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9077 free (relstart);
9078 }
9079
9080 /* Merge the used and skip arrays. Assume that TOC
9081 doublewords not appearing as either used or unused belong
9082 to an entry more than one doubleword in size. */
9083 for (drop = skip, keep = used, last = 0, some_unused = 0;
9084 drop < skip + (toc->size + 7) / 8;
9085 ++drop, ++keep)
9086 {
9087 if (*keep)
9088 {
9089 *drop &= ~ref_from_discarded;
9090 if ((*drop & can_optimize) != 0)
9091 some_unused = 1;
9092 last = 0;
9093 }
9094 else if ((*drop & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
9095 {
9096 some_unused = 1;
9097 last = ref_from_discarded;
9098 }
9099 else
9100 *drop = last;
9101 }
9102
9103 free (used);
9104
9105 if (some_unused)
9106 {
9107 bfd_byte *contents, *src;
9108 unsigned long off;
9109 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9110 bool local_toc_syms = false;
9111
9112 /* Shuffle the toc contents, and at the same time convert the
9113 skip array from booleans into offsets. */
9114 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, toc, &contents))
9115 goto error_ret;
9116
9117 elf_section_data (toc)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
9118
9119 for (src = contents, off = 0, drop = skip;
9120 src < contents + toc->size;
9121 src += 8, ++drop)
9122 {
9123 if ((*drop & (can_optimize | ref_from_discarded)) != 0)
9124 off += 8;
9125 else if (off != 0)
9126 {
9127 *drop = off;
9128 memcpy (src - off, src, 8);
9129 }
9130 }
9131 *drop = off;
9132 toc->rawsize = toc->size;
9133 toc->size = src - contents - off;
9134
9135 /* Adjust addends for relocs against the toc section sym,
9136 and optimize any accesses we can. */
9137 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9138 {
9139 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9140 || discarded_section (sec))
9141 continue;
9142
9143 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9144 info->keep_memory);
9145 if (relstart == NULL)
9146 goto error_ret;
9147
9148 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9149 {
9150 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9151 unsigned long r_symndx;
9152 asection *sym_sec;
9153 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9154 bfd_vma val;
9155
9156 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9157 switch (r_type)
9158 {
9159 default:
9160 continue;
9161
9162 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
9163 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9164 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
9165 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9166 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
9167 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9168 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
9169 break;
9170 }
9171
9172 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9173 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9174 r_symndx, ibfd))
9175 goto error_ret;
9176
9177 if (sym_sec != toc)
9178 continue;
9179
9180 if (h != NULL)
9181 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9182 else
9183 {
9184 val = sym->st_value;
9185 if (val != 0)
9186 local_toc_syms = true;
9187 }
9188
9189 val += rel->r_addend;
9190
9191 if (val > toc->rawsize)
9192 val = toc->rawsize;
9193 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
9194 continue;
9195 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
9196 {
9197 Elf_Internal_Rela *tocrel
9198 = toc_relocs + (skip[val >> 3] >> 2);
9199 unsigned long tsym = ELF64_R_SYM (tocrel->r_info);
9200
9201 switch (r_type)
9202 {
9203 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9204 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
9205 break;
9206
9207 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9208 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT);
9209 break;
9210
9211 default:
9212 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
9213 ppc_howto_init ();
9214 info->callbacks->einfo
9215 /* xgettext:c-format */
9216 (_("%H: %s references "
9217 "optimized away TOC entry\n"),
9218 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
9219 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
9220 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9221 goto error_ret;
9222 }
9223 rel->r_addend = tocrel->r_addend;
9224 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
9225 continue;
9226 }
9227
9228 if (h != NULL || sym->st_value != 0)
9229 continue;
9230
9231 rel->r_addend -= skip[val >> 3];
9232 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
9233 }
9234
9235 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9236 free (relstart);
9237 }
9238
9239 /* We shouldn't have local or global symbols defined in the TOC,
9240 but handle them anyway. */
9241 if (local_syms != NULL)
9242 for (sym = local_syms;
9243 sym < local_syms + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9244 ++sym)
9245 if (sym->st_value != 0
9246 && bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx) == toc)
9247 {
9248 unsigned long i;
9249
9250 if (sym->st_value > toc->rawsize)
9251 i = toc->rawsize >> 3;
9252 else
9253 i = sym->st_value >> 3;
9254
9255 if ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
9256 {
9257 if (local_toc_syms)
9258 _bfd_error_handler
9259 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"),
9260 bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym, NULL));
9261 do
9262 ++i;
9263 while ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)));
9264 sym->st_value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
9265 }
9266
9267 sym->st_value -= skip[i];
9268 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9269 }
9270
9271 /* Adjust any global syms defined in this toc input section. */
9272 if (toc_inf.global_toc_syms)
9273 {
9274 toc_inf.toc = toc;
9275 toc_inf.skip = skip;
9276 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = false;
9277 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_toc_syms,
9278 &toc_inf);
9279 }
9280
9281 if (toc->reloc_count != 0)
9282 {
9283 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9284 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
9285 bfd_size_type sz;
9286
9287 /* Remove unused toc relocs, and adjust those we keep. */
9288 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
9289 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
9290 info->keep_memory);
9291 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
9292 goto error_ret;
9293
9294 wrel = toc_relocs;
9295 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
9296 if ((skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
9297 & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) == 0)
9298 {
9299 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset - skip[rel->r_offset >> 3];
9300 wrel->r_info = rel->r_info;
9301 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
9302 ++wrel;
9303 }
9304 else if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, toc, info,
9305 &local_syms, NULL, NULL))
9306 goto error_ret;
9307
9308 elf_section_data (toc)->relocs = toc_relocs;
9309 toc->reloc_count = wrel - toc_relocs;
9310 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (toc);
9311 sz = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9312 rel_hdr->sh_size = toc->reloc_count * sz;
9313 }
9314 }
9315 else if (elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
9316 free (toc_relocs);
9317
9318 if (local_syms != NULL
9319 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9320 {
9321 if (!info->keep_memory)
9322 free (local_syms);
9323 else
9324 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9325 }
9326 free (skip);
9327 }
9328
9329 /* Look for cases where we can change an indirect GOT access to
9330 a GOT relative or PC relative access, possibly reducing the
9331 number of GOT entries. */
9332 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9333 {
9334 asection *sec;
9335 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9336 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
9337 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
9338 bfd_vma got;
9339
9340 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9341 continue;
9342
9343 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_optrel)
9344 continue;
9345
9346 sec = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9347 got = 0;
9348 if (sec != NULL)
9349 got = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
9350
9351 local_syms = NULL;
9352 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9353
9354 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9355 {
9356 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9357 || !ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel
9358 || discarded_section (sec))
9359 continue;
9360
9361 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9362 info->keep_memory);
9363 if (relstart == NULL)
9364 {
9365 got_error_ret:
9366 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9367 free (local_syms);
9368 if (sec != NULL
9369 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9370 free (relstart);
9371 return false;
9372 }
9373
9374 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9375 {
9376 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9377 unsigned long r_symndx;
9378 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9379 asection *sym_sec;
9380 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9381 struct got_entry *ent;
9382 bfd_vma val, pc;
9383 unsigned char buf[8];
9384 unsigned int insn;
9385 enum {no_check, check_lo, check_ha} insn_check;
9386
9387 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9388 switch (r_type)
9389 {
9390 default:
9391 insn_check = no_check;
9392 break;
9393
9394 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
9395 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
9396 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
9397 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
9398 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
9399 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9400 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9401 insn_check = check_ha;
9402 break;
9403
9404 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
9405 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
9406 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
9407 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
9408 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
9409 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
9410 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
9411 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9412 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9413 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9414 insn_check = check_lo;
9415 break;
9416 }
9417
9418 if (insn_check != no_check)
9419 {
9420 bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
9421
9422 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf, off, 4))
9423 goto got_error_ret;
9424
9425 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9426 if (insn_check == check_lo
9427 ? !ok_lo_toc_insn (insn, r_type)
9428 : ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9429 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9430 {
9431 char str[12];
9432
9433 ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->unexpected_toc_insn = 1;
9434 sprintf (str, "%#08x", insn);
9435 info->callbacks->einfo
9436 /* xgettext:c-format */
9437 (_("%H: got/toc optimization is not supported for"
9438 " %s instruction\n"),
9439 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset & ~3, str);
9440 continue;
9441 }
9442 }
9443
9444 switch (r_type)
9445 {
9446 /* Note that we don't delete GOT entries for
9447 R_PPC64_GOT16_DS since we'd need a lot more
9448 analysis. For starters, the preliminary layout is
9449 before the GOT, PLT, dynamic sections and stubs are
9450 laid out. Then we'd need to allow for changes in
9451 distance between sections caused by alignment. */
9452 default:
9453 continue;
9454
9455 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9456 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9457 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9458 break;
9459 }
9460
9461 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9462 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9463 r_symndx, ibfd))
9464 goto got_error_ret;
9465
9466 if (sym_sec == NULL
9467 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
9468 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
9469 continue;
9470
9471 if ((h ? h->type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9472 continue;
9473
9474 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9475 continue;
9476
9477 if (h != NULL)
9478 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9479 else
9480 val = sym->st_value;
9481 val += rel->r_addend;
9482 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
9483
9484 /* Fudge factor to allow for the fact that the preliminary layout
9485 isn't exact. Reduce limits by this factor. */
9486 #define LIMIT_ADJUST(LIMIT) ((LIMIT) - (LIMIT) / 16)
9487
9488 switch (r_type)
9489 {
9490 default:
9491 continue;
9492
9493 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9494 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9495 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9496 continue;
9497
9498 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9499 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9500 goto got_error_ret;
9501 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9502 if (((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9503 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9504 continue;
9505 break;
9506
9507 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9508 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9509 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9510 continue;
9511 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9512 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9513 goto got_error_ret;
9514 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9515 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) != 58u << 26 /* ld */)
9516 continue;
9517 break;
9518
9519 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9520 pc = rel->r_offset;
9521 pc += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9522 if (val - pc + LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 33)
9523 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 34))
9524 continue;
9525 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9526 rel->r_offset & ~3, 8))
9527 goto got_error_ret;
9528 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9529 if ((insn & (-1u << 18)) != ((1u << 26) | (1u << 20)))
9530 continue;
9531 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf + 4);
9532 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 57u << 26)
9533 continue;
9534 break;
9535 }
9536 #undef LIMIT_ADJUST
9537
9538 if (h != NULL)
9539 ent = h->got.glist;
9540 else
9541 {
9542 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9543 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
9544 }
9545 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9546 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
9547 && ent->owner == ibfd
9548 && ent->tls_type == 0)
9549 break;
9550 BFD_ASSERT (ent && ent->got.refcount > 0);
9551 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
9552 }
9553
9554 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9555 free (relstart);
9556 }
9557
9558 if (local_syms != NULL
9559 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9560 {
9561 if (!info->keep_memory)
9562 free (local_syms);
9563 else
9564 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9565 }
9566 }
9567
9568 return true;
9569 }
9570
9571 /* Return true iff input section I references the TOC using
9572 instructions limited to +/-32k offsets. */
9573
9574 bool
9575 ppc64_elf_has_small_toc_reloc (asection *i)
9576 {
9577 return (is_ppc64_elf (i->owner)
9578 && ppc64_elf_tdata (i->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc);
9579 }
9580
9581 /* Allocate space for one GOT entry. */
9582
9583 static void
9584 allocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9585 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9586 struct got_entry *gent)
9587 {
9588 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9589 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
9590 int entsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)
9591 ? 16 : 8);
9592 int rentsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & TLS_GD
9593 ? 2 : 1) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9594 asection *got = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->got;
9595
9596 gent->got.offset = got->size;
9597 got->size += entsize;
9598
9599 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9600 {
9601 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rentsize;
9602 htab->got_reli_size += rentsize;
9603 }
9604 else if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
9605 && !(gent->tls_type != 0
9606 && bfd_link_executable (info)
9607 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9608 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9609 && h->dynindx != -1
9610 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9611 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9612 {
9613 asection *relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->relgot;
9614 relgot->size += rentsize;
9615 }
9616 }
9617
9618 /* This function merges got entries in the same toc group. */
9619
9620 static void
9621 merge_got_entries (struct got_entry **pent)
9622 {
9623 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
9624
9625 for (ent = *pent; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9626 if (!ent->is_indirect)
9627 for (ent2 = ent->next; ent2 != NULL; ent2 = ent2->next)
9628 if (!ent2->is_indirect
9629 && ent2->addend == ent->addend
9630 && ent2->tls_type == ent->tls_type
9631 && elf_gp (ent2->owner) == elf_gp (ent->owner))
9632 {
9633 ent2->is_indirect = true;
9634 ent2->got.ent = ent;
9635 }
9636 }
9637
9638 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
9639
9640 static bool
9641 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9642 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9643 {
9644 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
9645
9646 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
9647 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
9648 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
9649 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9650 && h->dynindx == -1
9651 && !h->forced_local
9652 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
9653 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
9654 return true;
9655 }
9656
9657 /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
9658 usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry. */
9659
9660 static inline
9661 bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9662 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9663 {
9664 return (h == NULL
9665 || h->dynindx == -1
9666 || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
9667 }
9668
9669 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
9670 dynamic relocs. */
9671
9672 static bool
9673 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9674 {
9675 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9676 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9677 asection *s;
9678 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
9679 struct got_entry **pgent, *gent;
9680
9681 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9682 return true;
9683
9684 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9685 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9686 if (htab == NULL)
9687 return false;
9688
9689 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
9690 /* Run through the TLS GD got entries first if we're changing them
9691 to TPREL. */
9692 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE))
9693 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9694 if (gent->got.refcount > 0
9695 && (gent->tls_type & TLS_GD) != 0)
9696 {
9697 /* This was a GD entry that has been converted to TPREL. If
9698 there happens to be a TPREL entry we can use that one. */
9699 struct got_entry *ent;
9700 for (ent = h->got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9701 if (ent->got.refcount > 0
9702 && (ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9703 && ent->addend == gent->addend
9704 && ent->owner == gent->owner)
9705 {
9706 gent->got.refcount = 0;
9707 break;
9708 }
9709
9710 /* If not, then we'll be using our own TPREL entry. */
9711 if (gent->got.refcount != 0)
9712 gent->tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
9713 }
9714
9715 /* Remove any list entry that won't generate a word in the GOT before
9716 we call merge_got_entries. Otherwise we risk merging to empty
9717 entries. */
9718 pgent = &h->got.glist;
9719 while ((gent = *pgent) != NULL)
9720 if (gent->got.refcount > 0)
9721 {
9722 if ((gent->tls_type & TLS_LD) != 0
9723 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9724 {
9725 ppc64_tlsld_got (gent->owner)->got.refcount += 1;
9726 *pgent = gent->next;
9727 }
9728 else
9729 pgent = &gent->next;
9730 }
9731 else
9732 *pgent = gent->next;
9733
9734 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
9735 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
9736
9737 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9738 if (!gent->is_indirect)
9739 {
9740 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol should
9741 be made dynamic. */
9742 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9743 return false;
9744
9745 if (!is_ppc64_elf (gent->owner))
9746 abort ();
9747
9748 allocate_got (h, info, gent);
9749 }
9750
9751 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
9752 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
9753 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9754 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9755 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9756
9757 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
9758 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
9759 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
9760 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9761
9762 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
9763 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
9764 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9765 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9766
9767 if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9768 {
9769 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p, **pp;
9770
9771 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
9772 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to
9773 be defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case,
9774 discard space for relocs that have become local due to symbol
9775 visibility changes. */
9776 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9777 {
9778 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call
9779 insn, or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that
9780 can be generated via assembly. We want calls to
9781 protected symbols to resolve directly to the function
9782 rather than going via the plt. If people want function
9783 pointer comparisons to work as expected then they should
9784 avoid writing weird assembly. */
9785 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
9786 {
9787 for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
9788 {
9789 p->count -= p->pc_count;
9790 p->pc_count = 0;
9791 if (p->count == 0)
9792 *pp = p->next;
9793 else
9794 pp = &p->next;
9795 }
9796 }
9797
9798 if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9799 {
9800 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9801 should be made dynamic. */
9802 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9803 return false;
9804 }
9805 }
9806
9807 /* For a fixed position executable, discard space for
9808 relocs against symbols which are not dynamic. */
9809 else if (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9810 {
9811 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
9812 && !h->def_regular
9813 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
9814 {
9815 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9816 should be made dynamic. */
9817 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9818 return false;
9819
9820 /* But if that didn't work out, discard dynamic relocs. */
9821 if (h->dynindx == -1)
9822 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9823 }
9824 else
9825 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9826 }
9827
9828 /* Finally, allocate space. */
9829 for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9830 {
9831 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9832 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9833 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
9834 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9835 }
9836 }
9837
9838 /* We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
9839 a) is dynamic, or
9840 b) is an ifunc, or
9841 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
9842 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
9843 if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
9844 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
9845 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
9846 || (h->needs_plt
9847 && h->def_regular
9848 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9849 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
9850 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
9851 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
9852 {
9853 struct plt_entry *pent;
9854 bool doneone = false;
9855 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9856 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0)
9857 {
9858 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9859 return false;
9860
9861 if (use_local_plt (info, h))
9862 {
9863 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9864 {
9865 s = htab->elf.iplt;
9866 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9867 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9868 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
9869 }
9870 else
9871 {
9872 s = htab->pltlocal;
9873 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9874 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9875 s = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9876 }
9877 }
9878 else
9879 {
9880 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
9881 first entry. */
9882 s = htab->elf.splt;
9883 if (s->size == 0)
9884 s->size += PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9885
9886 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9887
9888 /* Make room for this entry. */
9889 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9890
9891 /* Make room for the .glink code. */
9892 s = htab->glink;
9893 if (s->size == 0)
9894 s->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab);
9895 if (htab->opd_abi)
9896 {
9897 /* We need bigger stubs past index 32767. */
9898 if (s->size >= GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + 32768*2*4)
9899 s->size += 4;
9900 s->size += 2*4;
9901 }
9902 else
9903 s->size += 4;
9904
9905 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9906 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9907 }
9908 if (s != NULL)
9909 s->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9910 doneone = true;
9911 }
9912 else
9913 pent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9914 if (!doneone)
9915 {
9916 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9917 h->needs_plt = 0;
9918 }
9919 }
9920 else
9921 {
9922 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9923 h->needs_plt = 0;
9924 }
9925
9926 return true;
9927 }
9928
9929 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
9930 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
9931 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
9932 #define D34(v) \
9933 ((((v) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) << 16) | (v & 0xffff))
9934 #define HA34(v) ((v + (1ULL << 33)) >> 34)
9935
9936 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
9937 to set up space for global entry stubs. These are put in glink,
9938 after the branch table. */
9939
9940 static bool
9941 size_global_entry_stubs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9942 {
9943 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9944 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9945 struct plt_entry *pent;
9946 asection *s, *plt;
9947
9948 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9949 return true;
9950
9951 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9952 return true;
9953
9954 if (h->def_regular)
9955 return true;
9956
9957 info = inf;
9958 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9959 if (htab == NULL)
9960 return false;
9961
9962 s = htab->global_entry;
9963 plt = htab->elf.splt;
9964 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9965 if (pent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
9966 && pent->addend == 0)
9967 {
9968 /* For ELFv2, if this symbol is not defined in a regular file
9969 and we are not generating a shared library or pie, then we
9970 need to define the symbol in the executable on a call stub.
9971 This is to avoid text relocations. */
9972 bfd_vma off, stub_align, stub_off, stub_size;
9973 unsigned int align_power;
9974
9975 stub_size = 16;
9976 stub_off = s->size;
9977 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
9978 align_power = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9979 else
9980 align_power = -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9981 /* Setting section alignment is delayed until we know it is
9982 non-empty. Otherwise the .text output section will be
9983 aligned at least to plt_stub_align even when no global
9984 entry stubs are needed. */
9985 if (s->alignment_power < align_power)
9986 s->alignment_power = align_power;
9987 stub_align = (bfd_vma) 1 << align_power;
9988 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0
9989 || ((((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)
9990 - (stub_off & -stub_align))
9991 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)))
9992 stub_off = (stub_off + stub_align - 1) & -stub_align;
9993 off = pent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
9994 off -= stub_off + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
9995 /* Note that for --plt-stub-align negative we have a possible
9996 dependency between stub offset and size. Break that
9997 dependency by assuming the max stub size when calculating
9998 the stub offset. */
9999 if (PPC_HA (off) == 0)
10000 stub_size -= 4;
10001 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
10002 h->root.u.def.section = s;
10003 h->root.u.def.value = stub_off;
10004 s->size = stub_off + stub_size;
10005 break;
10006 }
10007 return true;
10008 }
10009
10010 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
10011
10012 static bool
10013 ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
10014 struct bfd_link_info *info)
10015 {
10016 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
10017 bfd *dynobj;
10018 asection *s;
10019 bool relocs;
10020 bfd *ibfd;
10021 struct got_entry *first_tlsld;
10022
10023 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
10024 if (htab == NULL)
10025 return false;
10026
10027 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
10028 if (dynobj == NULL)
10029 abort ();
10030
10031 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10032 {
10033 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
10034 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
10035 {
10036 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
10037 if (s == NULL)
10038 abort ();
10039 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
10040 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
10041 }
10042 }
10043
10044 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
10045 relocs. */
10046 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10047 {
10048 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
10049 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
10050 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
10051 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
10052 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
10053 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
10054 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10055
10056 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10057 continue;
10058
10059 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10060 {
10061 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
10062
10063 for (p = elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10064 {
10065 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
10066 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
10067 {
10068 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
10069 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
10070 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
10071 the relocs too. */
10072 }
10073 else if (p->count != 0)
10074 {
10075 asection *srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
10076 if (p->ifunc)
10077 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
10078 srel->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10079 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
10080 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
10081 }
10082 }
10083 }
10084
10085 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
10086 if (!lgot_ents)
10087 continue;
10088
10089 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
10090 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10091 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
10092 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
10093 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
10094 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
10095 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10096 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
10097 {
10098 struct got_entry **pent, *ent;
10099
10100 pent = lgot_ents;
10101 while ((ent = *pent) != NULL)
10102 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
10103 {
10104 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_LD) != 0)
10105 {
10106 ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd)->got.refcount += 1;
10107 *pent = ent->next;
10108 }
10109 else
10110 {
10111 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
10112 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10113
10114 ent->got.offset = s->size;
10115 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
10116 {
10117 ent_size *= 2;
10118 rel_size *= 2;
10119 }
10120 s->size += ent_size;
10121 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
10122 {
10123 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
10124 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
10125 }
10126 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
10127 && !(ent->tls_type != 0
10128 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
10129 {
10130 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10131 srel->size += rel_size;
10132 }
10133 pent = &ent->next;
10134 }
10135 }
10136 else
10137 *pent = ent->next;
10138 }
10139
10140 /* Allocate space for plt calls to local syms. */
10141 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
10142 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
10143 {
10144 struct plt_entry *ent;
10145
10146 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10147 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
10148 {
10149 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
10150 {
10151 s = htab->elf.iplt;
10152 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
10153 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
10154 htab->elf.irelplt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10155 }
10156 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
10157 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
10158 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10159 else
10160 {
10161 s = htab->pltlocal;
10162 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
10163 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
10164 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10165 htab->relpltlocal->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10166 }
10167 }
10168 else
10169 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10170 }
10171 }
10172
10173 /* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
10174 sym dynamic relocs. */
10175 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
10176
10177 if (!htab->opd_abi && !bfd_link_pic (info))
10178 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, size_global_entry_stubs, info);
10179
10180 first_tlsld = NULL;
10181 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10182 {
10183 struct got_entry *ent;
10184
10185 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10186 continue;
10187
10188 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
10189 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
10190 {
10191 if (!htab->do_multi_toc && first_tlsld != NULL)
10192 {
10193 ent->is_indirect = true;
10194 ent->got.ent = first_tlsld;
10195 }
10196 else
10197 {
10198 if (first_tlsld == NULL)
10199 first_tlsld = ent;
10200 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10201 ent->got.offset = s->size;
10202 ent->owner = ibfd;
10203 s->size += 16;
10204 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
10205 {
10206 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10207 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10208 }
10209 }
10210 }
10211 else
10212 ent->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10213 }
10214
10215 /* We now have determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
10216 Allocate memory for them. */
10217 relocs = false;
10218 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10219 {
10220 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
10221 continue;
10222
10223 if (s == htab->brlt || s == htab->relbrlt)
10224 /* These haven't been allocated yet; don't strip. */
10225 continue;
10226 else if (s == htab->elf.sgot
10227 || s == htab->elf.splt
10228 || s == htab->elf.iplt
10229 || s == htab->pltlocal
10230 || s == htab->glink
10231 || s == htab->global_entry
10232 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
10233 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
10234 {
10235 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
10236 comment below. */
10237 }
10238 else if (s == htab->glink_eh_frame)
10239 {
10240 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
10241 /* Not sized yet. */
10242 continue;
10243 }
10244 else if (startswith (s->name, ".rela"))
10245 {
10246 if (s->size != 0)
10247 {
10248 if (s != htab->elf.srelplt)
10249 relocs = true;
10250
10251 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
10252 to copy relocs into the output file. */
10253 s->reloc_count = 0;
10254 }
10255 }
10256 else
10257 {
10258 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
10259 continue;
10260 }
10261
10262 if (s->size == 0)
10263 {
10264 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
10265 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
10266 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
10267 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
10268 before the linker maps input sections to output
10269 sections. The linker does that before
10270 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
10271 function which decides whether anything needs to go
10272 into these sections. */
10273 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10274 continue;
10275 }
10276
10277 if (bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
10278 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: discarding dynamic section %s"),
10279 s->name);
10280
10281 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
10282 continue;
10283
10284 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. We use bfd_zalloc
10285 here in case unused entries are not reclaimed before the
10286 section's contents are written out. This should not happen,
10287 but this way if it does we get a R_PPC64_NONE reloc in .rela
10288 sections instead of garbage.
10289 We also rely on the section contents being zero when writing
10290 the GOT and .dynrelro. */
10291 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
10292 if (s->contents == NULL)
10293 return false;
10294 }
10295
10296 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10297 {
10298 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10299 continue;
10300
10301 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10302 if (s != NULL && s != htab->elf.sgot)
10303 {
10304 if (s->size == 0)
10305 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10306 else
10307 {
10308 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10309 if (s->contents == NULL)
10310 return false;
10311 }
10312 }
10313 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10314 if (s != NULL)
10315 {
10316 if (s->size == 0)
10317 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10318 else
10319 {
10320 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10321 if (s->contents == NULL)
10322 return false;
10323 relocs = true;
10324 s->reloc_count = 0;
10325 }
10326 }
10327 }
10328
10329 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10330 {
10331 bool tls_opt;
10332
10333 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
10334 values later, in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
10335 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
10336 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
10337 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
10338 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
10339 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
10340
10341 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
10342 {
10343 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
10344 return false;
10345 }
10346
10347 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
10348 {
10349 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
10350 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
10351 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
10352 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0)
10353 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_GLINK, 0))
10354 return false;
10355 }
10356
10357 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && abiversion (output_bfd) <= 1)
10358 {
10359 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPD, 0)
10360 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPDSZ, 0))
10361 return false;
10362 }
10363
10364 tls_opt = (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
10365 && ((htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
10366 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
10367 || (htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
10368 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL)));
10369 if (tls_opt || !htab->opd_abi)
10370 {
10371 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPT, tls_opt ? PPC64_OPT_TLS : 0))
10372 return false;
10373 }
10374
10375 if (relocs)
10376 {
10377 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
10378 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
10379 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)))
10380 return false;
10381
10382 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
10383 then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
10384 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
10385 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf,
10386 _bfd_elf_maybe_set_textrel, info);
10387
10388 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
10389 {
10390 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
10391 return false;
10392 }
10393 }
10394 }
10395 #undef add_dynamic_entry
10396
10397 return true;
10398 }
10399
10400 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
10401
10402 static bool
10403 ppc64_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
10404 {
10405 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
10406 && !h->def_regular
10407 && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
10408 return false;
10409
10410 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
10411 }
10412
10413 /* Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a call. */
10414
10415 static inline enum ppc_stub_type
10416 ppc_type_of_stub (asection *input_sec,
10417 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10418 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **hash,
10419 struct plt_entry **plt_ent,
10420 bfd_vma destination,
10421 unsigned long local_off)
10422 {
10423 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h = *hash;
10424 bfd_vma location;
10425 bfd_vma branch_offset;
10426 bfd_vma max_branch_offset;
10427 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
10428
10429 if (h != NULL)
10430 {
10431 struct plt_entry *ent;
10432 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = h;
10433 if (h->oh != NULL
10434 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
10435 {
10436 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
10437 *hash = fdh;
10438 }
10439
10440 for (ent = fdh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10441 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10442 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10443 {
10444 *plt_ent = ent;
10445 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10446 }
10447
10448 /* Here, we know we don't have a plt entry. If we don't have a
10449 either a defined function descriptor or a defined entry symbol
10450 in a regular object file, then it is pointless trying to make
10451 any other type of stub. */
10452 if (!is_static_defined (&fdh->elf)
10453 && !is_static_defined (&h->elf))
10454 return ppc_stub_none;
10455 }
10456 else if (elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) != NULL)
10457 {
10458 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_sec->owner);
10459 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
10460 elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10461 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10462
10463 if (local_plt[r_symndx] != NULL)
10464 {
10465 struct plt_entry *ent;
10466
10467 for (ent = local_plt[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10468 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10469 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10470 {
10471 *plt_ent = ent;
10472 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10473 }
10474 }
10475 }
10476
10477 /* Determine where the call point is. */
10478 location = (input_sec->output_offset
10479 + input_sec->output_section->vma
10480 + rel->r_offset);
10481
10482 branch_offset = destination - location;
10483 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10484
10485 /* Determine if a long branch stub is needed. */
10486 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
10487 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
10488 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
10489 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
10490 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
10491
10492 if (branch_offset + max_branch_offset >= 2 * max_branch_offset - local_off)
10493 /* We need a stub. Figure out whether a long_branch or plt_branch
10494 is needed later. */
10495 return ppc_stub_long_branch;
10496
10497 return ppc_stub_none;
10498 }
10499
10500 /* Gets the address of a label (1:) in r11 and builds an offset in r12,
10501 then adds it to r11 (LOAD false) or loads r12 from r11+r12 (LOAD true).
10502 . mflr %r12
10503 . bcl 20,31,1f
10504 .1: mflr %r11
10505 . mtlr %r12
10506 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
10507 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
10508 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
10509 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
10510 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
10511 . add/ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
10512
10513 static bfd_byte *
10514 build_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, bool load)
10515 {
10516 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R12, p);
10517 p += 4;
10518 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10519 p += 4;
10520 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R11, p);
10521 p += 4;
10522 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R12, p);
10523 p += 4;
10524 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10525 {
10526 if (load)
10527 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10528 else
10529 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10530 p += 4;
10531 }
10532 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10533 {
10534 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDIS_R12_R11 + PPC_HA (off), p);
10535 p += 4;
10536 if (load)
10537 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10538 else
10539 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10540 p += 4;
10541 }
10542 else
10543 {
10544 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10545 {
10546 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10547 p += 4;
10548 }
10549 else
10550 {
10551 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R12 + ((off >> 48) & 0xffff), p);
10552 p += 4;
10553 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10554 {
10555 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10556 p += 4;
10557 }
10558 }
10559 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10560 {
10561 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R12_R12_32, p);
10562 p += 4;
10563 }
10564 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10565 {
10566 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORIS_R12_R12_0 + PPC_HI (off), p);
10567 p += 4;
10568 }
10569 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10570 {
10571 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10572 p += 4;
10573 }
10574 if (load)
10575 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10576 else
10577 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10578 p += 4;
10579 }
10580 return p;
10581 }
10582
10583 static unsigned int
10584 size_offset (bfd_vma off)
10585 {
10586 unsigned int size;
10587 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10588 size = 4;
10589 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10590 size = 8;
10591 else
10592 {
10593 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10594 size = 4;
10595 else
10596 {
10597 size = 4;
10598 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10599 size += 4;
10600 }
10601 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10602 size += 4;
10603 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10604 size += 4;
10605 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10606 size += 4;
10607 size += 4;
10608 }
10609 return size + 16;
10610 }
10611
10612 static unsigned int
10613 num_relocs_for_offset (bfd_vma off)
10614 {
10615 unsigned int num_rel;
10616 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10617 num_rel = 1;
10618 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10619 num_rel = 2;
10620 else
10621 {
10622 num_rel = 1;
10623 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL >= 0x1000000000000ULL
10624 && ((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10625 num_rel += 1;
10626 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10627 num_rel += 1;
10628 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10629 num_rel += 1;
10630 }
10631 return num_rel;
10632 }
10633
10634 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10635 emit_relocs_for_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info, Elf_Internal_Rela *r,
10636 bfd_vma roff, bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off)
10637 {
10638 bfd_vma relative_targ = targ - (roff - 8);
10639 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
10640 roff += 2;
10641 r->r_offset = roff;
10642 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10643 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10644 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16);
10645 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10646 {
10647 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HA);
10648 ++r;
10649 roff += 4;
10650 r->r_offset = roff;
10651 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10652 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10653 }
10654 else
10655 {
10656 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10657 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10658 else
10659 {
10660 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST);
10661 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10662 {
10663 ++r;
10664 roff += 4;
10665 r->r_offset = roff;
10666 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10667 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10668 }
10669 }
10670 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10671 roff += 4;
10672 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10673 {
10674 ++r;
10675 roff += 4;
10676 r->r_offset = roff;
10677 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH);
10678 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10679 }
10680 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10681 {
10682 ++r;
10683 roff += 4;
10684 r->r_offset = roff;
10685 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10686 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10687 }
10688 }
10689 return r;
10690 }
10691
10692 static bfd_byte *
10693 build_power10_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, int odd,
10694 bool load)
10695 {
10696 uint64_t insn;
10697 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10698 {
10699 off -= odd;
10700 if (odd)
10701 {
10702 bfd_put_32 (abfd, NOP, p);
10703 p += 4;
10704 }
10705 if (load)
10706 insn = PLD_R12_PC;
10707 else
10708 insn = PADDI_R12_PC;
10709 insn |= D34 (off);
10710 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10711 p += 4;
10712 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10713 }
10714 /* The minimum value for paddi is -0x200000000. The minimum value
10715 for li is -0x8000, which when shifted by 34 and added gives a
10716 minimum value of -0x2000200000000. The maximum value is
10717 0x1ffffffff+0x7fff<<34 which is 0x2000200000000-1. */
10718 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10719 {
10720 off -= 8 - odd;
10721 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10722 p += 4;
10723 if (!odd)
10724 {
10725 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10726 p += 4;
10727 }
10728 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10729 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10730 p += 4;
10731 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10732 p += 4;
10733 if (odd)
10734 {
10735 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10736 p += 4;
10737 }
10738 if (load)
10739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10740 else
10741 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10742 }
10743 else
10744 {
10745 off -= odd + 8;
10746 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R11 | ((HA34 (off) >> 16) & 0x3fff), p);
10747 p += 4;
10748 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R11_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10749 p += 4;
10750 if (odd)
10751 {
10752 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10753 p += 4;
10754 }
10755 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10756 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10757 p += 4;
10758 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10759 p += 4;
10760 if (!odd)
10761 {
10762 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10763 p += 4;
10764 }
10765 if (load)
10766 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10767 else
10768 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10769 }
10770 p += 4;
10771 return p;
10772 }
10773
10774 static unsigned int
10775 size_power10_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10776 {
10777 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10778 return odd + 8;
10779 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10780 return 20;
10781 else
10782 return 24;
10783 }
10784
10785 static unsigned int
10786 num_relocs_for_power10_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10787 {
10788 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10789 return 1;
10790 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10791 return 2;
10792 else
10793 return 3;
10794 }
10795
10796 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10797 emit_relocs_for_power10_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10798 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, bfd_vma roff,
10799 bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off, int odd)
10800 {
10801 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10802 roff += odd;
10803 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10804 {
10805 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10806 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10807 r->r_addend = targ + 8 - odd - d_offset;
10808 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10809 ++r;
10810 roff += 8 - odd;
10811 }
10812 else
10813 {
10814 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10815 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10816 r->r_addend = targ + 8 + odd - d_offset;
10817 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34);
10818 ++r;
10819 roff += 4;
10820 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10821 r->r_addend = targ + 4 + odd - d_offset;
10822 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10823 ++r;
10824 roff += 4 + odd;
10825 }
10826 r->r_offset = roff;
10827 r->r_addend = targ;
10828 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL34);
10829 return r;
10830 }
10831
10832 /* Emit .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10833
10834 static bfd_byte *
10835 eh_advance (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *eh, unsigned int delta)
10836 {
10837 delta /= 4;
10838 if (delta < 64)
10839 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + delta;
10840 else if (delta < 256)
10841 {
10842 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
10843 *eh++ = delta;
10844 }
10845 else if (delta < 65536)
10846 {
10847 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
10848 bfd_put_16 (abfd, delta, eh);
10849 eh += 2;
10850 }
10851 else
10852 {
10853 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
10854 bfd_put_32 (abfd, delta, eh);
10855 eh += 4;
10856 }
10857 return eh;
10858 }
10859
10860 /* Size of required .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10861
10862 static unsigned int
10863 eh_advance_size (unsigned int delta)
10864 {
10865 if (delta < 64 * 4)
10866 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc+[1..63]. */
10867 return 1;
10868 if (delta < 256 * 4)
10869 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc1, byte. */
10870 return 2;
10871 if (delta < 65536 * 4)
10872 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc2, 2 bytes. */
10873 return 3;
10874 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc4, 4 bytes. */
10875 return 5;
10876 }
10877
10878 /* With power7 weakly ordered memory model, it is possible for ld.so
10879 to update a plt entry in one thread and have another thread see a
10880 stale zero toc entry. To avoid this we need some sort of acquire
10881 barrier in the call stub. One solution is to make the load of the
10882 toc word seem to appear to depend on the load of the function entry
10883 word. Another solution is to test for r2 being zero, and branch to
10884 the appropriate glink entry if so.
10885
10886 . fake dep barrier compare
10887 . ld 12,xxx(2) ld 12,xxx(2)
10888 . mtctr 12 mtctr 12
10889 . xor 11,12,12 ld 2,xxx+8(2)
10890 . add 2,2,11 cmpldi 2,0
10891 . ld 2,xxx+8(2) bnectr+
10892 . bctr b <glink_entry>
10893
10894 The solution involving the compare turns out to be faster, so
10895 that's what we use unless the branch won't reach. */
10896
10897 #define ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP 0
10898 #define ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE 0
10899
10900 static inline unsigned int
10901 plt_stub_size (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10902 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10903 bfd_vma off,
10904 unsigned int odd)
10905 {
10906 unsigned size;
10907
10908 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10909 {
10910 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
10911 size = 8 + size_power10_offset (off, odd);
10912 else
10913 size = 8 + size_offset (off - 8);
10914 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10915 size += 4;
10916 }
10917 else
10918 {
10919 size = 12;
10920 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10921 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10922 size += 4;
10923 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10924 size += 4;
10925 if (htab->opd_abi)
10926 {
10927 size += 4;
10928 if (htab->params->plt_static_chain)
10929 size += 4;
10930 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10931 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10932 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10933 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1)
10934 size += 8;
10935 if (PPC_HA (off + 8 + 8 * htab->params->plt_static_chain)
10936 != PPC_HA (off))
10937 size += 4;
10938 }
10939 }
10940 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10941 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
10942 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
10943 {
10944 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
10945 {
10946 size += 30 * 4;
10947 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
10948 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
10949 size += 4;
10950 }
10951 else
10952 {
10953 size += 7 * 4;
10954 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
10955 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
10956 size += 6 * 4;
10957 }
10958 }
10959 return size;
10960 }
10961
10962 /* Depending on the sign of plt_stub_align:
10963 If positive, return the padding to align to a 2**plt_stub_align
10964 boundary.
10965 If negative, if this stub would cross fewer 2**plt_stub_align
10966 boundaries if we align, then return the padding needed to do so. */
10967
10968 static inline unsigned int
10969 plt_stub_pad (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10970 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10971 bfd_vma plt_off,
10972 unsigned int odd)
10973 {
10974 int stub_align;
10975 unsigned stub_size;
10976 bfd_vma stub_off = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
10977
10978 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
10979 {
10980 stub_align = 1 << htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10981 if ((stub_off & (stub_align - 1)) != 0)
10982 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10983 return 0;
10984 }
10985
10986 stub_align = 1 << -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10987 stub_size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, plt_off, odd);
10988 if (((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align) - (stub_off & -stub_align)
10989 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align))
10990 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10991 return 0;
10992 }
10993
10994 /* Build a .plt call stub. */
10995
10996 static inline bfd_byte *
10997 build_plt_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10998 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10999 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
11000 {
11001 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11002 bool plt_load_toc = htab->opd_abi;
11003 bool plt_static_chain = htab->params->plt_static_chain;
11004 bool plt_thread_safe = (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
11005 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11006 && stub_entry->h != NULL
11007 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1);
11008 bool use_fake_dep = plt_thread_safe;
11009 bfd_vma cmp_branch_off = 0;
11010
11011 if (!ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP
11012 && plt_load_toc
11013 && plt_thread_safe
11014 && !(stub_entry->h != NULL
11015 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
11016 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt))
11017 {
11018 bfd_vma pltoff = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11019 bfd_vma pltindex = ((pltoff - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
11020 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab));
11021 bfd_vma glinkoff = GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + pltindex * 8;
11022 bfd_vma to, from;
11023
11024 if (pltindex > 32768)
11025 glinkoff += (pltindex - 32768) * 4;
11026 to = (glinkoff
11027 + htab->glink->output_offset
11028 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
11029 from = (p - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents
11030 + 4 * (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11031 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11032 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
11033 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain)
11034 != PPC_HA (offset))
11035 + 4 * (plt_static_chain != 0)
11036 + 20
11037 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11038 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11039 cmp_branch_off = to - from;
11040 use_fake_dep = cmp_branch_off + (1 << 25) >= (1 << 26);
11041 }
11042
11043 if (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
11044 {
11045 if (r != NULL)
11046 {
11047 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11048 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11049 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11050 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
11051 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11052 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11053 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11054 if (plt_load_toc)
11055 {
11056 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11057 {
11058 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
11059 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO);
11060 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11061 }
11062 else
11063 {
11064 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
11065 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11066 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
11067 if (plt_static_chain)
11068 {
11069 r[3].r_offset = r[2].r_offset + 4;
11070 r[3].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11071 r[3].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 16;
11072 }
11073 }
11074 }
11075 }
11076 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11077 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11078 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
11079 if (plt_load_toc)
11080 {
11081 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R11_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
11082 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11083 }
11084 else
11085 {
11086 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
11087 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11088 }
11089 if (plt_load_toc
11090 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11091 {
11092 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R11_R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11093 offset = 0;
11094 }
11095 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
11096 if (plt_load_toc)
11097 {
11098 if (use_fake_dep)
11099 {
11100 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R2_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
11101 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R11_R11_R2, p), p += 4;
11102 }
11103 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
11104 if (plt_static_chain)
11105 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
11106 }
11107 }
11108 else
11109 {
11110 if (r != NULL)
11111 {
11112 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11113 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11114 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11115 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11116 if (plt_load_toc)
11117 {
11118 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11119 {
11120 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11121 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16);
11122 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11123 }
11124 else
11125 {
11126 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
11127 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11128 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain;
11129 if (plt_static_chain)
11130 {
11131 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
11132 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11133 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
11134 }
11135 }
11136 }
11137 }
11138 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11139 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11140 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
11141 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11142 if (plt_load_toc
11143 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11144 {
11145 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11146 offset = 0;
11147 }
11148 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
11149 if (plt_load_toc)
11150 {
11151 if (use_fake_dep)
11152 {
11153 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R11_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
11154 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R2_R2_R11, p), p += 4;
11155 }
11156 if (plt_static_chain)
11157 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
11158 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
11159 }
11160 }
11161 if (plt_load_toc && plt_thread_safe && !use_fake_dep)
11162 {
11163 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPLDI_R2_0, p), p += 4;
11164 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BNECTR_P4, p), p += 4;
11165 bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | (cmp_branch_off & 0x3fffffc), p), p += 4;
11166 }
11167 else
11168 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p), p += 4;
11169 return p;
11170 }
11171
11172 /* Build a special .plt call stub for __tls_get_addr. */
11173
11174 #define LD_R0_0R3 0xe8030000
11175 #define LD_R12_0R3 0xe9830000
11176 #define MR_R0_R3 0x7c601b78
11177 #define CMPDI_R0_0 0x2c200000
11178 #define ADD_R3_R12_R13 0x7c6c6a14
11179 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
11180 #define MR_R3_R0 0x7c030378
11181 #define BCTRL 0x4e800421
11182
11183 static bfd_byte *
11184 build_tls_get_addr_head (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11185 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11186 bfd_byte *p)
11187 {
11188 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11189
11190 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R3 + 0, p), p += 4;
11191 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R3 + 8, p), p += 4;
11192 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPDI_R0_0, p), p += 4;
11193 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R0_R3, p), p += 4;
11194 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R3_R12_R13, p), p += 4;
11195 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BEQLR, p), p += 4;
11196 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R3_R0, p), p += 4;
11197
11198 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11199 p = tls_get_addr_prologue (obfd, p, htab);
11200 else if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
11201 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11202 {
11203 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R0, p);
11204 p += 4;
11205 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p);
11206 p += 4;
11207 }
11208 return p;
11209 }
11210
11211 static bfd_byte *
11212 build_tls_get_addr_tail (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11213 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11214 bfd_byte *p,
11215 bfd_byte *loc)
11216 {
11217 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11218
11219 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11220 {
11221 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
11222
11223 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
11224 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11225 {
11226 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11227 p += 4;
11228 }
11229 p = tls_get_addr_epilogue (obfd, p, htab);
11230 }
11231 else if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
11232 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11233 {
11234 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
11235
11236 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11237 p += 4;
11238 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p);
11239 p += 4;
11240 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R0, p);
11241 p += 4;
11242 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p);
11243 p += 4;
11244 }
11245
11246 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11247 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11248 {
11249 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11250
11251 base = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17;
11252 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11253
11254 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11255 {
11256 unsigned int cfa_updt, delta, i;
11257
11258 /* After the bctrl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
11259 .eh_frame info saying the return address is on the stack. In
11260 fact we must put the EH info at or before the call rather
11261 than after it, because the EH info for a call needs to be
11262 specified by that point.
11263 See libgcc/unwind-dw2.c execute_cfa_program.
11264 Any stack pointer update must be described immediately after
11265 the instruction making the change, and since the stdu occurs
11266 after saving regs we put all the reg saves and the cfa
11267 change there. */
11268 cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
11269 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11270 stub_entry->group->lr_restore
11271 = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc) - 4;
11272 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11273 *eh++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
11274 if (htab->opd_abi)
11275 {
11276 *eh++ = 128;
11277 *eh++ = 1;
11278 }
11279 else
11280 *eh++ = 96;
11281 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
11282 *eh++ = 65;
11283 *eh++ = (-16 / 8) & 0x7f;
11284 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
11285 {
11286 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset + i;
11287 *eh++ = (htab->opd_abi ? 13 : 12) - i;
11288 }
11289 *eh++ = (DW_CFA_advance_loc
11290 + (stub_entry->group->lr_restore - 8 - cfa_updt) / 4);
11291 *eh++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
11292 *eh++ = 0;
11293 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
11294 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore + i;
11295 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11296 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11297 *eh++ = 65;
11298 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11299 }
11300 else if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
11301 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11302 {
11303 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11304
11305 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - 20 - loc);
11306 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11307 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 16;
11308 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11309 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
11310 *eh++ = 65;
11311 *eh++ = -(STK_LINKER (htab) / 8) & 0x7f;
11312 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
11313 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11314 *eh++ = 65;
11315 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11316 }
11317 }
11318 return p;
11319 }
11320
11321 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
11322 get_relocs (asection *sec, int count)
11323 {
11324 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
11325 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elfsec_data;
11326
11327 elfsec_data = elf_section_data (sec);
11328 relocs = elfsec_data->relocs;
11329 if (relocs == NULL)
11330 {
11331 bfd_size_type relsize;
11332 relsize = sec->reloc_count * sizeof (*relocs);
11333 relocs = bfd_alloc (sec->owner, relsize);
11334 if (relocs == NULL)
11335 return NULL;
11336 elfsec_data->relocs = relocs;
11337 elfsec_data->rela.hdr = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner,
11338 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
11339 if (elfsec_data->rela.hdr == NULL)
11340 return NULL;
11341 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_size = (sec->reloc_count
11342 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11343 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11344 sec->reloc_count = 0;
11345 }
11346 relocs += sec->reloc_count;
11347 sec->reloc_count += count;
11348 return relocs;
11349 }
11350
11351 /* Convert the relocs R[0] thru R[-NUM_REL+1], which are all no-symbol
11352 forms, to the equivalent relocs against the global symbol given by
11353 STUB_ENTRY->H. */
11354
11355 static bool
11356 use_global_in_relocs (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11357 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11358 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, unsigned int num_rel)
11359 {
11360 struct elf_link_hash_entry **hashes;
11361 unsigned long symndx;
11362 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
11363 bfd_vma symval;
11364
11365 /* Relocs are always against symbols in their own object file. Fake
11366 up global sym hashes for the stub bfd (which has no symbols). */
11367 hashes = elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd);
11368 if (hashes == NULL)
11369 {
11370 bfd_size_type hsize;
11371
11372 /* When called the first time, stub_globals will contain the
11373 total number of symbols seen during stub sizing. After
11374 allocating, stub_globals is used as an index to fill the
11375 hashes array. */
11376 hsize = (htab->stub_globals + 1) * sizeof (*hashes);
11377 hashes = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, hsize);
11378 if (hashes == NULL)
11379 return false;
11380 elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd) = hashes;
11381 htab->stub_globals = 1;
11382 }
11383 symndx = htab->stub_globals++;
11384 h = stub_entry->h;
11385 hashes[symndx] = &h->elf;
11386 if (h->oh != NULL && h->oh->is_func)
11387 h = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
11388 BFD_ASSERT (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11389 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
11390 symval = defined_sym_val (&h->elf);
11391 while (num_rel-- != 0)
11392 {
11393 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (symndx, ELF64_R_TYPE (r->r_info));
11394 if (h->elf.root.u.def.section != stub_entry->target_section)
11395 {
11396 /* H is an opd symbol. The addend must be zero, and the
11397 branch reloc is the only one we can convert. */
11398 r->r_addend = 0;
11399 break;
11400 }
11401 else
11402 r->r_addend -= symval;
11403 --r;
11404 }
11405 return true;
11406 }
11407
11408 static bfd_vma
11409 get_r2off (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11410 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry)
11411 {
11412 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11413 bfd_vma r2off = htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off;
11414
11415 if (r2off == 0)
11416 {
11417 /* Support linking -R objects. Get the toc pointer from the
11418 opd entry. */
11419 char buf[8];
11420 if (!htab->opd_abi)
11421 return r2off;
11422 asection *opd = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section;
11423 bfd_vma opd_off = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.value;
11424
11425 if (strcmp (opd->name, ".opd") != 0
11426 || opd->reloc_count != 0)
11427 {
11428 info->callbacks->einfo
11429 (_("%P: cannot find opd entry toc for `%pT'\n"),
11430 stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string);
11431 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11432 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11433 }
11434 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (opd->owner, opd, buf, opd_off + 8, 8))
11435 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11436 r2off = bfd_get_64 (opd->owner, buf);
11437 r2off -= elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
11438 }
11439 r2off -= htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off;
11440 return r2off;
11441 }
11442
11443 static bool
11444 ppc_build_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11445 {
11446 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11447 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11448 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11449 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11450 bfd *obfd;
11451 bfd_byte *loc;
11452 bfd_byte *p, *relp;
11453 bfd_vma targ, off;
11454 Elf_Internal_Rela *r;
11455 asection *plt;
11456 int num_rel;
11457 int odd;
11458 bool is_tga;
11459
11460 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11461 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11462 info = in_arg;
11463
11464 /* Fail if the target section could not be assigned to an output
11465 section. The user should fix his linker script. */
11466 if (stub_entry->target_section != NULL
11467 && stub_entry->target_section->output_section == NULL
11468 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
11469 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign '%pA' to an output section. "
11470 "Retry without --enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
11471 stub_entry->target_section);
11472
11473 /* Same for the group. */
11474 if (stub_entry->group->stub_sec != NULL
11475 && stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section == NULL
11476 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
11477 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign group %pA target %pA to an "
11478 "output section. Retry without "
11479 "--enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
11480 stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11481 stub_entry->target_section);
11482
11483 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11484 if (htab == NULL)
11485 return false;
11486
11487 BFD_ASSERT (stub_entry->stub_offset >= stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size);
11488 loc = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents + stub_entry->stub_offset;
11489
11490 htab->stub_count[stub_entry->stub_type - 1] += 1;
11491 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11492 {
11493 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11494 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11495 /* Branches are relative. This is where we are going to. */
11496 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11497 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11498 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11499 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11500
11501 /* And this is where we are coming from. */
11502 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11503 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11504 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11505 off = targ - off;
11506
11507 p = loc;
11508 obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11509 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11510 {
11511 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11512
11513 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11514 {
11515 htab->stub_error = true;
11516 return false;
11517 }
11518 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11519 p += 4;
11520 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11521 {
11522 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11523 p += 4;
11524 }
11525 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11526 {
11527 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11528 p += 4;
11529 }
11530 off -= p - loc;
11531 }
11532 bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | (off & 0x3fffffc), p);
11533 p += 4;
11534
11535 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11536 {
11537 _bfd_error_handler
11538 (_("long branch stub `%s' offset overflow"),
11539 stub_entry->root.string);
11540 htab->stub_error = true;
11541 return false;
11542 }
11543
11544 if (info->emitrelocations)
11545 {
11546 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1);
11547 if (r == NULL)
11548 return false;
11549 r->r_offset = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11550 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11551 r->r_addend = targ;
11552 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11553 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, 1))
11554 return false;
11555 }
11556 break;
11557
11558 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11559 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11560 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11561 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11562 false, false);
11563 if (br_entry == NULL)
11564 {
11565 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't find branch stub `%s'"),
11566 stub_entry->root.string);
11567 htab->stub_error = true;
11568 return false;
11569 }
11570
11571 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11572 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11573 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11574 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11575 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11576
11577 bfd_put_64 (htab->brlt->owner, targ,
11578 htab->brlt->contents + br_entry->offset);
11579
11580 if (br_entry->iter == htab->stub_iteration)
11581 {
11582 br_entry->iter = 0;
11583
11584 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11585 {
11586 /* Create a reloc for the branch lookup table entry. */
11587 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
11588 bfd_byte *rl;
11589
11590 rela.r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11591 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11592 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11593 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11594 rela.r_addend = targ;
11595
11596 rl = htab->relbrlt->contents;
11597 rl += (htab->relbrlt->reloc_count++
11598 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11599 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (htab->relbrlt->owner, &rela, rl);
11600 }
11601 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11602 {
11603 r = get_relocs (htab->brlt, 1);
11604 if (r == NULL)
11605 return false;
11606 /* brlt, being SEC_LINKER_CREATED does not go through the
11607 normal reloc processing. Symbols and offsets are not
11608 translated from input file to output file form, so
11609 set up the offset per the output file. */
11610 r->r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11611 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11612 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11613 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11614 r->r_addend = targ;
11615 }
11616 }
11617
11618 targ = (br_entry->offset
11619 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11620 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11621
11622 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11623 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11624 off = targ - off;
11625
11626 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11627 {
11628 info->callbacks->einfo
11629 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11630 stub_entry->root.string);
11631 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11632 htab->stub_error = true;
11633 return false;
11634 }
11635
11636 if (info->emitrelocations)
11637 {
11638 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0));
11639 if (r == NULL)
11640 return false;
11641 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11642 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11643 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11644 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11645 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11646 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11647 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11648 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11649 {
11650 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
11651 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11652 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11653 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11654 }
11655 }
11656
11657 p = loc;
11658 obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11659 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11660 {
11661 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11662 {
11663 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11664 p += 4;
11665 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11666 }
11667 else
11668 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11669 }
11670 else
11671 {
11672 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11673
11674 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11675 {
11676 htab->stub_error = true;
11677 return false;
11678 }
11679
11680 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11681 p += 4;
11682 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11683 {
11684 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11685 p += 4;
11686 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11687 }
11688 else
11689 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11690
11691 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11692 {
11693 p += 4;
11694 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11695 }
11696 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11697 {
11698 p += 4;
11699 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11700 }
11701 }
11702 p += 4;
11703 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11704 p += 4;
11705 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p);
11706 p += 4;
11707 break;
11708
11709 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
11710 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
11711 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
11712 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
11713 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
11714 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
11715 p = loc;
11716 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11717 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11718 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11719 obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11720 is_tga = ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
11721 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11722 && stub_entry->h != NULL
11723 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
11724 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt);
11725 if (is_tga)
11726 {
11727 p = build_tls_get_addr_head (htab, stub_entry, p);
11728 off += p - loc;
11729 }
11730 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11731 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11732 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11733 {
11734 off += 4;
11735 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11736 p += 4;
11737 }
11738 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
11739 {
11740 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11741 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11742 abort ();
11743
11744 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11745 if (use_local_plt (info, elf_hash_entry (stub_entry->h)))
11746 {
11747 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11748 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11749 else
11750 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11751 }
11752 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11753 }
11754 else
11755 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11756 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11757 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11758 odd = off & 4;
11759 off = targ - off;
11760
11761 relp = p;
11762 num_rel = 0;
11763 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
11764 {
11765 bool load = stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
11766 p = build_power10_offset (obfd, p, off, odd, load);
11767 }
11768 else
11769 {
11770 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11771 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11772 {
11773 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11774 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11775
11776 base = (htab->glink_eh_frame->contents
11777 + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17);
11778 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11779 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc) + 8;
11780 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11781 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
11782 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11783 *eh++ = DW_CFA_register;
11784 *eh++ = 65;
11785 *eh++ = 12;
11786 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11787 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11788 *eh++ = 65;
11789 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11790 }
11791
11792 /* The notoc stubs calculate their target (either a PLT entry or
11793 the global entry point of a function) relative to the PC
11794 returned by the "bcl" two instructions past the start of the
11795 sequence emitted by build_offset. The offset is therefore 8
11796 less than calculated from the start of the sequence. */
11797 off -= 8;
11798 p = build_offset (obfd, p, off,
11799 stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc);
11800 }
11801
11802 if (stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11803 {
11804 bfd_vma from;
11805 num_rel = 1;
11806 from = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11807 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11808 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
11809 + (p - loc));
11810 bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | ((targ - from) & 0x3fffffc), p);
11811 }
11812 else
11813 {
11814 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11815 p += 4;
11816 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p);
11817 }
11818 p += 4;
11819
11820 if (is_tga)
11821 p = build_tls_get_addr_tail (htab, stub_entry, p, loc);
11822
11823 if (info->emitrelocations)
11824 {
11825 bfd_vma roff = relp - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11826 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
11827 num_rel += num_relocs_for_power10_offset (off, odd);
11828 else
11829 {
11830 num_rel += num_relocs_for_offset (off);
11831 roff += 16;
11832 }
11833 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, num_rel);
11834 if (r == NULL)
11835 return false;
11836 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
11837 r = emit_relocs_for_power10_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off, odd);
11838 else
11839 r = emit_relocs_for_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off);
11840 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
11841 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11842 {
11843 ++r;
11844 roff = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11845 r->r_offset = roff;
11846 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11847 r->r_addend = targ;
11848 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11849 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, num_rel))
11850 return false;
11851 }
11852 }
11853 break;
11854
11855 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
11856 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
11857 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11858 && stub_entry->h->is_func_descriptor
11859 && stub_entry->h->oh != NULL)
11860 {
11861 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (stub_entry->h->oh);
11862
11863 /* If the old-ABI "dot-symbol" is undefined make it weak so
11864 we don't get a link error from RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL. */
11865 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
11866 && (stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11867 || stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
11868 fh->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_undefweak;
11869 }
11870
11871 /* Now build the stub. */
11872 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11873 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11874 abort ();
11875
11876 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11877 if (use_local_plt (info, elf_hash_entry (stub_entry->h)))
11878 {
11879 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11880 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11881 else
11882 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11883 }
11884 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11885
11886 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11887 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11888 off = targ - off;
11889
11890 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11891 {
11892 info->callbacks->einfo
11893 /* xgettext:c-format */
11894 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11895 stub_entry->h != NULL
11896 ? stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string
11897 : "<local sym>");
11898 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11899 htab->stub_error = true;
11900 return false;
11901 }
11902
11903 r = NULL;
11904 if (info->emitrelocations)
11905 {
11906 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11907 ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11908 + (htab->opd_abi
11909 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
11910 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
11911 : 1)));
11912 if (r == NULL)
11913 return false;
11914 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11915 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11916 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11917 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11918 }
11919 p = loc;
11920 obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11921 is_tga = (stub_entry->h != NULL
11922 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
11923 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt);
11924 if (is_tga)
11925 {
11926 p = build_tls_get_addr_head (htab, stub_entry, p);
11927 if (r != NULL)
11928 r[0].r_offset += p - loc;
11929 }
11930 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, off, r);
11931 if (is_tga)
11932 p = build_tls_get_addr_tail (htab, stub_entry, p, loc);
11933 break;
11934
11935 case ppc_stub_save_res:
11936 return true;
11937
11938 default:
11939 BFD_FAIL ();
11940 return false;
11941 }
11942
11943 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc);
11944
11945 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
11946 {
11947 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11948 size_t len1, len2;
11949 char *name;
11950 const char *const stub_str[] = { "long_branch",
11951 "long_branch",
11952 "long_branch",
11953 "long_branch",
11954 "plt_branch",
11955 "plt_branch",
11956 "plt_branch",
11957 "plt_branch",
11958 "plt_call",
11959 "plt_call",
11960 "plt_call",
11961 "plt_call" };
11962
11963 len1 = strlen (stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1]);
11964 len2 = strlen (stub_entry->root.string);
11965 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + 2);
11966 if (name == NULL)
11967 return false;
11968 memcpy (name, stub_entry->root.string, 9);
11969 memcpy (name + 9, stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1], len1);
11970 memcpy (name + len1 + 9, stub_entry->root.string + 8, len2 - 8 + 1);
11971 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
11972 if (h == NULL)
11973 return false;
11974 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
11975 {
11976 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
11977 h->root.u.def.section = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
11978 h->root.u.def.value = stub_entry->stub_offset;
11979 h->ref_regular = 1;
11980 h->def_regular = 1;
11981 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
11982 h->forced_local = 1;
11983 h->non_elf = 0;
11984 h->root.linker_def = 1;
11985 }
11986 }
11987
11988 return true;
11989 }
11990
11991 /* As above, but don't actually build the stub. Just bump offset so
11992 we know stub section sizes, and select plt_branch stubs where
11993 long_branch stubs won't do. */
11994
11995 static bool
11996 ppc_size_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11997 {
11998 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11999 struct bfd_link_info *info;
12000 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12001 asection *plt;
12002 bfd_vma targ, off, r2off;
12003 unsigned int size, extra, lr_used, delta, odd;
12004
12005 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
12006 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
12007 info = in_arg;
12008
12009 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12010 if (htab == NULL)
12011 return false;
12012
12013 /* Fail if the target section could not be assigned to an output
12014 section. The user should fix his linker script. */
12015 if (stub_entry->target_section != NULL
12016 && stub_entry->target_section->output_section == NULL
12017 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
12018 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign %pA to an output section. "
12019 "Retry without --enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
12020 stub_entry->target_section);
12021
12022 /* Same for the group. */
12023 if (stub_entry->group->stub_sec != NULL
12024 && stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section == NULL
12025 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
12026 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign group %pA target %pA to an "
12027 "output section. Retry without "
12028 "--enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
12029 stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
12030 stub_entry->target_section);
12031
12032 /* Make a note of the offset within the stubs for this entry. */
12033 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12034
12035 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
12036 && stub_entry->h->save_res
12037 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12038 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
12039 {
12040 /* Don't make stubs to out-of-line register save/restore
12041 functions. Instead, emit copies of the functions. */
12042 stub_entry->group->needs_save_res = 1;
12043 stub_entry->stub_type = ppc_stub_save_res;
12044 return true;
12045 }
12046
12047 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
12048 {
12049 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
12050 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
12051 /* Reset the stub type from the plt branch variant in case we now
12052 can reach with a shorter stub. */
12053 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
12054 /* Fall through. */
12055 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
12056 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
12057 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
12058 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
12059 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
12060 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
12061 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12062 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12063 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
12064
12065 size = 4;
12066 r2off = 0;
12067 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
12068 {
12069 r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
12070 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
12071 {
12072 htab->stub_error = true;
12073 return false;
12074 }
12075 size = 8;
12076 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
12077 size += 4;
12078 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
12079 size += 4;
12080 off += size - 4;
12081 }
12082 off = targ - off;
12083
12084 /* If the branch offset is too big, use a ppc_stub_plt_branch.
12085 Do the same for -R objects without function descriptors. */
12086 if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
12087 && r2off == 0
12088 && htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off == 0)
12089 || off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
12090 {
12091 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
12092
12093 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
12094 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
12095 true, false);
12096 if (br_entry == NULL)
12097 {
12098 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't build branch stub `%s'"),
12099 stub_entry->root.string);
12100 htab->stub_error = true;
12101 return false;
12102 }
12103
12104 if (br_entry->iter != htab->stub_iteration)
12105 {
12106 br_entry->iter = htab->stub_iteration;
12107 br_entry->offset = htab->brlt->size;
12108 htab->brlt->size += 8;
12109
12110 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
12111 htab->relbrlt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12112 else if (info->emitrelocations)
12113 {
12114 htab->brlt->reloc_count += 1;
12115 htab->brlt->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12116 }
12117 }
12118
12119 targ = (br_entry->offset
12120 + htab->brlt->output_offset
12121 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
12122 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
12123 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
12124 off = targ - off;
12125
12126 if (info->emitrelocations)
12127 {
12128 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
12129 += 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0);
12130 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12131 }
12132
12133 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_plt_branch - ppc_stub_long_branch;
12134 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
12135 {
12136 size = 12;
12137 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12138 size = 16;
12139 }
12140 else
12141 {
12142 size = 16;
12143 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12144 size += 4;
12145
12146 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
12147 size += 4;
12148 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
12149 size += 4;
12150 }
12151 }
12152 else if (info->emitrelocations)
12153 {
12154 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += 1;
12155 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12156 }
12157 break;
12158
12159 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
12160 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
12161 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
12162 /* Fall through. */
12163 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
12164 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
12165 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12166 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12167 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
12168 size = 0;
12169 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
12170 size = 4;
12171 off += size;
12172 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
12173 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
12174 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
12175 odd = off & 4;
12176 off = targ - off;
12177
12178 if (info->emitrelocations)
12179 {
12180 unsigned int num_rel;
12181 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
12182 num_rel = num_relocs_for_power10_offset (off, odd);
12183 else
12184 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
12185 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
12186 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12187 }
12188
12189 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
12190 extra = size_power10_offset (off, odd);
12191 else
12192 extra = size_offset (off - 8);
12193 /* Include branch insn plus those in the offset sequence. */
12194 size += 4 + extra;
12195 /* The branch insn is at the end, or "extra" bytes along. So
12196 its offset will be "extra" bytes less that that already
12197 calculated. */
12198 off -= extra;
12199
12200 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == 0)
12201 {
12202 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
12203 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
12204 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
12205 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
12206 lr_used += 4;
12207 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
12208 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
12209 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
12210 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12211 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12212 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
12213 }
12214
12215 /* If the branch can't reach, use a plt_branch. */
12216 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
12217 {
12218 stub_entry->stub_type += (ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
12219 - ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
12220 size += 4;
12221 }
12222 else if (info->emitrelocations)
12223 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count +=1;
12224 break;
12225
12226 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
12227 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
12228 lr_used = 0;
12229 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
12230 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
12231 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
12232 {
12233 lr_used += 7 * 4;
12234 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
12235 lr_used += 11 * 4;
12236 else if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12237 lr_used += 2 * 4;
12238 }
12239 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12240 lr_used += 4;
12241 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
12242 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
12243 abort ();
12244
12245 plt = htab->elf.splt;
12246 if (use_local_plt (info, elf_hash_entry (stub_entry->h)))
12247 {
12248 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12249 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12250 else
12251 plt = htab->pltlocal;
12252 }
12253 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12254 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12255 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12256 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
12257 + lr_used);
12258 odd = off & 4;
12259 off = targ - off;
12260
12261 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12262 {
12263 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off, odd);
12264
12265 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
12266 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12267 off -= pad;
12268 odd ^= pad & 4;
12269 }
12270
12271 if (info->emitrelocations)
12272 {
12273 unsigned int num_rel;
12274 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
12275 num_rel = num_relocs_for_power10_offset (off, odd);
12276 else
12277 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
12278 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
12279 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12280 }
12281
12282 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off, odd);
12283
12284 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == 0)
12285 {
12286 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
12287 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
12288 lr_used += stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
12289 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
12290 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
12291 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
12292 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12293 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12294 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
12295 }
12296 if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
12297 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12298 && stub_entry->h != NULL
12299 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
12300 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
12301 {
12302 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
12303 {
12304 unsigned int cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
12305 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12306 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta);
12307 stub_entry->group->eh_size += htab->opd_abi ? 36 : 35;
12308 stub_entry->group->lr_restore
12309 = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 4;
12310 }
12311 else if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12312 {
12313 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 20;
12314 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12315 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12316 stub_entry->group->lr_restore
12317 = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 4;
12318 }
12319 }
12320 break;
12321
12322 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
12323 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
12324 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~(bfd_vma) 1;
12325 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
12326 abort ();
12327 plt = htab->elf.splt;
12328 if (use_local_plt (info, elf_hash_entry (stub_entry->h)))
12329 {
12330 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12331 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12332 else
12333 plt = htab->pltlocal;
12334 }
12335 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12336
12337 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
12338 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
12339 off = targ - off;
12340
12341 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12342 {
12343 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off, 0);
12344
12345 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
12346 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12347 }
12348
12349 if (info->emitrelocations)
12350 {
12351 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
12352 += ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12353 + (htab->opd_abi
12354 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
12355 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
12356 : 1));
12357 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12358 }
12359
12360 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off, 0);
12361
12362 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
12363 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
12364 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
12365 && stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
12366 {
12367 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
12368 {
12369 /* Adjustments to r1 need to be described. */
12370 unsigned int cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
12371 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12372 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta);
12373 stub_entry->group->eh_size += htab->opd_abi ? 36 : 35;
12374 }
12375 else
12376 {
12377 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 20;
12378 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc
12379 or variant, DW_CFA_offset_externed_sf, 65, -stackoff,
12380 DW_CFA_advance_loc+4, DW_CFA_restore_extended, 65. */
12381 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12382 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12383 }
12384 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 4;
12385 }
12386 break;
12387
12388 default:
12389 BFD_FAIL ();
12390 return false;
12391 }
12392
12393 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += size;
12394 return true;
12395 }
12396
12397 /* Set up various things so that we can make a list of input sections
12398 for each output section included in the link. Returns -1 on error,
12399 0 when no stubs will be needed, and 1 on success. */
12400
12401 int
12402 ppc64_elf_setup_section_lists (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12403 {
12404 unsigned int id;
12405 size_t amt;
12406 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12407
12408 if (htab == NULL)
12409 return -1;
12410
12411 htab->sec_info_arr_size = _bfd_section_id;
12412 amt = sizeof (*htab->sec_info) * (htab->sec_info_arr_size);
12413 htab->sec_info = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
12414 if (htab->sec_info == NULL)
12415 return -1;
12416
12417 /* Set toc_off for com, und, abs and ind sections. */
12418 for (id = 0; id < 3; id++)
12419 htab->sec_info[id].toc_off = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12420
12421 return 1;
12422 }
12423
12424 /* Set up for first pass at multitoc partitioning. */
12425
12426 void
12427 ppc64_elf_start_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12428 {
12429 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12430
12431 htab->toc_curr = ppc64_elf_set_toc (info, info->output_bfd);
12432 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12433 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12434 }
12435
12436 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each TOC input section
12437 and linker generated GOT section. Group input bfds such that the toc
12438 within a group is less than 64k in size. */
12439
12440 bool
12441 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12442 {
12443 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12444 bfd_vma addr, off, limit;
12445
12446 if (htab == NULL)
12447 return false;
12448
12449 if (!htab->second_toc_pass)
12450 {
12451 /* Keep track of the first .toc or .got section for this input bfd. */
12452 bool new_bfd = htab->toc_bfd != isec->owner;
12453
12454 if (new_bfd)
12455 {
12456 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12457 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12458 }
12459
12460 addr = isec->output_offset + isec->output_section->vma;
12461 off = addr - htab->toc_curr;
12462 limit = 0x80008000;
12463 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (isec->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc)
12464 limit = 0x10000;
12465 if (off + isec->size > limit)
12466 {
12467 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12468 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12469 htab->toc_curr = addr;
12470 htab->toc_curr &= -TOC_BASE_ALIGN;
12471 }
12472
12473 /* toc_curr is the base address of this toc group. Set elf_gp
12474 for the input section to be the offset relative to the
12475 output toc base plus 0x8000. Making the input elf_gp an
12476 offset allows us to move the toc as a whole without
12477 recalculating input elf_gp. */
12478 off = htab->toc_curr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12479 off += TOC_BASE_OFF;
12480
12481 /* Die if someone uses a linker script that doesn't keep input
12482 file .toc and .got together. */
12483 if (new_bfd
12484 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0
12485 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != off)
12486 return false;
12487
12488 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12489 return true;
12490 }
12491
12492 /* During the second pass toc_first_sec points to the start of
12493 a toc group, and toc_curr is used to track the old elf_gp.
12494 We use toc_bfd to ensure we only look at each bfd once. */
12495 if (htab->toc_bfd == isec->owner)
12496 return true;
12497 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12498
12499 if (htab->toc_first_sec == NULL
12500 || htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (isec->owner))
12501 {
12502 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12503 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12504 }
12505 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12506 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12507 off = addr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF;
12508 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12509
12510 return true;
12511 }
12512
12513 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to merge GOT entries for global
12514 symbol H. */
12515
12516 static bool
12517 merge_global_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12518 {
12519 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12520 return true;
12521
12522 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
12523
12524 return true;
12525 }
12526
12527 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to allocate GOT entries for global
12528 symbol H. */
12529
12530 static bool
12531 reallocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
12532 {
12533 struct got_entry *gent;
12534
12535 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12536 return true;
12537
12538 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
12539 if (!gent->is_indirect)
12540 allocate_got (h, (struct bfd_link_info *) inf, gent);
12541 return true;
12542 }
12543
12544 /* Called on the first multitoc pass after the last call to
12545 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section. This function removes duplicate GOT
12546 entries. */
12547
12548 bool
12549 ppc64_elf_layout_multitoc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12550 {
12551 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12552 struct bfd *ibfd, *ibfd2;
12553 bool done_something;
12554
12555 htab->multi_toc_needed = htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12556
12557 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
12558 return false;
12559
12560 /* Merge global sym got entries within a toc group. */
12561 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, merge_global_got, info);
12562
12563 /* And tlsld_got. */
12564 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12565 {
12566 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
12567
12568 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12569 continue;
12570
12571 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12572 if (!ent->is_indirect
12573 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12574 {
12575 for (ibfd2 = ibfd->link.next; ibfd2 != NULL; ibfd2 = ibfd2->link.next)
12576 {
12577 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd2))
12578 continue;
12579
12580 ent2 = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd2);
12581 if (!ent2->is_indirect
12582 && ent2->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
12583 && elf_gp (ibfd2) == elf_gp (ibfd))
12584 {
12585 ent2->is_indirect = true;
12586 ent2->got.ent = ent;
12587 }
12588 }
12589 }
12590 }
12591
12592 /* Zap sizes of got sections. */
12593 htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize = htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12594 htab->elf.irelplt->size -= htab->got_reli_size;
12595 htab->got_reli_size = 0;
12596
12597 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12598 {
12599 asection *got, *relgot;
12600
12601 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12602 continue;
12603
12604 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12605 if (got != NULL)
12606 {
12607 got->rawsize = got->size;
12608 got->size = 0;
12609 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12610 relgot->rawsize = relgot->size;
12611 relgot->size = 0;
12612 }
12613 }
12614
12615 /* Now reallocate the got, local syms first. We don't need to
12616 allocate section contents again since we never increase size. */
12617 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12618 {
12619 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
12620 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
12621 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
12622 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
12623 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
12624 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
12625 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12626 asection *s;
12627
12628 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12629 continue;
12630
12631 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
12632 if (!lgot_ents)
12633 continue;
12634
12635 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
12636 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
12637 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
12638 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
12639 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
12640 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
12641 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12642 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
12643 {
12644 struct got_entry *ent;
12645
12646 for (ent = *lgot_ents; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12647 {
12648 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
12649 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12650
12651 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12652 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
12653 {
12654 ent_size *= 2;
12655 rel_size *= 2;
12656 }
12657 s->size += ent_size;
12658 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
12659 {
12660 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
12661 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
12662 }
12663 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
12664 && !(ent->tls_type != 0
12665 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
12666 {
12667 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12668 srel->size += rel_size;
12669 }
12670 }
12671 }
12672 }
12673
12674 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, reallocate_got, info);
12675
12676 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12677 {
12678 struct got_entry *ent;
12679
12680 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12681 continue;
12682
12683 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12684 if (!ent->is_indirect
12685 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12686 {
12687 asection *s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12688 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12689 s->size += 16;
12690 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
12691 {
12692 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12693 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12694 }
12695 }
12696 }
12697
12698 done_something = htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize != htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12699 if (!done_something)
12700 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12701 {
12702 asection *got;
12703
12704 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12705 continue;
12706
12707 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12708 if (got != NULL)
12709 {
12710 done_something = got->rawsize != got->size;
12711 if (done_something)
12712 break;
12713 }
12714 }
12715
12716 if (done_something)
12717 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
12718
12719 /* Set up for second pass over toc sections to recalculate elf_gp
12720 on input sections. */
12721 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12722 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12723 htab->second_toc_pass = true;
12724 return done_something;
12725 }
12726
12727 /* Called after second pass of multitoc partitioning. */
12728
12729 void
12730 ppc64_elf_finish_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12731 {
12732 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12733
12734 /* After the second pass, toc_curr tracks the TOC offset used
12735 for code sections below in ppc64_elf_next_input_section. */
12736 htab->toc_curr = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12737 }
12738
12739 /* No toc references were found in ISEC. If the code in ISEC makes no
12740 calls, then there's no need to use toc adjusting stubs when branching
12741 into ISEC. Actually, indirect calls from ISEC are OK as they will
12742 load r2. Returns -1 on error, 0 for no stub needed, 1 for stub
12743 needed, and 2 if a cyclical call-graph was found but no other reason
12744 for a stub was detected. If called from the top level, a return of
12745 2 means the same as a return of 0. */
12746
12747 static int
12748 toc_adjusting_stub_needed (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12749 {
12750 int ret;
12751
12752 /* Mark this section as checked. */
12753 isec->call_check_done = 1;
12754
12755 /* We know none of our code bearing sections will need toc stubs. */
12756 if ((isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
12757 return 0;
12758
12759 if (isec->size == 0)
12760 return 0;
12761
12762 if (isec->output_section == NULL)
12763 return 0;
12764
12765 ret = 0;
12766 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
12767 {
12768 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
12769 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
12770 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12771
12772 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (isec->owner, isec, NULL, NULL,
12773 info->keep_memory);
12774 if (relstart == NULL)
12775 return -1;
12776
12777 /* Look for branches to outside of this section. */
12778 local_syms = NULL;
12779 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12780 if (htab == NULL)
12781 return -1;
12782
12783 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + isec->reloc_count; ++rel)
12784 {
12785 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
12786 unsigned long r_symndx;
12787 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12788 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
12789 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12790 asection *sym_sec;
12791 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
12792 bfd_vma sym_value;
12793 bfd_vma dest;
12794
12795 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
12796 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
12797 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
12798 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
12799 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
12800 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
12801 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
12802 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
12803 continue;
12804
12805 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
12806 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms, r_symndx,
12807 isec->owner))
12808 {
12809 ret = -1;
12810 break;
12811 }
12812
12813 /* Calls to dynamic lib functions go through a plt call stub
12814 that uses r2. */
12815 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
12816 if (eh != NULL
12817 && (eh->elf.plt.plist != NULL
12818 || (eh->oh != NULL
12819 && ppc_follow_link (eh->oh)->elf.plt.plist != NULL)))
12820 {
12821 ret = 1;
12822 break;
12823 }
12824
12825 if (sym_sec == NULL)
12826 /* Ignore other undefined symbols. */
12827 continue;
12828
12829 /* Assume branches to other sections not included in the
12830 link need stubs too, to cover -R and absolute syms. */
12831 if (sym_sec->output_section == NULL)
12832 {
12833 ret = 1;
12834 break;
12835 }
12836
12837 if (h == NULL)
12838 sym_value = sym->st_value;
12839 else
12840 {
12841 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
12842 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12843 abort ();
12844 sym_value = h->root.u.def.value;
12845 }
12846 sym_value += rel->r_addend;
12847
12848 /* If this branch reloc uses an opd sym, find the code section. */
12849 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
12850 if (opd != NULL)
12851 {
12852 if (h == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
12853 {
12854 long adjust;
12855
12856 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
12857 if (adjust == -1)
12858 /* Assume deleted functions won't ever be called. */
12859 continue;
12860 sym_value += adjust;
12861 }
12862
12863 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
12864 &sym_sec, NULL, false);
12865 if (dest == (bfd_vma) -1)
12866 continue;
12867 }
12868 else
12869 dest = (sym_value
12870 + sym_sec->output_offset
12871 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
12872
12873 /* Ignore branch to self. */
12874 if (sym_sec == isec)
12875 continue;
12876
12877 /* If the called function uses the toc, we need a stub. */
12878 if (sym_sec->has_toc_reloc
12879 || sym_sec->makes_toc_func_call)
12880 {
12881 ret = 1;
12882 break;
12883 }
12884
12885 /* Assume any branch that needs a long branch stub might in fact
12886 need a plt_branch stub. A plt_branch stub uses r2. */
12887 else if (dest - (isec->output_offset
12888 + isec->output_section->vma
12889 + rel->r_offset) + (1 << 25)
12890 >= (2u << 25) - PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h
12891 ? h->other
12892 : sym->st_other))
12893 {
12894 ret = 1;
12895 break;
12896 }
12897
12898 /* If calling back to a section in the process of being
12899 tested, we can't say for sure that no toc adjusting stubs
12900 are needed, so don't return zero. */
12901 else if (sym_sec->call_check_in_progress)
12902 ret = 2;
12903
12904 /* Branches to another section that itself doesn't have any TOC
12905 references are OK. Recursively call ourselves to check. */
12906 else if (!sym_sec->call_check_done)
12907 {
12908 int recur;
12909
12910 /* Mark current section as indeterminate, so that other
12911 sections that call back to current won't be marked as
12912 known. */
12913 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12914 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, sym_sec);
12915 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12916
12917 if (recur != 0)
12918 {
12919 ret = recur;
12920 if (recur != 2)
12921 break;
12922 }
12923 }
12924 }
12925
12926 if (elf_symtab_hdr (isec->owner).contents
12927 != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
12928 free (local_syms);
12929 if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != relstart)
12930 free (relstart);
12931 }
12932
12933 if ((ret & 1) == 0
12934 && isec->map_head.s != NULL
12935 && (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
12936 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
12937 {
12938 if (isec->map_head.s->has_toc_reloc
12939 || isec->map_head.s->makes_toc_func_call)
12940 ret = 1;
12941 else if (!isec->map_head.s->call_check_done)
12942 {
12943 int recur;
12944 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12945 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec->map_head.s);
12946 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12947 if (recur != 0)
12948 ret = recur;
12949 }
12950 }
12951
12952 if (ret == 1)
12953 isec->makes_toc_func_call = 1;
12954
12955 return ret;
12956 }
12957
12958 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each input section,
12959 in the order that input sections are linked into output sections.
12960 Build lists of input sections to determine groupings between which
12961 we may insert linker stubs. */
12962
12963 bool
12964 ppc64_elf_next_input_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12965 {
12966 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12967
12968 if (htab == NULL)
12969 return false;
12970
12971 if ((isec->output_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
12972 && isec->output_section->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12973 {
12974 /* This happens to make the list in reverse order,
12975 which is what we want. */
12976 htab->sec_info[isec->id].u.list
12977 = htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list;
12978 htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list = isec;
12979 }
12980
12981 if (htab->multi_toc_needed)
12982 {
12983 /* Analyse sections that aren't already flagged as needing a
12984 valid toc pointer. Exclude .fixup for the linux kernel.
12985 .fixup contains branches, but only back to the function that
12986 hit an exception. */
12987 if (!(isec->has_toc_reloc
12988 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
12989 || strcmp (isec->name, ".fixup") == 0
12990 || isec->call_check_done))
12991 {
12992 if (toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec) < 0)
12993 return false;
12994 }
12995 /* Make all sections use the TOC assigned for this object file.
12996 This will be wrong for pasted sections; We fix that in
12997 check_pasted_section(). */
12998 if (elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0)
12999 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
13000 }
13001
13002 htab->sec_info[isec->id].toc_off = htab->toc_curr;
13003 return true;
13004 }
13005
13006 /* Check that all .init and .fini sections use the same toc, if they
13007 have toc relocs. */
13008
13009 static bool
13010 check_pasted_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, const char *name)
13011 {
13012 asection *o = bfd_get_section_by_name (info->output_bfd, name);
13013
13014 if (o != NULL)
13015 {
13016 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13017 bfd_vma toc_off = 0;
13018 asection *i;
13019
13020 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
13021 if (i->has_toc_reloc)
13022 {
13023 if (toc_off == 0)
13024 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
13025 else if (toc_off != htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off)
13026 return false;
13027 }
13028
13029 if (toc_off == 0)
13030 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
13031 if (i->makes_toc_func_call)
13032 {
13033 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
13034 break;
13035 }
13036
13037 /* Make sure the whole pasted function uses the same toc offset. */
13038 if (toc_off != 0)
13039 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
13040 htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off = toc_off;
13041 }
13042 return true;
13043 }
13044
13045 bool
13046 ppc64_elf_check_init_fini (struct bfd_link_info *info)
13047 {
13048 return (check_pasted_section (info, ".init")
13049 & check_pasted_section (info, ".fini"));
13050 }
13051
13052 /* See whether we can group stub sections together. Grouping stub
13053 sections may result in fewer stubs. More importantly, we need to
13054 put all .init* and .fini* stubs at the beginning of the .init or
13055 .fini output sections respectively, because glibc splits the
13056 _init and _fini functions into multiple parts. Putting a stub in
13057 the middle of a function is not a good idea. */
13058
13059 static bool
13060 group_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
13061 bfd_size_type stub_group_size,
13062 bool stubs_always_before_branch)
13063 {
13064 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
13065 asection *osec;
13066 bool suppress_size_errors;
13067
13068 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13069 if (htab == NULL)
13070 return false;
13071
13072 suppress_size_errors = false;
13073 if (stub_group_size == 1)
13074 {
13075 /* Default values. */
13076 if (stubs_always_before_branch)
13077 stub_group_size = 0x1e00000;
13078 else
13079 stub_group_size = 0x1c00000;
13080 suppress_size_errors = true;
13081 }
13082
13083 for (osec = info->output_bfd->sections; osec != NULL; osec = osec->next)
13084 {
13085 asection *tail;
13086
13087 if (osec->id >= htab->sec_info_arr_size)
13088 continue;
13089
13090 tail = htab->sec_info[osec->id].u.list;
13091 while (tail != NULL)
13092 {
13093 asection *curr;
13094 asection *prev;
13095 bfd_size_type total;
13096 bool big_sec;
13097 bfd_vma curr_toc;
13098 struct map_stub *group;
13099 bfd_size_type group_size;
13100
13101 curr = tail;
13102 total = tail->size;
13103 group_size = (ppc64_elf_section_data (tail) != NULL
13104 && ppc64_elf_section_data (tail)->has_14bit_branch
13105 ? stub_group_size >> 10 : stub_group_size);
13106
13107 big_sec = total > group_size;
13108 if (big_sec && !suppress_size_errors)
13109 /* xgettext:c-format */
13110 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB section %pA exceeds stub group size"),
13111 tail->owner, tail);
13112 curr_toc = htab->sec_info[tail->id].toc_off;
13113
13114 while ((prev = htab->sec_info[curr->id].u.list) != NULL
13115 && ((total += curr->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
13116 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
13117 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
13118 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10) : group_size))
13119 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
13120 curr = prev;
13121
13122 /* OK, the size from the start of CURR to the end is less
13123 than group_size and thus can be handled by one stub
13124 section. (or the tail section is itself larger than
13125 group_size, in which case we may be toast.) We should
13126 really be keeping track of the total size of stubs added
13127 here, as stubs contribute to the final output section
13128 size. That's a little tricky, and this way will only
13129 break if stubs added make the total size more than 2^25,
13130 ie. for the default stub_group_size, if stubs total more
13131 than 2097152 bytes, or nearly 75000 plt call stubs. */
13132 group = bfd_alloc (curr->owner, sizeof (*group));
13133 if (group == NULL)
13134 return false;
13135 group->link_sec = curr;
13136 group->stub_sec = NULL;
13137 group->needs_save_res = 0;
13138 group->lr_restore = 0;
13139 group->eh_size = 0;
13140 group->eh_base = 0;
13141 group->next = htab->group;
13142 htab->group = group;
13143 do
13144 {
13145 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
13146 /* Set up this stub group. */
13147 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
13148 }
13149 while (tail != curr && (tail = prev) != NULL);
13150
13151 /* But wait, there's more! Input sections up to group_size
13152 bytes before the stub section can be handled by it too.
13153 Don't do this if we have a really large section after the
13154 stubs, as adding more stubs increases the chance that
13155 branches may not reach into the stub section. */
13156 if (!stubs_always_before_branch && !big_sec)
13157 {
13158 total = 0;
13159 while (prev != NULL
13160 && ((total += tail->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
13161 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
13162 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
13163 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10)
13164 : group_size))
13165 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
13166 {
13167 tail = prev;
13168 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
13169 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
13170 }
13171 }
13172 tail = prev;
13173 }
13174 }
13175 return true;
13176 }
13177
13178 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
13179 {
13180 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
13181 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
13182 1, /* CIE version. */
13183 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
13184 4, /* Code alignment. */
13185 0x78, /* Data alignment. */
13186 65, /* RA reg. */
13187 1, /* Augmentation size. */
13188 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
13189 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
13190 };
13191
13192 /* Stripping output sections is normally done before dynamic section
13193 symbols have been allocated. This function is called later, and
13194 handles cases like htab->brlt which is mapped to its own output
13195 section. */
13196
13197 static void
13198 maybe_strip_output (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
13199 {
13200 if (isec->size == 0
13201 && isec->output_section->size == 0
13202 && !(isec->output_section->flags & SEC_KEEP)
13203 && !bfd_section_removed_from_list (info->output_bfd,
13204 isec->output_section)
13205 && elf_section_data (isec->output_section)->dynindx == 0)
13206 {
13207 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
13208 bfd_section_list_remove (info->output_bfd, isec->output_section);
13209 info->output_bfd->section_count--;
13210 }
13211 }
13212
13213 /* Determine and set the size of the stub section for a final link.
13214
13215 The basic idea here is to examine all the relocations looking for
13216 PC-relative calls to a target that is unreachable with a "bl"
13217 instruction. */
13218
13219 bool
13220 ppc64_elf_size_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
13221 {
13222 bfd_size_type stub_group_size;
13223 bool stubs_always_before_branch;
13224 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13225
13226 if (htab == NULL)
13227 return false;
13228
13229 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == -1 && !htab->has_power10_relocs)
13230 htab->params->power10_stubs = 0;
13231
13232 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1 && !bfd_link_executable (info))
13233 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 1;
13234 if (!htab->opd_abi)
13235 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 0;
13236 else if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1)
13237 {
13238 static const char *const thread_starter[] =
13239 {
13240 "pthread_create",
13241 /* libstdc++ */
13242 "_ZNSt6thread15_M_start_threadESt10shared_ptrINS_10_Impl_baseEE",
13243 /* librt */
13244 "aio_init", "aio_read", "aio_write", "aio_fsync", "lio_listio",
13245 "mq_notify", "create_timer",
13246 /* libanl */
13247 "getaddrinfo_a",
13248 /* libgomp */
13249 "GOMP_parallel",
13250 "GOMP_parallel_start",
13251 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static",
13252 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static_start",
13253 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic",
13254 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic_start",
13255 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided",
13256 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided_start",
13257 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime",
13258 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime_start",
13259 "GOMP_parallel_sections",
13260 "GOMP_parallel_sections_start",
13261 /* libgo */
13262 "__go_go",
13263 };
13264 unsigned i;
13265
13266 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (thread_starter); i++)
13267 {
13268 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13269 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, thread_starter[i],
13270 false, false, true);
13271 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = h != NULL && h->ref_regular;
13272 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe)
13273 break;
13274 }
13275 }
13276 stubs_always_before_branch = htab->params->group_size < 0;
13277 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
13278 stub_group_size = -htab->params->group_size;
13279 else
13280 stub_group_size = htab->params->group_size;
13281
13282 if (!group_sections (info, stub_group_size, stubs_always_before_branch))
13283 return false;
13284
13285 htab->tga_group = NULL;
13286 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave
13287 && htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
13288 && (htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
13289 || htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
13290 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
13291 && is_static_defined (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf))
13292 {
13293 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec, *stub_sec;
13294 bfd_vma sym_value;
13295 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13296
13297 sym_sec = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.root.u.def.section;
13298 sym_value = defined_sym_val (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf);
13299 code_sec = sym_sec;
13300 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
13301 if (opd != NULL)
13302 opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value, &code_sec, NULL, false);
13303 htab->tga_group = htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].u.group;
13304 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (".tga_desc.stub",
13305 htab->tga_group->link_sec);
13306 if (stub_sec == NULL)
13307 return false;
13308 htab->tga_group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
13309
13310 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13311 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
13312 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
13313 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
13314 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.def_regular = 1;
13315 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.non_elf = 0;
13316 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &htab->tga_desc_fd->elf, true);
13317 }
13318
13319 #define STUB_SHRINK_ITER 20
13320 /* Loop until no stubs added. After iteration 20 of this loop we may
13321 exit on a stub section shrinking. This is to break out of a
13322 pathological case where adding stubs on one iteration decreases
13323 section gaps (perhaps due to alignment), which then requires
13324 fewer or smaller stubs on the next iteration. */
13325
13326 while (1)
13327 {
13328 bfd *input_bfd;
13329 unsigned int bfd_indx;
13330 struct map_stub *group;
13331
13332 htab->stub_iteration += 1;
13333
13334 for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_indx = 0;
13335 input_bfd != NULL;
13336 input_bfd = input_bfd->link.next, bfd_indx++)
13337 {
13338 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13339 asection *section;
13340 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
13341
13342 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
13343 continue;
13344
13345 /* We'll need the symbol table in a second. */
13346 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
13347 if (symtab_hdr->sh_info == 0)
13348 continue;
13349
13350 /* Walk over each section attached to the input bfd. */
13351 for (section = input_bfd->sections;
13352 section != NULL;
13353 section = section->next)
13354 {
13355 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irelaend, *irela;
13356
13357 /* If there aren't any relocs, then there's nothing more
13358 to do. */
13359 if ((section->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
13360 || (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
13361 || (section->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0
13362 || (section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
13363 || section->reloc_count == 0)
13364 continue;
13365
13366 /* If this section is a link-once section that will be
13367 discarded, then don't create any stubs. */
13368 if (section->output_section == NULL
13369 || section->output_section->owner != info->output_bfd)
13370 continue;
13371
13372 /* Get the relocs. */
13373 internal_relocs
13374 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (input_bfd, section, NULL, NULL,
13375 info->keep_memory);
13376 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
13377 goto error_ret_free_local;
13378
13379 /* Now examine each relocation. */
13380 irela = internal_relocs;
13381 irelaend = irela + section->reloc_count;
13382 for (; irela < irelaend; irela++)
13383 {
13384 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
13385 unsigned int r_indx;
13386 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
13387 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
13388 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec;
13389 bfd_vma sym_value, code_value;
13390 bfd_vma destination;
13391 unsigned long local_off;
13392 bool ok_dest;
13393 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash;
13394 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
13395 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13396 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
13397 char *stub_name;
13398 const asection *id_sec;
13399 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13400 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
13401
13402 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (irela->r_info);
13403 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
13404
13405 if (r_type >= R_PPC64_max)
13406 {
13407 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13408 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13409 }
13410
13411 /* Only look for stubs on branch instructions. */
13412 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
13413 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
13414 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
13415 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
13416 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
13417 continue;
13418
13419 /* Now determine the call target, its name, value,
13420 section. */
13421 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
13422 r_indx, input_bfd))
13423 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13424 hash = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
13425
13426 ok_dest = false;
13427 fdh = NULL;
13428 sym_value = 0;
13429 if (hash == NULL)
13430 {
13431 sym_value = sym->st_value;
13432 if (sym_sec != NULL
13433 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13434 ok_dest = true;
13435 }
13436 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13437 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13438 {
13439 sym_value = hash->elf.root.u.def.value;
13440 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13441 ok_dest = true;
13442 }
13443 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
13444 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
13445 {
13446 /* Recognise an old ABI func code entry sym, and
13447 use the func descriptor sym instead if it is
13448 defined. */
13449 if (hash->elf.root.root.string[0] == '.'
13450 && hash->oh != NULL)
13451 {
13452 fdh = ppc_follow_link (hash->oh);
13453 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13454 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13455 {
13456 sym_sec = fdh->elf.root.u.def.section;
13457 sym_value = fdh->elf.root.u.def.value;
13458 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13459 ok_dest = true;
13460 }
13461 else
13462 fdh = NULL;
13463 }
13464 }
13465 else
13466 {
13467 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13468 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13469 }
13470
13471 destination = 0;
13472 local_off = 0;
13473 if (ok_dest)
13474 {
13475 sym_value += irela->r_addend;
13476 destination = (sym_value
13477 + sym_sec->output_offset
13478 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
13479 local_off = PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (hash
13480 ? hash->elf.other
13481 : sym->st_other);
13482 }
13483
13484 code_sec = sym_sec;
13485 code_value = sym_value;
13486 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
13487 if (opd != NULL)
13488 {
13489 bfd_vma dest;
13490
13491 if (hash == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
13492 {
13493 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
13494 if (adjust == -1)
13495 continue;
13496 code_value += adjust;
13497 sym_value += adjust;
13498 }
13499 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
13500 &code_sec, &code_value, false);
13501 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
13502 {
13503 destination = dest;
13504 if (fdh != NULL)
13505 {
13506 /* Fixup old ABI sym to point at code
13507 entry. */
13508 hash->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defweak;
13509 hash->elf.root.u.def.section = code_sec;
13510 hash->elf.root.u.def.value = code_value;
13511 }
13512 }
13513 }
13514
13515 /* Determine what (if any) linker stub is needed. */
13516 plt_ent = NULL;
13517 stub_type = ppc_type_of_stub (section, irela, &hash,
13518 &plt_ent, destination,
13519 local_off);
13520
13521 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
13522 {
13523 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13524 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
13525 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
13526 || (code_sec != NULL
13527 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13528 && (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13529 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13530 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
13531 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc;
13532 }
13533 else if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call)
13534 {
13535 /* Check whether we need a TOC adjusting stub.
13536 Since the linker pastes together pieces from
13537 different object files when creating the
13538 _init and _fini functions, it may be that a
13539 call to what looks like a local sym is in
13540 fact a call needing a TOC adjustment. */
13541 if ((code_sec != NULL
13542 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13543 && (code_sec->has_toc_reloc
13544 || code_sec->makes_toc_func_call)
13545 && (htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].toc_off
13546 != htab->sec_info[section->id].toc_off))
13547 || (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13548 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13549 == 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT))
13550 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off;
13551 }
13552
13553 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_none)
13554 continue;
13555
13556 /* __tls_get_addr calls might be eliminated. */
13557 if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call
13558 && stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
13559 && hash != NULL
13560 && is_tls_get_addr (&hash->elf, htab)
13561 && section->has_tls_reloc
13562 && irela != internal_relocs)
13563 {
13564 /* Get tls info. */
13565 unsigned char *tls_mask;
13566
13567 if (!get_tls_mask (&tls_mask, NULL, NULL, &local_syms,
13568 irela - 1, input_bfd))
13569 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13570 if ((*tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13571 && (*tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) == 0)
13572 continue;
13573 }
13574
13575 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13576 {
13577 if (!htab->opd_abi
13578 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
13579 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&hash->elf))
13580 htab->has_plt_localentry0 = 1;
13581 else if (irela + 1 < irelaend
13582 && irela[1].r_offset == irela->r_offset + 4
13583 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (irela[1].r_info)
13584 == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE))
13585 {
13586 if (!tocsave_find (htab, INSERT,
13587 &local_syms, irela + 1, input_bfd))
13588 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13589 }
13590 else
13591 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save;
13592 }
13593
13594 /* Support for grouping stub sections. */
13595 id_sec = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group->link_sec;
13596
13597 /* Get the name of this stub. */
13598 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, hash, irela);
13599 if (!stub_name)
13600 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13601
13602 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
13603 stub_name, false, false);
13604 if (stub_entry != NULL)
13605 {
13606 enum ppc_stub_type old_type;
13607
13608 /* A stub has already been created, but it may
13609 not be the required type. We shouldn't be
13610 transitioning from plt_call to long_branch
13611 stubs or vice versa, but we might be
13612 upgrading from plt_call to plt_call_r2save or
13613 from long_branch to long_branch_r2off. */
13614 free (stub_name);
13615 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == -1)
13616 {
13617 /* For --power10-stubs=auto, don't merge _notoc
13618 and other varieties of stubs. (The _both
13619 variety won't be created.) */
13620 bool notoc = r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
13621 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *alt_stub
13622 = select_alt_stub (stub_entry, notoc);
13623
13624 if (alt_stub == NULL)
13625 {
13626 alt_stub = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *)
13627 stub_hash_newfunc (NULL,
13628 &htab->stub_hash_table,
13629 stub_entry->root.string);
13630 if (alt_stub == NULL)
13631 {
13632 /* xgettext:c-format */
13633 _bfd_error_handler
13634 (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
13635 section->owner, stub_entry->root.string);
13636 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13637 }
13638 *alt_stub = *stub_entry;
13639 stub_entry->root.next = &alt_stub->root;
13640 if (notoc)
13641 /* Sort notoc stubs first, for no good
13642 reason. */
13643 alt_stub = stub_entry;
13644 alt_stub->stub_type = stub_type;
13645 }
13646 stub_entry = alt_stub;
13647 }
13648 old_type = stub_entry->stub_type;
13649 switch (old_type)
13650 {
13651 default:
13652 abort ();
13653
13654 case ppc_stub_save_res:
13655 continue;
13656
13657 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
13658 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
13659 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
13660 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
13661 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13662 continue;
13663 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13664 {
13665 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13666 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13667 }
13668 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13669 {
13670 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13671 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13672 }
13673 else
13674 abort ();
13675 break;
13676
13677 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
13678 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
13679 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
13680 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
13681 old_type += (ppc_stub_long_branch
13682 - ppc_stub_plt_branch);
13683 /* Fall through. */
13684 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
13685 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
13686 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
13687 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
13688 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch)
13689 continue;
13690 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13691 {
13692 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13693 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13694 }
13695 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13696 {
13697 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13698 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13699 }
13700 else
13701 abort ();
13702 break;
13703 }
13704 if (old_type < stub_type)
13705 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13706 continue;
13707 }
13708
13709 stub_entry = ppc_add_stub (stub_name, section, info);
13710 if (stub_entry == NULL)
13711 {
13712 free (stub_name);
13713 error_ret_free_internal:
13714 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
13715 free (internal_relocs);
13716 error_ret_free_local:
13717 if (symtab_hdr->contents
13718 != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13719 free (local_syms);
13720 return false;
13721 }
13722
13723 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13724 if (stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
13725 && stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
13726 {
13727 stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
13728 stub_entry->target_section = sym_sec;
13729 }
13730 else
13731 {
13732 stub_entry->target_value = code_value;
13733 stub_entry->target_section = code_sec;
13734 }
13735 stub_entry->h = hash;
13736 stub_entry->plt_ent = plt_ent;
13737 stub_entry->symtype
13738 = hash ? hash->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
13739 stub_entry->other = hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other;
13740
13741 if (hash != NULL
13742 && (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13743 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
13744 htab->stub_globals += 1;
13745 }
13746
13747 /* We're done with the internal relocs, free them. */
13748 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs != internal_relocs)
13749 free (internal_relocs);
13750 }
13751
13752 if (local_syms != NULL
13753 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13754 {
13755 if (!info->keep_memory)
13756 free (local_syms);
13757 else
13758 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
13759 }
13760 }
13761
13762 /* We may have added some stubs. Find out the new size of the
13763 stub sections. */
13764 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13765 {
13766 group->lr_restore = 0;
13767 group->eh_size = 0;
13768 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13769 {
13770 asection *stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
13771
13772 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13773 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size)
13774 /* Past STUB_SHRINK_ITER, rawsize is the max size seen. */
13775 stub_sec->rawsize = stub_sec->size;
13776 stub_sec->size = 0;
13777 stub_sec->reloc_count = 0;
13778 stub_sec->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13779 }
13780 }
13781 if (htab->tga_group != NULL)
13782 {
13783 /* See emit_tga_desc and emit_tga_desc_eh_frame. */
13784 htab->tga_group->eh_size
13785 = 1 + 2 + (htab->opd_abi != 0) + 3 + 8 * 2 + 3 + 8 + 3;
13786 htab->tga_group->lr_restore = 23 * 4;
13787 htab->tga_group->stub_sec->size = 24 * 4;
13788 }
13789
13790 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13791 || htab->brlt->rawsize < htab->brlt->size)
13792 htab->brlt->rawsize = htab->brlt->size;
13793 htab->brlt->size = 0;
13794 htab->brlt->reloc_count = 0;
13795 htab->brlt->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13796 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13797 htab->relbrlt->size = 0;
13798
13799 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_size_one_stub, info);
13800
13801 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13802 if (group->needs_save_res)
13803 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
13804
13805 if (info->emitrelocations
13806 && htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13807 {
13808 htab->glink->reloc_count = 1;
13809 htab->glink->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
13810 }
13811
13812 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13813 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
13814 && htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->size > 8)
13815 {
13816 size_t size = 0, align = 4;
13817
13818 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13819 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13820 size += (group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align;
13821 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13822 size += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
13823 if (size != 0)
13824 size += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
13825 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13826 size = (size + align - 1) & -align;
13827 htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize = htab->glink_eh_frame->size;
13828 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size;
13829 }
13830
13831 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
13832 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13833 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13834 {
13835 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
13836 group->stub_sec->size
13837 = (group->stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
13838 }
13839
13840 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13841 if (group->stub_sec != NULL
13842 && group->stub_sec->rawsize != group->stub_sec->size
13843 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13844 || group->stub_sec->rawsize < group->stub_sec->size))
13845 break;
13846
13847 if (group == NULL
13848 && (htab->brlt->rawsize == htab->brlt->size
13849 || (htab->stub_iteration > STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13850 && htab->brlt->rawsize > htab->brlt->size))
13851 && (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
13852 || htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize == htab->glink_eh_frame->size)
13853 && (htab->tga_group == NULL
13854 || htab->stub_iteration > 1))
13855 break;
13856
13857 /* Ask the linker to do its stuff. */
13858 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
13859 }
13860
13861 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13862 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
13863 {
13864 bfd_vma val;
13865 bfd_byte *p, *last_fde;
13866 size_t last_fde_len, size, align, pad;
13867 struct map_stub *group;
13868
13869 /* It is necessary to at least have a rough outline of the
13870 linker generated CIEs and FDEs written before
13871 bfd_elf_discard_info is run, in order for these FDEs to be
13872 indexed in .eh_frame_hdr. */
13873 p = bfd_zalloc (htab->glink_eh_frame->owner, htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
13874 if (p == NULL)
13875 return false;
13876 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents = p;
13877 last_fde = p;
13878 align = 4;
13879
13880 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
13881 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
13882 last_fde_len = ((sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13883 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13884 p += last_fde_len + 4;
13885
13886 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13887 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13888 {
13889 group->eh_base = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13890 last_fde = p;
13891 last_fde_len = ((group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13892 /* FDE length. */
13893 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13894 p += 4;
13895 /* CIE pointer. */
13896 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13897 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13898 p += 4;
13899 /* Offset to stub section, written later. */
13900 p += 4;
13901 /* stub section size. */
13902 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, group->stub_sec->size, p);
13903 p += 4;
13904 /* Augmentation. */
13905 p += 1;
13906 /* Make sure we don't have all nops. This is enough for
13907 elf-eh-frame.c to detect the last non-nop opcode. */
13908 p[group->eh_size - 1] = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13909 p = last_fde + last_fde_len + 4;
13910 }
13911 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13912 {
13913 last_fde = p;
13914 last_fde_len = ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13915 /* FDE length. */
13916 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13917 p += 4;
13918 /* CIE pointer. */
13919 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13920 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13921 p += 4;
13922 /* Offset to .glink, written later. */
13923 p += 4;
13924 /* .glink size. */
13925 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size - 8, p);
13926 p += 4;
13927 /* Augmentation. */
13928 p += 1;
13929
13930 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + (htab->has_plt_localentry0 ? 3 : 2);
13931 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
13932 *p++ = 65;
13933 *p++ = htab->opd_abi ? 12 : 0;
13934 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + (htab->opd_abi ? 4 : 2);
13935 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
13936 *p++ = 65;
13937 p += ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 24;
13938 }
13939 /* Subsume any padding into the last FDE if user .eh_frame
13940 sections are aligned more than glink_eh_frame. Otherwise any
13941 zero padding will be seen as a terminator. */
13942 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13943 size = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13944 pad = ((size + align - 1) & -align) - size;
13945 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size + pad;
13946 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len + pad, last_fde);
13947 }
13948
13949 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->brlt);
13950 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13951 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->relbrlt);
13952 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL)
13953 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->glink_eh_frame);
13954
13955 return true;
13956 }
13957
13958 /* Called after we have determined section placement. If sections
13959 move, we'll be called again. Provide a value for TOCstart. */
13960
13961 bfd_vma
13962 ppc64_elf_set_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *obfd)
13963 {
13964 asection *s;
13965 bfd_vma TOCstart, adjust;
13966
13967 if (info != NULL)
13968 {
13969 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13970 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
13971
13972 if (is_elf_hash_table (&htab->root)
13973 && htab->hgot != NULL)
13974 h = htab->hgot;
13975 else
13976 {
13977 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *)
13978 bfd_link_hash_lookup (&htab->root, ".TOC.", false, false, true);
13979 if (is_elf_hash_table (&htab->root))
13980 htab->hgot = h;
13981 }
13982 if (h != NULL
13983 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13984 && !h->root.linker_def
13985 && (!is_elf_hash_table (&htab->root)
13986 || h->def_regular))
13987 {
13988 TOCstart = defined_sym_val (h) - TOC_BASE_OFF;
13989 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13990 return TOCstart;
13991 }
13992 }
13993
13994 /* The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, .plt in that
13995 order. The TOC starts where the first of these sections starts. */
13996 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".got");
13997 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13998 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".toc");
13999 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
14000 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".tocbss");
14001 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
14002 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".plt");
14003 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
14004 {
14005 /* This may happen for
14006 o references to TOC base (SYM@toc / TOC[tc0]) without a
14007 .toc directive
14008 o bad linker script
14009 o --gc-sections and empty TOC sections
14010
14011 FIXME: Warn user? */
14012
14013 /* Look for a likely section. We probably won't even be
14014 using TOCstart. */
14015 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
14016 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_READONLY
14017 | SEC_EXCLUDE))
14018 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
14019 break;
14020 if (s == NULL)
14021 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
14022 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_EXCLUDE))
14023 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
14024 break;
14025 if (s == NULL)
14026 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
14027 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY | SEC_EXCLUDE))
14028 == SEC_ALLOC)
14029 break;
14030 if (s == NULL)
14031 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
14032 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_ALLOC)
14033 break;
14034 }
14035
14036 TOCstart = 0;
14037 if (s != NULL)
14038 TOCstart = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
14039
14040 /* Force alignment. */
14041 adjust = TOCstart & (TOC_BASE_ALIGN - 1);
14042 TOCstart -= adjust;
14043 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
14044
14045 if (info != NULL && s != NULL)
14046 {
14047 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14048
14049 if (htab != NULL)
14050 {
14051 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
14052 {
14053 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust;
14054 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = s;
14055 }
14056 }
14057 else
14058 {
14059 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
14060 _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, obfd, ".TOC.", BSF_GLOBAL,
14061 s, TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust,
14062 NULL, false, false, &bh);
14063 }
14064 }
14065 return TOCstart;
14066 }
14067
14068 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_build_stubs to
14069 write out any global entry stubs, and PLT relocations. */
14070
14071 static bool
14072 build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
14073 {
14074 struct bfd_link_info *info;
14075 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
14076 struct plt_entry *ent;
14077 asection *s;
14078
14079 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
14080 return true;
14081
14082 info = inf;
14083 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14084 if (htab == NULL)
14085 return false;
14086
14087 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14088 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14089 {
14090 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage
14091 table. Set it up. */
14092 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
14093 asection *plt, *relplt;
14094 bfd_byte *loc;
14095
14096 if (use_local_plt (info, h))
14097 {
14098 if (!(h->def_regular
14099 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14100 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)))
14101 continue;
14102 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14103 {
14104 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14105 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
14106 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = true;
14107 if (htab->opd_abi)
14108 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
14109 else
14110 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
14111 }
14112 else
14113 {
14114 plt = htab->pltlocal;
14115 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
14116 {
14117 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
14118 if (htab->opd_abi)
14119 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
14120 else
14121 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
14122 }
14123 else
14124 relplt = NULL;
14125 }
14126 rela.r_addend = defined_sym_val (h) + ent->addend;
14127
14128 if (relplt == NULL)
14129 {
14130 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
14131 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
14132 if (htab->opd_abi)
14133 {
14134 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
14135 toc += htab->sec_info[h->root.u.def.section->id].toc_off;
14136 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
14137 }
14138 }
14139 else
14140 {
14141 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
14142 + plt->output_offset
14143 + ent->plt.offset);
14144 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
14145 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
14146 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
14147 }
14148 }
14149 else
14150 {
14151 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
14152 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
14153 + ent->plt.offset);
14154 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
14155 rela.r_addend = ent->addend;
14156 loc = (htab->elf.srelplt->contents
14157 + ((ent->plt.offset - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
14158 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)));
14159 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
14160 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = true;
14161 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
14162 }
14163 }
14164
14165 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
14166 return true;
14167
14168 if (h->def_regular)
14169 return true;
14170
14171 s = htab->global_entry;
14172 if (s == NULL || s->size == 0)
14173 return true;
14174
14175 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14176 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
14177 && ent->addend == 0)
14178 {
14179 bfd_byte *p;
14180 asection *plt;
14181 bfd_vma off;
14182
14183 p = s->contents + h->root.u.def.value;
14184 plt = htab->elf.splt;
14185 if (use_local_plt (info, h))
14186 {
14187 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14188 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14189 else
14190 plt = htab->pltlocal;
14191 }
14192 off = ent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
14193 off -= h->root.u.def.value + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
14194
14195 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 3) != 0)
14196 {
14197 info->callbacks->einfo
14198 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
14199 h->root.root.string);
14200 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
14201 htab->stub_error = true;
14202 }
14203
14204 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1] += 1;
14205 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14206 {
14207 size_t len = strlen (h->root.root.string);
14208 char *name = bfd_malloc (sizeof "12345678.global_entry." + len);
14209
14210 if (name == NULL)
14211 return false;
14212
14213 sprintf (name, "%08x.global_entry.%s", s->id, h->root.root.string);
14214 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
14215 if (h == NULL)
14216 return false;
14217 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
14218 {
14219 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
14220 h->root.u.def.section = s;
14221 h->root.u.def.value = p - s->contents;
14222 h->ref_regular = 1;
14223 h->def_regular = 1;
14224 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
14225 h->forced_local = 1;
14226 h->non_elf = 0;
14227 h->root.linker_def = 1;
14228 }
14229 }
14230
14231 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
14232 {
14233 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, ADDIS_R12_R12 | PPC_HA (off), p);
14234 p += 4;
14235 }
14236 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
14237 p += 4;
14238 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14239 p += 4;
14240 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, BCTR, p);
14241 break;
14242 }
14243 return true;
14244 }
14245
14246 /* Write PLT relocs for locals. */
14247
14248 static bool
14249 write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
14250 {
14251 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14252 bfd *ibfd;
14253
14254 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
14255 {
14256 struct got_entry **lgot_ents, **end_lgot_ents;
14257 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
14258 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14259 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
14260 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
14261 struct plt_entry *ent;
14262
14263 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
14264 continue;
14265
14266 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
14267 if (!lgot_ents)
14268 continue;
14269
14270 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
14271 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
14272 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
14273 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
14274 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
14275 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
14276 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14277 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14278 {
14279 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14280 asection *sym_sec;
14281 asection *plt, *relplt;
14282 bfd_byte *loc;
14283 bfd_vma val;
14284
14285 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
14286 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
14287 {
14288 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
14289 free (local_syms);
14290 return false;
14291 }
14292
14293 val = sym->st_value + ent->addend;
14294 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
14295 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
14296
14297 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14298 {
14299 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = true;
14300 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14301 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
14302 }
14303 else
14304 {
14305 plt = htab->pltlocal;
14306 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
14307 }
14308
14309 if (relplt == NULL)
14310 {
14311 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
14312 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
14313 if (htab->opd_abi)
14314 {
14315 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (ibfd);
14316 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
14317 }
14318 }
14319 else
14320 {
14321 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
14322 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
14323 + plt->output_offset
14324 + plt->output_section->vma);
14325 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14326 {
14327 if (htab->opd_abi)
14328 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
14329 else
14330 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
14331 }
14332 else
14333 {
14334 if (htab->opd_abi)
14335 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
14336 else
14337 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
14338 }
14339 rela.r_addend = val;
14340 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
14341 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
14342 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
14343 }
14344 }
14345
14346 if (local_syms != NULL
14347 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
14348 {
14349 if (!info->keep_memory)
14350 free (local_syms);
14351 else
14352 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
14353 }
14354 }
14355 return true;
14356 }
14357
14358 /* Emit the static wrapper function preserving registers around a
14359 __tls_get_addr_opt call. */
14360
14361 static bool
14362 emit_tga_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
14363 {
14364 asection *stub_sec = htab->tga_group->stub_sec;
14365 unsigned int cfa_updt = 11 * 4;
14366 bfd_byte *p;
14367 bfd_vma to, from, delta;
14368
14369 BFD_ASSERT (htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14370 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.section == stub_sec
14371 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.value == 0);
14372 to = defined_sym_val (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf);
14373 from = defined_sym_val (&htab->tga_desc_fd->elf) + cfa_updt;
14374 delta = to - from;
14375 if (delta + (1 << 25) >= 1 << 26)
14376 {
14377 _bfd_error_handler (_("__tls_get_addr call offset overflow"));
14378 htab->stub_error = true;
14379 return false;
14380 }
14381
14382 p = stub_sec->contents;
14383 p = tls_get_addr_prologue (htab->elf.dynobj, p, htab);
14384 bfd_put_32 (stub_sec->owner, B_DOT | 1 | (delta & 0x3fffffc), p);
14385 p += 4;
14386 p = tls_get_addr_epilogue (htab->elf.dynobj, p, htab);
14387 return stub_sec->size == (bfd_size_type) (p - stub_sec->contents);
14388 }
14389
14390 /* Emit eh_frame describing the static wrapper function. */
14391
14392 static bfd_byte *
14393 emit_tga_desc_eh_frame (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab, bfd_byte *p)
14394 {
14395 unsigned int cfa_updt = 11 * 4;
14396 unsigned int i;
14397
14398 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + cfa_updt / 4;
14399 *p++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
14400 if (htab->opd_abi)
14401 {
14402 *p++ = 128;
14403 *p++ = 1;
14404 }
14405 else
14406 *p++ = 96;
14407 *p++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
14408 *p++ = 65;
14409 *p++ = (-16 / 8) & 0x7f;
14410 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
14411 {
14412 *p++ = DW_CFA_offset + i;
14413 *p++ = (htab->opd_abi ? 13 : 12) - i;
14414 }
14415 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 10;
14416 *p++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
14417 *p++ = 0;
14418 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
14419 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore + i;
14420 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
14421 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
14422 *p++ = 65;
14423 return p;
14424 }
14425
14426 /* Build all the stubs associated with the current output file.
14427 The stubs are kept in a hash table attached to the main linker
14428 hash table. This function is called via gldelf64ppc_finish. */
14429
14430 bool
14431 ppc64_elf_build_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
14432 char **stats)
14433 {
14434 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14435 struct map_stub *group;
14436 asection *stub_sec;
14437 bfd_byte *p;
14438 int stub_sec_count = 0;
14439
14440 if (htab == NULL)
14441 return false;
14442
14443 /* Allocate memory to hold the linker stubs. */
14444 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14445 {
14446 group->eh_size = 0;
14447 group->lr_restore = 0;
14448 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL
14449 && stub_sec->size != 0)
14450 {
14451 stub_sec->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd,
14452 stub_sec->size);
14453 if (stub_sec->contents == NULL)
14454 return false;
14455 stub_sec->size = 0;
14456 }
14457 }
14458
14459 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14460 {
14461 unsigned int indx;
14462 bfd_vma plt0;
14463
14464 /* Build the .glink plt call stub. */
14465 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14466 {
14467 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
14468 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
14469 true, false, false);
14470 if (h == NULL)
14471 return false;
14472 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
14473 {
14474 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
14475 h->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
14476 h->root.u.def.value = 8;
14477 h->ref_regular = 1;
14478 h->def_regular = 1;
14479 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
14480 h->forced_local = 1;
14481 h->non_elf = 0;
14482 h->root.linker_def = 1;
14483 }
14484 }
14485 plt0 = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
14486 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
14487 - 16);
14488 if (info->emitrelocations)
14489 {
14490 Elf_Internal_Rela *r = get_relocs (htab->glink, 1);
14491 if (r == NULL)
14492 return false;
14493 r->r_offset = (htab->glink->output_offset
14494 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
14495 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL64);
14496 r->r_addend = plt0;
14497 }
14498 p = htab->glink->contents;
14499 plt0 -= htab->glink->output_section->vma + htab->glink->output_offset;
14500 bfd_put_64 (htab->glink->owner, plt0, p);
14501 p += 8;
14502 if (htab->opd_abi)
14503 {
14504 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R12, p);
14505 p += 4;
14506 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
14507 p += 4;
14508 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
14509 p += 4;
14510 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
14511 p += 4;
14512 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R12, p);
14513 p += 4;
14514 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
14515 p += 4;
14516 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
14517 p += 4;
14518 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | 8, p);
14519 p += 4;
14520 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14521 p += 4;
14522 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 16, p);
14523 p += 4;
14524 }
14525 else
14526 {
14527 unsigned int insn;
14528
14529 /* 0:
14530 . .quad plt0-1f # plt0 entry relative to 1:
14531 #
14532 # We get here with r12 initially @ a glink branch
14533 # Load the address of _dl_runtime_resolve from plt0 and
14534 # jump to it, with r0 set to the index of the PLT entry
14535 # to be resolved and r11 the link map.
14536 __glink_PLTresolve:
14537 . std %r2,24(%r1) # optional
14538 . mflr %r0
14539 . bcl 20,31,1f
14540 1:
14541 . mflr %r11
14542 . mtlr %r0
14543 . ld %r0,(0b-1b)(%r11)
14544 . sub %r12,%r12,%r11
14545 . add %r11,%r0,%r11
14546 . addi %r0,%r12,1b-2f
14547 . ld %r12,0(%r11)
14548 . srdi %r0,%r0,2
14549 . mtctr %r12
14550 . ld %r11,8(%r11)
14551 . bctr
14552 2:
14553 . b __glink_PLTresolve
14554 . ...
14555 . b __glink_PLTresolve */
14556
14557 if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
14558 {
14559 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, STD_R2_0R1 + 24, p);
14560 p += 4;
14561 }
14562 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R0, p);
14563 p += 4;
14564 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
14565 p += 4;
14566 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
14567 p += 4;
14568 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R0, p);
14569 p += 4;
14570 if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
14571 insn = LD_R0_0R11 | (-20 & 0xfffc);
14572 else
14573 insn = LD_R0_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc);
14574 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, insn, p);
14575 p += 4;
14576 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SUB_R12_R12_R11, p);
14577 p += 4;
14578 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R0_R11, p);
14579 p += 4;
14580 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADDI_R0_R12 | (-44 & 0xffff), p);
14581 p += 4;
14582 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
14583 p += 4;
14584 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SRDI_R0_R0_2, p);
14585 p += 4;
14586 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14587 p += 4;
14588 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 8, p);
14589 p += 4;
14590 }
14591 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCTR, p);
14592 p += 4;
14593 BFD_ASSERT (p == htab->glink->contents + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab));
14594
14595 /* Build the .glink lazy link call stubs. */
14596 indx = 0;
14597 while (p < htab->glink->contents + htab->glink->size)
14598 {
14599 if (htab->opd_abi)
14600 {
14601 if (indx < 0x8000)
14602 {
14603 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LI_R0_0 | indx, p);
14604 p += 4;
14605 }
14606 else
14607 {
14608 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LIS_R0_0 | PPC_HI (indx), p);
14609 p += 4;
14610 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ORI_R0_R0_0 | PPC_LO (indx),
14611 p);
14612 p += 4;
14613 }
14614 }
14615 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner,
14616 B_DOT | ((htab->glink->contents - p + 8) & 0x3fffffc), p);
14617 indx++;
14618 p += 4;
14619 }
14620 }
14621
14622 if (htab->tga_group != NULL)
14623 {
14624 htab->tga_group->lr_restore = 23 * 4;
14625 htab->tga_group->stub_sec->size = 24 * 4;
14626 if (!emit_tga_desc (htab))
14627 return false;
14628 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14629 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14630 {
14631 size_t align = 4;
14632
14633 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14634 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14635 p += 17;
14636 htab->tga_group->eh_size = emit_tga_desc_eh_frame (htab, p) - p;
14637 }
14638 }
14639
14640 /* Build .glink global entry stubs, and PLT relocs for globals. */
14641 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt, info);
14642
14643 if (!write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (info))
14644 return false;
14645
14646 if (htab->brlt != NULL && htab->brlt->size != 0)
14647 {
14648 htab->brlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->brlt->owner,
14649 htab->brlt->size);
14650 if (htab->brlt->contents == NULL)
14651 return false;
14652 }
14653 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL && htab->relbrlt->size != 0)
14654 {
14655 htab->relbrlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->relbrlt->owner,
14656 htab->relbrlt->size);
14657 if (htab->relbrlt->contents == NULL)
14658 return false;
14659 }
14660
14661 /* Build the stubs as directed by the stub hash table. */
14662 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_build_one_stub, info);
14663
14664 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14665 if (group->needs_save_res)
14666 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
14667
14668 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
14669 htab->relbrlt->reloc_count = 0;
14670
14671 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
14672 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14673 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14674 {
14675 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
14676 stub_sec->size = (stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
14677 }
14678
14679 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14680 if (group->needs_save_res)
14681 {
14682 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
14683 memcpy (stub_sec->contents + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size,
14684 htab->sfpr->contents, htab->sfpr->size);
14685 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14686 {
14687 unsigned int i;
14688
14689 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
14690 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], stub_sec))
14691 return false;
14692 }
14693 }
14694
14695 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14696 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14697 {
14698 bfd_vma val;
14699 size_t align = 4;
14700
14701 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14702 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14703
14704 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14705 if (group->eh_size != 0)
14706 {
14707 /* Offset to stub section. */
14708 val = (group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
14709 + group->stub_sec->output_offset);
14710 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14711 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14712 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14713 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14714 {
14715 _bfd_error_handler
14716 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14717 group->stub_sec->name);
14718 return false;
14719 }
14720 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14721 p += (group->eh_size + 17 + 3) & -4;
14722 }
14723 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14724 {
14725 /* Offset to .glink. */
14726 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
14727 + htab->glink->output_offset
14728 + 8);
14729 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14730 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14731 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14732 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14733 {
14734 _bfd_error_handler
14735 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14736 htab->glink->name);
14737 return false;
14738 }
14739 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14740 p += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
14741 }
14742 }
14743
14744 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14745 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14746 {
14747 stub_sec_count += 1;
14748 if (stub_sec->rawsize != stub_sec->size
14749 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
14750 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size))
14751 break;
14752 }
14753
14754 if (group != NULL)
14755 {
14756 htab->stub_error = true;
14757 _bfd_error_handler (_("stubs don't match calculated size"));
14758 }
14759
14760 if (htab->stub_error)
14761 return false;
14762
14763 if (stats != NULL)
14764 {
14765 char *groupmsg;
14766 if (asprintf (&groupmsg,
14767 ngettext ("linker stubs in %u group\n",
14768 "linker stubs in %u groups\n",
14769 stub_sec_count),
14770 stub_sec_count) < 0)
14771 *stats = NULL;
14772 else
14773 {
14774 if (asprintf (stats, _("%s"
14775 " branch %lu\n"
14776 " branch toc adj %lu\n"
14777 " branch notoc %lu\n"
14778 " branch both %lu\n"
14779 " long branch %lu\n"
14780 " long toc adj %lu\n"
14781 " long notoc %lu\n"
14782 " long both %lu\n"
14783 " plt call %lu\n"
14784 " plt call save %lu\n"
14785 " plt call notoc %lu\n"
14786 " plt call both %lu\n"
14787 " global entry %lu"),
14788 groupmsg,
14789 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch - 1],
14790 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off - 1],
14791 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc - 1],
14792 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_both - 1],
14793 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch - 1],
14794 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off - 1],
14795 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc - 1],
14796 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_both - 1],
14797 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call - 1],
14798 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save - 1],
14799 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc - 1],
14800 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_both - 1],
14801 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1]) < 0)
14802 *stats = NULL;
14803 free (groupmsg);
14804 }
14805 }
14806 return true;
14807 }
14808
14809 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
14810 discarded sections. */
14811
14812 static unsigned int
14813 ppc64_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
14814 {
14815 if (strcmp (".opd", sec->name) == 0)
14816 return 0;
14817
14818 if (strcmp (".toc", sec->name) == 0)
14819 return 0;
14820
14821 if (strcmp (".toc1", sec->name) == 0)
14822 return 0;
14823
14824 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
14825 }
14826
14827 /* These are the dynamic relocations supported by glibc. */
14828
14829 static bool
14830 ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
14831 {
14832 switch (r_type)
14833 {
14834 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
14835 case R_PPC64_NONE:
14836 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
14837 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
14838 case R_PPC64_IRELATIVE:
14839 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
14840 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
14841 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
14842 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
14843 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
14844 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14845 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
14846 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
14847 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
14848 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
14849 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
14850 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
14851 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
14852 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
14853 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
14854 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
14855 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
14856 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
14857 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
14858 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
14859 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
14860 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
14861 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
14862 case R_PPC64_REL30:
14863 case R_PPC64_COPY:
14864 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
14865 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
14866 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
14867 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
14868 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
14869 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
14870 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
14871 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
14872 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
14873 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
14874 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
14875 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
14876 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
14877 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
14878 case R_PPC64_REL32:
14879 case R_PPC64_REL64:
14880 return true;
14881
14882 default:
14883 return false;
14884 }
14885 }
14886
14887 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
14888 to handle the relocations for a section.
14889
14890 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
14891 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
14892 zero.
14893
14894 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
14895 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
14896 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
14897 necessary.
14898
14899 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
14900 address or the reloc symbol index.
14901
14902 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
14903
14904 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
14905 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
14906
14907 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
14908 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
14909
14910 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
14911 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
14912 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
14913 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
14914 accordingly. */
14915
14916 static int
14917 ppc64_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
14918 struct bfd_link_info *info,
14919 bfd *input_bfd,
14920 asection *input_section,
14921 bfd_byte *contents,
14922 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
14923 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
14924 asection **local_sections)
14925 {
14926 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
14927 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14928 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
14929 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
14930 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
14931 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
14932 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
14933 bfd_byte *loc;
14934 struct got_entry **local_got_ents;
14935 bfd_vma TOCstart;
14936 bool ret = true;
14937 bool is_opd;
14938 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
14939 bool is_isa_v2 = true;
14940 bool warned_dynamic = false;
14941 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
14942
14943 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
14944 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
14945 ppc_howto_init ();
14946
14947 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14948 if (htab == NULL)
14949 return false;
14950
14951 /* Don't relocate stub sections. */
14952 if (input_section->owner == htab->params->stub_bfd)
14953 return true;
14954
14955 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
14956 {
14957 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
14958 return false;
14959 }
14960
14961 local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (input_bfd);
14962 TOCstart = elf_gp (output_bfd);
14963 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
14964 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
14965 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_type == sec_opd;
14966
14967 rel = wrel = relocs;
14968 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
14969 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
14970 {
14971 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
14972 bfd_vma addend;
14973 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
14974 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14975 asection *sec;
14976 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h_elf;
14977 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
14978 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
14979 const char *sym_name;
14980 unsigned long r_symndx, toc_symndx;
14981 bfd_vma toc_addend;
14982 unsigned char tls_mask, tls_gd, tls_type;
14983 unsigned char sym_type;
14984 bfd_vma relocation;
14985 bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
14986 bool warned;
14987 enum { DEST_NORMAL, DEST_OPD, DEST_STUB } reloc_dest;
14988 unsigned int insn;
14989 unsigned int mask;
14990 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
14991 bfd_vma max_br_offset;
14992 bfd_vma from;
14993 Elf_Internal_Rela orig_rel;
14994 reloc_howto_type *howto;
14995 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
14996 uint64_t pinsn;
14997 bfd_vma offset;
14998
14999 again:
15000 orig_rel = *rel;
15001
15002 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
15003 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
15004
15005 /* For old style R_PPC64_TOC relocs with a zero symbol, use the
15006 symbol of the previous ADDR64 reloc. The symbol gives us the
15007 proper TOC base to use. */
15008 if (rel->r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC)
15009 && wrel != relocs
15010 && ELF64_R_TYPE (wrel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
15011 && is_opd)
15012 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (wrel[-1].r_info);
15013
15014 sym = NULL;
15015 sec = NULL;
15016 h_elf = NULL;
15017 sym_name = NULL;
15018 unresolved_reloc = false;
15019 warned = false;
15020
15021 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
15022 {
15023 /* It's a local symbol. */
15024 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
15025
15026 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
15027 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
15028 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
15029 sym_type = ELF64_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
15030 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
15031 opd = get_opd_info (sec);
15032 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
15033 {
15034 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value
15035 + rel->r_addend)];
15036 if (adjust == -1)
15037 relocation = 0;
15038 else
15039 {
15040 /* If this is a relocation against the opd section sym
15041 and we have edited .opd, adjust the reloc addend so
15042 that ld -r and ld --emit-relocs output is correct.
15043 If it is a reloc against some other .opd symbol,
15044 then the symbol value will be adjusted later. */
15045 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
15046 rel->r_addend += adjust;
15047 else
15048 relocation += adjust;
15049 }
15050 }
15051 }
15052 else
15053 {
15054 bool ignored;
15055
15056 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
15057 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
15058 h_elf, sec, relocation,
15059 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
15060 sym_name = h_elf->root.root.string;
15061 sym_type = h_elf->type;
15062 if (sec != NULL
15063 && sec->owner == output_bfd
15064 && strcmp (sec->name, ".opd") == 0)
15065 {
15066 /* This is a symbol defined in a linker script. All
15067 such are defined in output sections, even those
15068 defined by simple assignment from a symbol defined in
15069 an input section. Transfer the symbol to an
15070 appropriate input .opd section, so that a branch to
15071 this symbol will be mapped to the location specified
15072 by the opd entry. */
15073 struct bfd_link_order *lo;
15074 for (lo = sec->map_head.link_order; lo != NULL; lo = lo->next)
15075 if (lo->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
15076 {
15077 asection *isec = lo->u.indirect.section;
15078 if (h_elf->root.u.def.value >= isec->output_offset
15079 && h_elf->root.u.def.value < (isec->output_offset
15080 + isec->size))
15081 {
15082 h_elf->root.u.def.value -= isec->output_offset;
15083 h_elf->root.u.def.section = isec;
15084 sec = isec;
15085 break;
15086 }
15087 }
15088 }
15089 }
15090 h = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h_elf);
15091
15092 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
15093 {
15094 _bfd_clear_contents (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type],
15095 input_bfd, input_section,
15096 contents, rel->r_offset);
15097 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
15098 wrel->r_info = 0;
15099 wrel->r_addend = 0;
15100
15101 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
15102 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
15103 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
15104 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
15105 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
15106 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
15107 wrel--;
15108
15109 continue;
15110 }
15111
15112 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
15113 goto copy_reloc;
15114
15115 if (h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
15116 {
15117 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15118 sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
15119 unresolved_reloc = false;
15120 }
15121
15122 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
15123 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
15124 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
15125 for the final instruction stream. */
15126 tls_mask = 0;
15127 tls_gd = 0;
15128 toc_symndx = 0;
15129 if (h != NULL)
15130 tls_mask = h->tls_mask;
15131 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
15132 {
15133 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
15134 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
15135 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
15136 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
15137 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
15138 }
15139 if (((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0 || tls_mask == (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
15140 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
15141 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
15142 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
15143 {
15144 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
15145 unsigned char *toc_tls;
15146
15147 if (!get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
15148 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
15149 return false;
15150
15151 if (toc_tls)
15152 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
15153 }
15154
15155 /* Check that tls relocs are used with tls syms, and non-tls
15156 relocs are used with non-tls syms. */
15157 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
15158 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE
15159 && (h == NULL
15160 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
15161 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
15162 && IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
15163 {
15164 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15165 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
15166 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
15167 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
15168 /* R_PPC64_TLS is OK against a symbol in the TOC. */
15169 ;
15170 else
15171 info->callbacks->einfo
15172 (!IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type)
15173 /* xgettext:c-format */
15174 ? _("%H: %s used with TLS symbol `%pT'\n")
15175 /* xgettext:c-format */
15176 : _("%H: %s used with non-TLS symbol `%pT'\n"),
15177 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
15178 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
15179 sym_name);
15180 }
15181
15182 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
15183 if (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS != R_PPC64_TOC16_DS + 1
15184 || R_PPC64_TOC16_LO != R_PPC64_TOC16 + 1
15185 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
15186 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
15187 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
15188 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
15189 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS & 3)
15190 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS & 3)
15191 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
15192 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
15193 abort ();
15194
15195 switch (r_type)
15196 {
15197 default:
15198 break;
15199
15200 case R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT:
15201 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15202 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 58u << 26)
15203 abort ();
15204 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15205 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15206 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
15207 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15208 break;
15209
15210 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
15211 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
15212 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
15213 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
15214 {
15215 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
15216 unsigned char *toc_tls;
15217 int retval;
15218
15219 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
15220 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd);
15221 if (retval == 0)
15222 return false;
15223
15224 if (toc_tls)
15225 {
15226 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
15227 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_DS
15228 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS)
15229 {
15230 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15231 && (tls_mask & (TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL)) == 0)
15232 goto toctprel;
15233 }
15234 else
15235 {
15236 /* If we found a GD reloc pair, then we might be
15237 doing a GD->IE transition. */
15238 if (retval == 2)
15239 {
15240 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15241 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15242 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15243 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15244 }
15245 else if (retval == 3)
15246 {
15247 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15248 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15249 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15250 }
15251 }
15252 }
15253 }
15254 break;
15255
15256 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
15257 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
15258 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15259 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15260 {
15261 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
15262 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15263 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15264 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15265 }
15266 break;
15267
15268 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
15269 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15270 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15271 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15272 {
15273 toctprel:
15274 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15275 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15276 insn &= 31 << 21;
15277 insn |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis 0,13,0 */
15278 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
15279 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15280 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
15281 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15282 {
15283 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
15284 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15285 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
15286 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15287 goto again;
15288 }
15289 else
15290 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15291 }
15292 break;
15293
15294 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
15295 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15296 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15297 {
15298 /* pld ra,sym@got@tprel@pcrel -> paddi ra,r13,sym@tprel */
15299 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15300 pinsn <<= 32;
15301 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15302 pinsn += ((2ULL << 56) + (-1ULL << 52)
15303 + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26) + (13ULL << 16));
15304 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15305 contents + rel->r_offset);
15306 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15307 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15308 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15309 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15310 }
15311 break;
15312
15313 case R_PPC64_TLS:
15314 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15315 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15316 {
15317 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15318 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 13);
15319 if (insn == 0)
15320 break;
15321 if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 0)
15322 {
15323 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15324 /* Was PPC64_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
15325 PPC64_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
15326 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
15327 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15328 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15329 {
15330 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
15331 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15332 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
15333 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15334 goto again;
15335 }
15336 else
15337 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15338 }
15339 else if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 1)
15340 {
15341 /* For pcrel IE to LE we already have the full
15342 offset and thus don't need an addi here. A nop
15343 or mr will do. */
15344 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14 << 26)
15345 {
15346 /* Extract regs from addi rt,ra,si. */
15347 unsigned int rt = (insn >> 21) & 0x1f;
15348 unsigned int ra = (insn >> 16) & 0x1f;
15349 if (rt == ra)
15350 insn = NOP;
15351 else
15352 {
15353 /* Build or ra,rs,rb with rb==rs, ie. mr ra,rs. */
15354 insn = (rt << 16) | (ra << 21) | (ra << 11);
15355 insn |= (31u << 26) | (444u << 1);
15356 }
15357 }
15358 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - 1);
15359 }
15360 }
15361 break;
15362
15363 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
15364 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15365 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15366 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15367 goto tls_gdld_hi;
15368 break;
15369
15370 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
15371 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15372 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15373 {
15374 tls_gdld_hi:
15375 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
15376 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
15377 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
15378 else
15379 {
15380 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
15381 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15382 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15383 }
15384 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15385 }
15386 break;
15387
15388 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
15389 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
15390 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15391 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15392 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15393 break;
15394
15395 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
15396 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
15397 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15398 {
15399 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15400
15401 tls_ldgd_opt:
15402 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
15403 /* If not using the newer R_PPC64_TLSGD/LD to mark
15404 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
15405 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
15406 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
15407 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
15408 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
15409 && rel + 1 < relend
15410 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
15411 htab->tls_get_addr_fd,
15412 htab->tga_desc_fd,
15413 htab->tls_get_addr,
15414 htab->tga_desc))
15415 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
15416 /* We read the low GOT_TLS (or TOC16) insn because we
15417 need to keep the destination reg. It may be
15418 something other than the usual r3, and moved to r3
15419 before the call by intervening code. */
15420 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15421 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15422 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
15423 {
15424 /* IE */
15425 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
15426 insn1 |= 58u << 26; /* ld */
15427 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
15428 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15429 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15430 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16
15431 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO)
15432 r_type += R_PPC64_TOC16_DS - R_PPC64_TOC16;
15433 else
15434 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 1)) & 1)
15435 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
15436 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15437 }
15438 else
15439 {
15440 /* LE */
15441 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
15442 insn1 |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis r,13,0 */
15443 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15444 if (tls_gd == 0)
15445 {
15446 /* Was an LD reloc. */
15447 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15448 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15449 }
15450 else if (toc_symndx != 0)
15451 {
15452 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
15453 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15454 }
15455 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
15456 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15457 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15458 {
15459 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx,
15460 R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO);
15461 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15462 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
15463 }
15464 }
15465 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
15466 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15467 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15468 {
15469 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15470 if (offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15471 {
15472 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15473 if (insn2 == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15474 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15475 }
15476 }
15477 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) == 0
15478 && (tls_gd == 0 || toc_symndx != 0))
15479 {
15480 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order
15481 to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15482 goto again;
15483 }
15484 }
15485 break;
15486
15487 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
15488 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15489 {
15490 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15491 pinsn <<= 32;
15492 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15493 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15494 {
15495 /* IE, pla -> pld */
15496 pinsn += (-2ULL << 56) + (57ULL << 26) - (14ULL << 26);
15497 r_type = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34;
15498 }
15499 else
15500 {
15501 /* LE, pla pcrel -> paddi r13 */
15502 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
15503 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15504 }
15505 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15506 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15507 contents + rel->r_offset);
15508 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15509 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15510 }
15511 break;
15512
15513 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
15514 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15515 {
15516 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15517 pinsn <<= 32;
15518 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15519 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
15520 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15521 contents + rel->r_offset);
15522 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15523 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15524 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15525 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15526 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15527 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15528 goto again;
15529 }
15530 break;
15531
15532 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
15533 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
15534 && rel + 1 < relend)
15535 {
15536 unsigned int insn2;
15537 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
15538
15539 offset = rel->r_offset;
15540 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
15541 {
15542 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
15543 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
15544 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
15545 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15546 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15547 break;
15548 }
15549
15550 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
15551 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15552
15553 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15554 {
15555 /* IE */
15556 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15557 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
15558 }
15559 else
15560 {
15561 /* LE */
15562 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15563 {
15564 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
15565 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15566 }
15567 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15568 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15569 {
15570 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15571 insn2 = NOP;
15572 }
15573 else
15574 {
15575 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15576 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15577 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15578 }
15579 }
15580 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15581 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
15582 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
15583 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15584 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15585 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) == 0
15586 && toc_symndx != 0
15587 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
15588 goto again;
15589 }
15590 break;
15591
15592 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
15593 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
15594 && rel + 1 < relend)
15595 {
15596 unsigned int insn2;
15597 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
15598
15599 offset = rel->r_offset;
15600 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
15601 {
15602 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
15603 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
15604 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
15605 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15606 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15607 break;
15608 }
15609
15610 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
15611 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15612
15613 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15614 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15615 {
15616 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15617 insn2 = NOP;
15618 }
15619 else
15620 {
15621 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15622 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15623 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15624 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15625 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15626 }
15627 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15628 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
15629 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
15630 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15631 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15632 if (r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
15633 goto again;
15634 }
15635 break;
15636
15637 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
15638 if (rel + 1 < relend
15639 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
15640 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
15641 {
15642 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15643 {
15644 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_NONE);
15645 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15646 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
15647 else
15648 {
15649 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
15650 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15651 }
15652 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15653 }
15654 }
15655 else
15656 {
15657 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15658 {
15659 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
15660 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15661 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15662 }
15663 }
15664 break;
15665
15666 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
15667 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15668 {
15669 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15670 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15671 }
15672 break;
15673
15674 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
15675 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15676 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15677 && !info->traditional_format
15678 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15679 {
15680 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15681
15682 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15683 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15684 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15685 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15686 {
15687 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15688 LIS_R2 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15689 contents + rel->r_offset);
15690 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15691 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15692 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15693 }
15694 }
15695 else
15696 {
15697 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
15698 + input_section->output_offset
15699 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15700 if (relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15701 {
15702 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15703
15704 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15705 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15706 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15707 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15708 {
15709 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15710 ADDIS_R2_R12 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15711 contents + rel->r_offset);
15712 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15713 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15714 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15715 }
15716 }
15717 }
15718 break;
15719
15720 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
15721 /* If we are generating a non-PIC executable, edit
15722 . 0: addis 2,12,.TOC.-0b@ha
15723 . addi 2,2,.TOC.-0b@l
15724 used by ELFv2 global entry points to set up r2, to
15725 . lis 2,.TOC.@ha
15726 . addi 2,2,.TOC.@l
15727 if .TOC. is in range. */
15728 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15729 && !info->traditional_format
15730 && !htab->opd_abi
15731 && rel->r_addend == d_offset
15732 && h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot
15733 && rel + 1 < relend
15734 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_REL16_LO)
15735 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15736 && rel[1].r_addend == rel->r_addend + 4
15737 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15738 {
15739 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15740 offset = rel->r_offset - d_offset;
15741 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15742 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15743 if ((insn1 & 0xffff0000) == ADDIS_R2_R12
15744 && (insn2 & 0xffff0000) == ADDI_R2_R2)
15745 {
15746 r_type = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
15747 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15748 rel->r_addend -= d_offset;
15749 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO);
15750 rel[1].r_addend -= d_offset + 4;
15751 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, LIS_R2, contents + offset);
15752 }
15753 }
15754 break;
15755 }
15756
15757 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
15758 insn = 0;
15759 max_br_offset = 1 << 25;
15760 addend = rel->r_addend;
15761 reloc_dest = DEST_NORMAL;
15762 switch (r_type)
15763 {
15764 default:
15765 break;
15766
15767 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
15768 if (relocation + addend == (rel->r_offset
15769 + input_section->output_offset
15770 + input_section->output_section->vma)
15771 && tocsave_find (htab, NO_INSERT,
15772 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
15773 {
15774 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15775 if (insn == NOP
15776 || insn == CROR_151515 || insn == CROR_313131)
15777 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15778 STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15779 contents + rel->r_offset);
15780 }
15781 break;
15782
15783 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
15784 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
15785 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
15786 insn = 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
15787 /* Fall through. */
15788
15789 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
15790 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
15791 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
15792 insn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15793 contents + rel->r_offset) & ~(0x01 << 21);
15794 /* Fall through. */
15795
15796 case R_PPC64_REL14:
15797 max_br_offset = 1 << 15;
15798 /* Fall through. */
15799
15800 case R_PPC64_REL24:
15801 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
15802 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
15803 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
15804 /* Calls to functions with a different TOC, such as calls to
15805 shared objects, need to alter the TOC pointer. This is
15806 done using a linkage stub. A REL24 branching to these
15807 linkage stubs needs to be followed by a nop, as the nop
15808 will be replaced with an instruction to restore the TOC
15809 base pointer. */
15810 fdh = h;
15811 if (h != NULL
15812 && h->oh != NULL
15813 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
15814 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
15815 stub_entry = ppc_get_stub_entry (input_section, sec, fdh, &orig_rel,
15816 htab);
15817 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
15818 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15819 && stub_entry != NULL
15820 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15821 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15822 stub_entry = NULL;
15823
15824 if (stub_entry != NULL
15825 && ((stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15826 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15827 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15828 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15829 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15830 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both))
15831 {
15832 bool can_plt_call = false;
15833
15834 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15835 && !htab->opd_abi
15836 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
15837 && h != NULL
15838 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&h->elf))
15839 {
15840 /* The function doesn't use or change r2. */
15841 can_plt_call = true;
15842 }
15843 else if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15844 {
15845 /* NOTOC calls don't need to restore r2. */
15846 can_plt_call = true;
15847 }
15848
15849 /* All of these stubs may modify r2, so there must be a
15850 branch and link followed by a nop. The nop is
15851 replaced by an insn to restore r2. */
15852 else if (rel->r_offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15853 {
15854 unsigned long br;
15855
15856 br = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15857 contents + rel->r_offset);
15858 if ((br & 1) != 0)
15859 {
15860 unsigned long nop;
15861
15862 nop = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15863 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15864 if (nop == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15865 can_plt_call = true;
15866 else if (nop == NOP
15867 || nop == CROR_151515
15868 || nop == CROR_313131)
15869 {
15870 if (h != NULL
15871 && is_tls_get_addr (&h->elf, htab)
15872 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15873 {
15874 /* Special stub used, leave nop alone. */
15875 }
15876 else
15877 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15878 LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15879 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15880 can_plt_call = true;
15881 }
15882 }
15883 }
15884
15885 if (!can_plt_call && h != NULL)
15886 {
15887 const char *name = h->elf.root.root.string;
15888
15889 if (*name == '.')
15890 ++name;
15891
15892 if (startswith (name, "__libc_start_main")
15893 && (name[17] == 0 || name[17] == '@'))
15894 {
15895 /* Allow crt1 branch to go via a toc adjusting
15896 stub. Other calls that never return could do
15897 the same, if we could detect such. */
15898 can_plt_call = true;
15899 }
15900 }
15901
15902 if (!can_plt_call)
15903 {
15904 /* g++ as of 20130507 emits self-calls without a
15905 following nop. This is arguably wrong since we
15906 have conflicting information. On the one hand a
15907 global symbol and on the other a local call
15908 sequence, but don't error for this special case.
15909 It isn't possible to cheaply verify we have
15910 exactly such a call. Allow all calls to the same
15911 section. */
15912 asection *code_sec = sec;
15913
15914 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15915 {
15916 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15917 - sec->output_section->vma
15918 - sec->output_offset);
15919
15920 opd_entry_value (sec, off, &code_sec, NULL, false);
15921 }
15922 if (code_sec == input_section)
15923 can_plt_call = true;
15924 }
15925
15926 if (!can_plt_call)
15927 {
15928 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15929 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15930 info->callbacks->einfo
15931 /* xgettext:c-format */
15932 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15933 "(plt call stub)\n"),
15934 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15935 else
15936 info->callbacks->einfo
15937 /* xgettext:c-format */
15938 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15939 "(toc save/adjust stub)\n"),
15940 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15941
15942 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15943 ret = false;
15944 }
15945
15946 if (can_plt_call
15947 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15948 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15949 unresolved_reloc = false;
15950 }
15951
15952 if ((stub_entry == NULL
15953 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15954 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15955 && get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15956 {
15957 /* The branch destination is the value of the opd entry. */
15958 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15959 - sec->output_section->vma
15960 - sec->output_offset);
15961 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (sec, off, NULL, NULL, false);
15962 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
15963 {
15964 relocation = dest;
15965 addend = 0;
15966 reloc_dest = DEST_OPD;
15967 }
15968 }
15969
15970 /* If the branch is out of reach we ought to have a long
15971 branch stub. */
15972 from = (rel->r_offset
15973 + input_section->output_offset
15974 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15975
15976 relocation += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (fdh
15977 ? fdh->elf.other
15978 : sym->st_other);
15979
15980 if (stub_entry != NULL
15981 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15982 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15983 && (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
15984 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
15985 || (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15986 < 2 * max_br_offset)))
15987 /* Don't use the stub if this branch is in range. */
15988 stub_entry = NULL;
15989
15990 if (stub_entry != NULL
15991 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
15992 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15993 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
15994 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15995 && (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15996 || ((fdh ? fdh->elf.other : sym->st_other)
15997 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK) <= 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)
15998 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15999 < 2 * max_br_offset))
16000 stub_entry = NULL;
16001
16002 if (stub_entry != NULL
16003 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
16004 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
16005 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
16006 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
16007 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
16008 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
16009 < 2 * max_br_offset))
16010 stub_entry = NULL;
16011
16012 if (stub_entry != NULL)
16013 {
16014 /* Munge up the value and addend so that we call the stub
16015 rather than the procedure directly. */
16016 asection *stub_sec = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
16017
16018 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_save_res)
16019 relocation += (stub_sec->output_offset
16020 + stub_sec->output_section->vma
16021 + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
16022 - htab->sfpr->output_offset
16023 - htab->sfpr->output_section->vma);
16024 else
16025 relocation = (stub_entry->stub_offset
16026 + stub_sec->output_offset
16027 + stub_sec->output_section->vma);
16028 addend = 0;
16029 reloc_dest = DEST_STUB;
16030
16031 if ((((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
16032 && ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE)
16033 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
16034 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
16035 && rel + 1 < relend
16036 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
16037 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE)
16038 || ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
16039 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
16040 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
16041 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC))
16042 {
16043 /* Skip over the r2 store at the start of the stub. */
16044 if (!(stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
16045 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
16046 && h != NULL
16047 && is_tls_get_addr (&h->elf, htab)))
16048 relocation += 4;
16049 }
16050
16051 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
16052 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
16053 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both))
16054 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16055 }
16056
16057 if (insn != 0)
16058 {
16059 if (is_isa_v2)
16060 {
16061 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
16062 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
16063 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
16064 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
16065 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
16066 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
16067 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
16068 else
16069 break;
16070 }
16071 else
16072 {
16073 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
16074 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + addend - from) < 0)
16075 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
16076 }
16077
16078 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
16079 }
16080
16081 /* NOP out calls to undefined weak functions.
16082 We can thus call a weak function without first
16083 checking whether the function is defined. */
16084 else if (h != NULL
16085 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
16086 && h->elf.dynindx == -1
16087 && (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
16088 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
16089 && relocation == 0
16090 && addend == 0)
16091 {
16092 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
16093 goto copy_reloc;
16094 }
16095 break;
16096
16097 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
16098 if ((h ? h->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16099 || !htab->do_toc_opt)
16100 break;
16101 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16102 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16103 && sec != NULL
16104 && sec->output_section != NULL
16105 && !discarded_section (sec)
16106 && (h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)))
16107 {
16108 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16109 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
16110 {
16111 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
16112 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16113 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16;
16114 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
16115 }
16116 }
16117 break;
16118
16119 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16120 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16121 if ((h ? h->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16122 || !htab->do_toc_opt)
16123 break;
16124 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16125 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL
16126 && sec != NULL
16127 && sec->output_section != NULL
16128 && !discarded_section (sec)
16129 && (h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)))
16130 {
16131 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16132 if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS
16133 && (insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
16134 {
16135 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
16136 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16137 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
16138 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
16139 }
16140 else if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_HA
16141 && (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */)
16142 {
16143 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
16144 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
16145 }
16146 }
16147 break;
16148
16149 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
16150 if ((h ? h->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16151 || !htab->do_toc_opt)
16152 break;
16153 from = (rel->r_offset
16154 + input_section->output_section->vma
16155 + input_section->output_offset);
16156 if (!(relocation - from + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34
16157 && sec != NULL
16158 && sec->output_section != NULL
16159 && !discarded_section (sec)
16160 && (h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))))
16161 break;
16162
16163 offset = rel->r_offset;
16164 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
16165 pinsn <<= 32;
16166 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
16167 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
16168 != ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52) | (57ULL << 26) /* pld */))
16169 break;
16170
16171 /* Replace with paddi. */
16172 pinsn += (2ULL << 56) + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26);
16173 r_type = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
16174 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
16175 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + offset);
16176 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + offset + 4);
16177 /* Fall through. */
16178
16179 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
16180 if (!htab->params->no_pcrel_opt
16181 && rel + 1 < relend
16182 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset
16183 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT)
16184 && (h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)))
16185 {
16186 offset = rel->r_offset;
16187 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
16188 pinsn <<= 32;
16189 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
16190 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
16191 == ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
16192 | (14ULL << 26) /* paddi */))
16193 {
16194 bfd_vma off2 = rel[1].r_addend;
16195 if (off2 == 0)
16196 /* zero means next insn. */
16197 off2 = 8;
16198 off2 += offset;
16199 if (off2 + 4 <= input_section->size)
16200 {
16201 uint64_t pinsn2;
16202 bfd_signed_vma addend_off;
16203 pinsn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + off2);
16204 pinsn2 <<= 32;
16205 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
16206 {
16207 if (off2 + 8 > input_section->size)
16208 break;
16209 pinsn2 |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
16210 contents + off2 + 4);
16211 }
16212 if (xlate_pcrel_opt (&pinsn, &pinsn2, &addend_off))
16213 {
16214 addend += addend_off;
16215 rel->r_addend = addend;
16216 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
16217 contents + offset);
16218 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn,
16219 contents + offset + 4);
16220 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2 >> 32,
16221 contents + off2);
16222 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
16223 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2,
16224 contents + off2 + 4);
16225 }
16226 }
16227 }
16228 }
16229 break;
16230 }
16231
16232 tls_type = 0;
16233 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
16234 switch (r_type)
16235 {
16236 default:
16237 /* xgettext:c-format */
16238 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
16239 input_bfd, ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
16240
16241 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16242 ret = false;
16243 goto copy_reloc;
16244
16245 case R_PPC64_NONE:
16246 case R_PPC64_TLS:
16247 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
16248 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
16249 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
16250 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
16251 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
16252 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
16253 case R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT:
16254 goto copy_reloc;
16255
16256 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
16257 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
16258 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
16259 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
16260 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
16261 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
16262 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
16263 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16264 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
16265 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
16266 goto dogot;
16267
16268 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
16269 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
16270 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
16271 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16272 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
16273 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
16274 goto dogot;
16275
16276 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
16277 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16278 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
16279 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16280 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
16281 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
16282 goto dogot;
16283
16284 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
16285 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16286 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
16287 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16288 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
16289 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
16290 goto dogot;
16291
16292 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
16293 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
16294 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
16295 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16296 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
16297 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16298 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
16299 dogot:
16300 {
16301 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
16302 offset table. */
16303 asection *got;
16304 bfd_vma *offp;
16305 bfd_vma off;
16306 unsigned long indx = 0;
16307 struct got_entry *ent;
16308
16309 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
16310 && (h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)))
16311 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (input_bfd);
16312 else
16313 {
16314 if (h != NULL)
16315 {
16316 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
16317 || h->elf.dynindx == -1
16318 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16319 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
16320 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
16321 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
16322 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
16323 because of a version file. */
16324 ;
16325 else
16326 {
16327 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16328 unresolved_reloc = false;
16329 }
16330 ent = h->elf.got.glist;
16331 }
16332 else
16333 {
16334 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
16335 abort ();
16336 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
16337 }
16338
16339 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16340 if (ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend
16341 && ent->owner == input_bfd
16342 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
16343 break;
16344 }
16345
16346 if (ent == NULL)
16347 abort ();
16348 if (ent->is_indirect)
16349 ent = ent->got.ent;
16350 offp = &ent->got.offset;
16351 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->got;
16352 if (got == NULL)
16353 abort ();
16354
16355 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 8. We use the
16356 least significant bit to record whether we have already
16357 processed this entry. */
16358 off = *offp;
16359 if ((off & 1) != 0)
16360 off &= ~1;
16361 else
16362 {
16363 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker, except in
16364 the case of TLSLD where we'll use one entry per
16365 module. */
16366 asection *relgot;
16367 bool ifunc;
16368
16369 *offp = off | 1;
16370 relgot = NULL;
16371 ifunc = (h != NULL
16372 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16373 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
16374 if (ifunc)
16375 {
16376 relgot = htab->elf.irelplt;
16377 if (indx == 0 || is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16378 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = true;
16379 }
16380 else if (indx != 0
16381 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
16382 && (h == NULL
16383 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
16384 && !(tls_type != 0
16385 && bfd_link_executable (info)
16386 && (h == NULL
16387 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
16388 &h->elf)))))
16389 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->relgot;
16390 if (relgot != NULL)
16391 {
16392 outrel.r_offset = (got->output_section->vma
16393 + got->output_offset
16394 + off);
16395 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
16396 if (tls_type & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
16397 {
16398 outrel.r_addend = 0;
16399 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64);
16400 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
16401 {
16402 loc = relgot->contents;
16403 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
16404 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
16405 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
16406 &outrel, loc);
16407 outrel.r_offset += 8;
16408 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
16409 outrel.r_info
16410 = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
16411 }
16412 }
16413 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
16414 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
16415 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
16416 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_TPREL64);
16417 else if (indx != 0)
16418 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT);
16419 else
16420 {
16421 if (ifunc)
16422 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16423 else
16424 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16425
16426 /* Write the .got section contents for the sake
16427 of prelink. */
16428 loc = got->contents + off;
16429 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend + relocation,
16430 loc);
16431 }
16432
16433 if (indx == 0 && tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
16434 {
16435 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16436 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
16437 {
16438 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
16439 outrel.r_addend = 0;
16440 else
16441 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
16442 }
16443 }
16444 loc = relgot->contents;
16445 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
16446 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
16447 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16448 }
16449
16450 /* Init the .got section contents here if we're not
16451 emitting a reloc. */
16452 else
16453 {
16454 relocation += orig_rel.r_addend;
16455 if (tls_type != 0)
16456 {
16457 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
16458 relocation = 0;
16459 else
16460 {
16461 if (tls_type & TLS_LD)
16462 relocation = 0;
16463 else
16464 relocation -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16465 if (tls_type & TLS_TPREL)
16466 relocation += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
16467 }
16468
16469 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD))
16470 {
16471 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
16472 got->contents + off + 8);
16473 relocation = 1;
16474 }
16475 }
16476 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
16477 got->contents + off);
16478 }
16479 }
16480
16481 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
16482 abort ();
16483
16484 relocation = got->output_section->vma + got->output_offset + off;
16485 addend = 0;
16486 if (!(r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34
16487 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34
16488 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34
16489 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34
16490 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34))
16491 addend = -(TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
16492 }
16493 break;
16494
16495 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16496 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
16497 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
16498 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16499 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16500 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16501 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
16502 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
16503 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
16504 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
16505 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
16506 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
16507 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
16508 procedure linkage table. */
16509 unresolved_reloc = true;
16510 {
16511 struct plt_entry **plt_list = NULL;
16512 if (h != NULL)
16513 plt_list = &h->elf.plt.plist;
16514 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
16515 {
16516 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
16517 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
16518 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
16519 }
16520 if (plt_list)
16521 {
16522 struct plt_entry *ent;
16523
16524 for (ent = *plt_list; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16525 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
16526 && ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend)
16527 {
16528 asection *plt;
16529 bfd_vma got;
16530
16531 plt = htab->elf.splt;
16532 if (use_local_plt (info, elf_hash_entry (h)))
16533 {
16534 if (h != NULL
16535 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16536 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16537 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
16538 else
16539 plt = htab->pltlocal;
16540 }
16541 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
16542 + plt->output_offset
16543 + ent->plt.offset);
16544 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
16545 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
16546 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
16547 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS)
16548 {
16549 got = (elf_gp (output_bfd)
16550 + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
16551 relocation -= got;
16552 }
16553 addend = 0;
16554 unresolved_reloc = false;
16555 break;
16556 }
16557 }
16558 }
16559 break;
16560
16561 case R_PPC64_TOC:
16562 /* Relocation value is TOC base. */
16563 relocation = TOCstart;
16564 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
16565 relocation += htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16566 else if (unresolved_reloc)
16567 ;
16568 else if (sec != NULL && sec->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
16569 relocation += htab->sec_info[sec->id].toc_off;
16570 else
16571 unresolved_reloc = true;
16572 goto dodyn;
16573
16574 /* TOC16 relocs. We want the offset relative to the TOC base,
16575 which is the address of the start of the TOC plus 0x8000.
16576 The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, and .plt,
16577 in this order. */
16578 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
16579 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
16580 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
16581 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
16582 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16583 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16584 addend -= TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16585 if (h != NULL)
16586 goto dodyn;
16587 break;
16588
16589 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
16590 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
16591 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
16592 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
16593 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
16594 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
16595 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
16596 if (sec != NULL)
16597 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
16598 break;
16599
16600 case R_PPC64_REL16:
16601 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
16602 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
16603 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
16604 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
16605 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
16606 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
16607 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
16608 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
16609 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
16610 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
16611 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
16612 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
16613 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
16614 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16615 case R_PPC64_REL14:
16616 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
16617 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
16618 case R_PPC64_REL24:
16619 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
16620 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
16621 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
16622 break;
16623
16624 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
16625 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
16626 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
16627 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16628 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
16629 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16630 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
16631 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
16632 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
16633 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
16634 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
16635 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16636 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
16637 if (h != NULL
16638 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
16639 && h->elf.dynindx == -1)
16640 {
16641 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
16642 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
16643 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
16644 defined before using them. */
16645 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
16646
16647 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16648 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 13);
16649 if (insn != 0)
16650 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16651 break;
16652 }
16653 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16654 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16655 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
16656 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
16657 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
16658 goto dodyn;
16659
16660 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
16661 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
16662 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
16663 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
16664 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
16665 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16666 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
16667 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
16668 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
16669 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
16670 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
16671 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16672 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
16673 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16674 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16675 break;
16676
16677 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
16678 addend += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h != NULL
16679 ? h->elf.other
16680 : sym->st_other);
16681 break;
16682
16683 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
16684 relocation = 1;
16685 addend = 0;
16686 goto dodyn;
16687
16688 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
16689 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16690 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16691 goto dodyn;
16692
16693 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
16694 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16695 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16696 /* Fall through. */
16697
16698 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a
16699 dynamic object. */
16700 case R_PPC64_REL30:
16701 case R_PPC64_REL32:
16702 case R_PPC64_REL64:
16703 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
16704 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
16705 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
16706 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
16707 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
16708 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16709 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
16710 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
16711 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16712 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
16713 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16714 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
16715 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16716 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
16717 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
16718 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
16719 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16720 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
16721 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16722 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
16723 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
16724 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
16725 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
16726 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
16727 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
16728 case R_PPC64_D34:
16729 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
16730 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
16731 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16732 case R_PPC64_D28:
16733 dodyn:
16734 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
16735 break;
16736
16737 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
16738 break;
16739
16740 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
16741 ? ((h == NULL
16742 || h->elf.dyn_relocs != NULL)
16743 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
16744 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
16745 : (h != NULL
16746 ? h->elf.dyn_relocs != NULL
16747 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16748 {
16749 bool skip, relocate;
16750 asection *sreloc;
16751 bfd_vma out_off;
16752 long indx = 0;
16753
16754 /* When generating a dynamic object, these relocations
16755 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
16756 time. */
16757
16758 skip = false;
16759 relocate = false;
16760
16761 out_off = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
16762 input_section, rel->r_offset);
16763 if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -1)
16764 skip = true;
16765 else if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -2)
16766 skip = true, relocate = true;
16767 out_off += (input_section->output_section->vma
16768 + input_section->output_offset);
16769 outrel.r_offset = out_off;
16770 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
16771
16772 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
16773 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 && (out_off & 7) != 0)
16774 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR64 && (out_off & 7) == 0))
16775 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR64 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR64;
16776 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR32 && (out_off & 3) != 0)
16777 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR32 && (out_off & 3) == 0))
16778 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR32;
16779 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16 && (out_off & 1) != 0)
16780 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR16 && (out_off & 1) == 0))
16781 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR16;
16782
16783 if (skip)
16784 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
16785 else if (h != NULL
16786 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16787 && !is_opd
16788 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC)
16789 {
16790 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16791 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
16792 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16793 }
16794 else
16795 {
16796 /* This symbol is local, or marked to become local,
16797 or this is an opd section reloc which must point
16798 at a local function. */
16799 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16800 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC)
16801 {
16802 if (is_opd && h != NULL)
16803 {
16804 /* Lie about opd entries. This case occurs
16805 when building shared libraries and we
16806 reference a function in another shared
16807 lib. The same thing happens for a weak
16808 definition in an application that's
16809 overridden by a strong definition in a
16810 shared lib. (I believe this is a generic
16811 bug in binutils handling of weak syms.)
16812 In these cases we won't use the opd
16813 entry in this lib. */
16814 unresolved_reloc = false;
16815 }
16816 if (!is_opd
16817 && r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
16818 && (h != NULL
16819 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16820 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16821 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16822 else
16823 {
16824 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16825
16826 /* We need to relocate .opd contents for ld.so.
16827 Prelink also wants simple and consistent rules
16828 for relocs. This make all RELATIVE relocs have
16829 *r_offset equal to r_addend. */
16830 relocate = true;
16831 }
16832 }
16833 else
16834 {
16835 if (h != NULL
16836 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16837 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16838 {
16839 info->callbacks->einfo
16840 /* xgettext:c-format */
16841 (_("%H: %s for indirect "
16842 "function `%pT' unsupported\n"),
16843 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16844 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
16845 sym_name);
16846 ret = false;
16847 }
16848 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
16849 ;
16850 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
16851 {
16852 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16853 return false;
16854 }
16855 else
16856 {
16857 asection *osec = sec->output_section;
16858
16859 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
16860 {
16861 /* TLS symbol values are relative to the
16862 TLS segment. Dynamic relocations for
16863 local TLS symbols therefore can't be
16864 reduced to a relocation against their
16865 section symbol because it holds the
16866 address of the section, not a value
16867 relative to the TLS segment. We could
16868 change the .tdata dynamic section symbol
16869 to be zero value but STN_UNDEF works
16870 and is used elsewhere, eg. for TPREL64
16871 GOT relocs against local TLS symbols. */
16872 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
16873 indx = 0;
16874 }
16875 else
16876 {
16877 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16878 if (indx == 0)
16879 {
16880 if ((osec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
16881 && htab->elf.data_index_section != NULL)
16882 osec = htab->elf.data_index_section;
16883 else
16884 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
16885 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16886 }
16887 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
16888 }
16889
16890 /* We are turning this relocation into one
16891 against a section symbol, so subtract out
16892 the output section's address but not the
16893 offset of the input section in the output
16894 section. */
16895 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
16896 }
16897
16898 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16899 }
16900 }
16901
16902 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
16903 if (h != NULL
16904 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16905 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16906 {
16907 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
16908 if (indx == 0 || is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16909 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = true;
16910 }
16911 if (sreloc == NULL)
16912 abort ();
16913
16914 if (sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)
16915 >= sreloc->size)
16916 abort ();
16917 loc = sreloc->contents;
16918 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
16919 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16920
16921 if (!warned_dynamic
16922 && !ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)))
16923 {
16924 info->callbacks->einfo
16925 /* xgettext:c-format */
16926 (_("%X%P: %pB: %s against %pT "
16927 "is not supported by glibc as a dynamic relocation\n"),
16928 input_bfd,
16929 ppc64_elf_howto_table[ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)]->name,
16930 sym_name);
16931 warned_dynamic = true;
16932 }
16933
16934 /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, it will
16935 be computed at runtime, so there's no need to do
16936 anything now. However, for the sake of prelink ensure
16937 that the section contents are a known value. */
16938 if (!relocate)
16939 {
16940 unresolved_reloc = false;
16941 /* The value chosen here is quite arbitrary as ld.so
16942 ignores section contents except for the special
16943 case of .opd where the contents might be accessed
16944 before relocation. Choose zero, as that won't
16945 cause reloc overflow. */
16946 relocation = 0;
16947 addend = 0;
16948 /* Use *r_offset == r_addend for R_PPC64_ADDR64 relocs
16949 to improve backward compatibility with older
16950 versions of ld. */
16951 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64)
16952 addend = outrel.r_addend;
16953 /* Adjust pc_relative relocs to have zero in *r_offset. */
16954 else if (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->pc_relative)
16955 addend = outrel.r_offset;
16956 }
16957 }
16958 break;
16959
16960 case R_PPC64_COPY:
16961 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
16962 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
16963 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
16964 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
16965 /* We shouldn't ever see these dynamic relocs in relocatable
16966 files. */
16967 /* Fall through. */
16968
16969 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16:
16970 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
16971 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16972 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI:
16973 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO:
16974 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
16975 case R_PPC64_PLTREL32:
16976 case R_PPC64_PLTREL64:
16977 /* These ones haven't been implemented yet. */
16978
16979 info->callbacks->einfo
16980 /* xgettext:c-format */
16981 (_("%P: %pB: %s is not supported for `%pT'\n"),
16982 input_bfd,
16983 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, sym_name);
16984
16985 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
16986 ret = false;
16987 goto copy_reloc;
16988 }
16989
16990 /* Multi-instruction sequences that access the TOC can be
16991 optimized, eg. addis ra,r2,0; addi rb,ra,x;
16992 to nop; addi rb,r2,x; */
16993 switch (r_type)
16994 {
16995 default:
16996 break;
16997
16998 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
16999 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
17000 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
17001 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
17002 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
17003 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
17004 /* These relocs would only be useful if building up an
17005 offset to later add to r2, perhaps in an indexed
17006 addressing mode instruction. Don't try to optimize.
17007 Unfortunately, the possibility of someone building up an
17008 offset like this or even with the HA relocs, means that
17009 we need to check the high insn when optimizing the low
17010 insn. */
17011 break;
17012
17013 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
17014 if (!unresolved_reloc)
17015 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
17016 /* Fall through. */
17017 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
17018 if (unresolved_reloc)
17019 {
17020 /* No plt entry. Make this into a direct call. */
17021 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
17022 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
17023 insn &= 1;
17024 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B_DOT | insn, p);
17025 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
17026 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p + 4);
17027 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
17028 r_type = R_PPC64_REL24;
17029 }
17030 break;
17031
17032 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
17033 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
17034 if (unresolved_reloc)
17035 {
17036 unresolved_reloc = false;
17037 goto nop_it;
17038 }
17039 break;
17040
17041 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
17042 if (!unresolved_reloc)
17043 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
17044 /* Fall through. */
17045 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
17046 if (unresolved_reloc)
17047 {
17048 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
17049 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP >> 32, p);
17050 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP, p + 4);
17051 unresolved_reloc = false;
17052 goto copy_reloc;
17053 }
17054 break;
17055
17056 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
17057 if (unresolved_reloc)
17058 {
17059 unresolved_reloc = false;
17060 goto nop_it;
17061 }
17062 /* Fall through. */
17063 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
17064 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
17065 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
17066 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
17067 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
17068 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
17069 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
17070 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
17071 {
17072 bfd_byte *p;
17073 nop_it:
17074 p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
17075 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
17076 goto copy_reloc;
17077 }
17078 break;
17079
17080 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
17081 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
17082 if (unresolved_reloc)
17083 {
17084 unresolved_reloc = false;
17085 goto nop_it;
17086 }
17087 /* Fall through. */
17088 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
17089 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
17090 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
17091 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
17092 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
17093 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
17094 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
17095 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
17096 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
17097 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
17098 {
17099 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
17100 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
17101 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */)
17102 {
17103 /* Transform addic to addi when we change reg. */
17104 insn &= ~((0x3fu << 26) | (0x1f << 16));
17105 insn |= (14u << 26) | (2 << 16);
17106 }
17107 else
17108 {
17109 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
17110 insn |= 2 << 16;
17111 }
17112 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
17113 }
17114 break;
17115
17116 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
17117 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
17118 {
17119 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
17120 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
17121 goto copy_reloc;
17122 }
17123 break;
17124
17125 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
17126 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
17127 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
17128 {
17129 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
17130 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
17131 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
17132 insn |= 13 << 16;
17133 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
17134 }
17135 break;
17136 }
17137
17138 /* Do any further special processing. */
17139 switch (r_type)
17140 {
17141 default:
17142 break;
17143
17144 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
17145 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
17146 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
17147 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
17148 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
17149 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
17150 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
17151 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
17152 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
17153 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
17154 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
17155 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
17156 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
17157 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
17158 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
17159 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
17160 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
17161 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
17162 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
17163 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
17164 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
17165 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
17166 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
17167 if (sec == NULL)
17168 break;
17169 /* Fall through. */
17170
17171 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
17172 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
17173 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
17174 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
17175 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
17176 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
17177 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
17178 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
17179 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
17180 addend += 0x8000;
17181 break;
17182
17183 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
17184 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
17185 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
17186 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
17187 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
17188 if (sec != NULL)
17189 addend += 1ULL << 33;
17190 break;
17191
17192 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
17193 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
17194 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
17195 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
17196 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
17197 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
17198 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
17199 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
17200 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
17201 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
17202 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
17203 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
17204 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
17205 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
17206 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
17207 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
17208 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
17209 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
17210 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
17211 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
17212 mask = 3;
17213 /* If this reloc is against an lq, lxv, or stxv insn, then
17214 the value must be a multiple of 16. This is somewhat of
17215 a hack, but the "correct" way to do this by defining _DQ
17216 forms of all the _DS relocs bloats all reloc switches in
17217 this file. It doesn't make much sense to use these
17218 relocs in data, so testing the insn should be safe. */
17219 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (56u << 26)
17220 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) && (insn & 3) == 1))
17221 mask = 15;
17222 relocation += addend;
17223 addend = insn & (mask ^ 3);
17224 if ((relocation & mask) != 0)
17225 {
17226 relocation ^= relocation & mask;
17227 info->callbacks->einfo
17228 /* xgettext:c-format */
17229 (_("%H: error: %s not a multiple of %u\n"),
17230 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17231 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
17232 mask + 1);
17233 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
17234 ret = false;
17235 goto copy_reloc;
17236 }
17237 break;
17238 }
17239
17240 /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
17241 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
17242 not process them. */
17243 howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) r_type];
17244 if (unresolved_reloc
17245 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
17246 && h->elf.def_dynamic)
17247 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
17248 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
17249 {
17250 info->callbacks->einfo
17251 /* xgettext:c-format */
17252 (_("%H: unresolvable %s against `%pT'\n"),
17253 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17254 howto->name,
17255 h->elf.root.root.string);
17256 ret = false;
17257 }
17258
17259 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
17260 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
17261 have different reloc types. */
17262 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
17263 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
17264 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
17265 {
17266 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
17267
17268 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
17269 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
17270 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
17271 else if (howto->rightshift == 0
17272 ? ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
17273 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
17274 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
17275 : ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 29u << 26 /* andis */
17276 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 25u << 26 /* oris */
17277 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 27u << 26 /* xoris */))
17278 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
17279 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
17280 {
17281 alt_howto = *howto;
17282 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
17283 howto = &alt_howto;
17284 }
17285 }
17286
17287 switch (r_type)
17288 {
17289 /* Split field relocs aren't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
17290 case R_PPC64_D34:
17291 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
17292 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
17293 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
17294 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
17295 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
17296 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
17297 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
17298 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
17299 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
17300 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
17301 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
17302 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
17303 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
17304 case R_PPC64_D28:
17305 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
17306 if (rel->r_offset + 8 > input_section->size)
17307 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
17308 else
17309 {
17310 relocation += addend;
17311 if (howto->pc_relative)
17312 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
17313 + input_section->output_offset
17314 + input_section->output_section->vma);
17315 relocation >>= howto->rightshift;
17316
17317 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
17318 pinsn <<= 32;
17319 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
17320
17321 pinsn &= ~howto->dst_mask;
17322 pinsn |= (((relocation << 16) | (relocation & 0xffff))
17323 & howto->dst_mask);
17324 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + rel->r_offset);
17325 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
17326 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
17327 if (howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
17328 && (relocation + (1ULL << (howto->bitsize - 1))
17329 >= 1ULL << howto->bitsize))
17330 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
17331 }
17332 break;
17333
17334 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
17335 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
17336 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
17337 else
17338 {
17339 relocation += addend;
17340 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
17341 + input_section->output_offset
17342 + input_section->output_section->vma);
17343 relocation = (bfd_signed_vma) relocation >> 16;
17344 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
17345 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
17346 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
17347 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
17348 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
17349 if (relocation + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
17350 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
17351 }
17352 break;
17353
17354 default:
17355 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
17356 contents, rel->r_offset,
17357 relocation, addend);
17358 }
17359
17360 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
17361 {
17362 char *more_info = NULL;
17363 const char *reloc_name = howto->name;
17364
17365 if (reloc_dest != DEST_NORMAL)
17366 {
17367 more_info = bfd_malloc (strlen (reloc_name) + 8);
17368 if (more_info != NULL)
17369 {
17370 strcpy (more_info, reloc_name);
17371 strcat (more_info, (reloc_dest == DEST_OPD
17372 ? " (OPD)" : " (stub)"));
17373 reloc_name = more_info;
17374 }
17375 }
17376
17377 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
17378 {
17379 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
17380 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
17381 if (!warned
17382 && (reloc_dest == DEST_STUB
17383 || !(h != NULL
17384 && (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
17385 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
17386 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))))
17387 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
17388 (info, (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h, sym_name,
17389 reloc_name, orig_rel.r_addend, input_bfd, input_section,
17390 rel->r_offset);
17391 }
17392 else
17393 {
17394 info->callbacks->einfo
17395 /* xgettext:c-format */
17396 (_("%H: %s against `%pT': error %d\n"),
17397 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17398 reloc_name, sym_name, (int) r);
17399 ret = false;
17400 }
17401 free (more_info);
17402 }
17403 copy_reloc:
17404 if (wrel != rel)
17405 *wrel = *rel;
17406 }
17407
17408 if (wrel != rel)
17409 {
17410 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
17411 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
17412
17413 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
17414 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
17415 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
17416 {
17417 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
17418 one NONE reloc.
17419 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
17420 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
17421 deleted -= 1;
17422 }
17423 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
17424 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
17425 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
17426 }
17427
17428 /* If we're emitting relocations, then shortly after this function
17429 returns, reloc offsets and addends for this section will be
17430 adjusted. Worse, reloc symbol indices will be for the output
17431 file rather than the input. Save a copy of the relocs for
17432 opd_entry_value. */
17433 if (is_opd && (info->emitrelocations || bfd_link_relocatable (info)))
17434 {
17435 bfd_size_type amt;
17436 amt = input_section->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela);
17437 rel = bfd_alloc (input_bfd, amt);
17438 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs == NULL);
17439 ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs = rel;
17440 if (rel == NULL)
17441 return false;
17442 memcpy (rel, relocs, amt);
17443 }
17444 return ret;
17445 }
17446
17447 /* Adjust the value of any local symbols in opd sections. */
17448
17449 static int
17450 ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook (struct bfd_link_info *info,
17451 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
17452 Elf_Internal_Sym *elfsym,
17453 asection *input_sec,
17454 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
17455 {
17456 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
17457 long adjust;
17458 bfd_vma value;
17459
17460 if (h != NULL)
17461 return 1;
17462
17463 opd = get_opd_info (input_sec);
17464 if (opd == NULL || opd->adjust == NULL)
17465 return 1;
17466
17467 value = elfsym->st_value - input_sec->output_offset;
17468 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
17469 value -= input_sec->output_section->vma;
17470
17471 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (value)];
17472 if (adjust == -1)
17473 return 2;
17474
17475 elfsym->st_value += adjust;
17476 return 1;
17477 }
17478
17479 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
17480 dynamic sections here. */
17481
17482 static bool
17483 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
17484 struct bfd_link_info *info,
17485 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
17486 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
17487 {
17488 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
17489 struct plt_entry *ent;
17490
17491 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17492 if (htab == NULL)
17493 return false;
17494
17495 if (!htab->opd_abi && !h->def_regular)
17496 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
17497 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
17498 {
17499 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
17500 defined in glink. Leave the value if there were
17501 any relocations where pointer equality matters
17502 (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to make
17503 function pointer comparisons work between an
17504 application and shared library), otherwise set it
17505 to zero. */
17506 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
17507 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
17508 sym->st_value = 0;
17509 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
17510 {
17511 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
17512 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
17513 function pointer. */
17514 sym->st_value = 0;
17515 }
17516 break;
17517 }
17518
17519 if (h->needs_copy
17520 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
17521 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
17522 && (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
17523 || h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro))
17524 {
17525 /* This symbol needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
17526 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
17527 asection *srel;
17528 bfd_byte *loc;
17529
17530 if (h->dynindx == -1)
17531 abort ();
17532
17533 rela.r_offset = defined_sym_val (h);
17534 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_COPY);
17535 rela.r_addend = 0;
17536 if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
17537 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
17538 else
17539 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
17540 loc = srel->contents;
17541 loc += srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
17542 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
17543 }
17544
17545 return true;
17546 }
17547
17548 /* Used to decide how to sort relocs in an optimal manner for the
17549 dynamic linker, before writing them out. */
17550
17551 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
17552 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
17553 const asection *rel_sec,
17554 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
17555 {
17556 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
17557 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17558
17559 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
17560 return reloc_class_ifunc;
17561
17562 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rela->r_info);
17563 switch (r_type)
17564 {
17565 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
17566 return reloc_class_relative;
17567 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
17568 return reloc_class_plt;
17569 case R_PPC64_COPY:
17570 return reloc_class_copy;
17571 default:
17572 return reloc_class_normal;
17573 }
17574 }
17575
17576 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
17577
17578 static bool
17579 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
17580 struct bfd_link_info *info)
17581 {
17582 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
17583 bfd *dynobj;
17584 asection *sdyn;
17585
17586 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17587 if (htab == NULL)
17588 return false;
17589
17590 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
17591 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
17592
17593 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
17594 {
17595 Elf64_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
17596
17597 if (sdyn == NULL || htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
17598 abort ();
17599
17600 dyncon = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
17601 dynconend = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
17602 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
17603 {
17604 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
17605 asection *s;
17606
17607 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
17608
17609 switch (dyn.d_tag)
17610 {
17611 default:
17612 continue;
17613
17614 case DT_PPC64_GLINK:
17615 s = htab->glink;
17616 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17617 /* We stupidly defined DT_PPC64_GLINK to be the start
17618 of glink rather than the first entry point, which is
17619 what ld.so needs, and now have a bigger stub to
17620 support automatic multiple TOCs. */
17621 dyn.d_un.d_ptr += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) - 8 * 4;
17622 break;
17623
17624 case DT_PPC64_OPD:
17625 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
17626 if (s == NULL)
17627 continue;
17628 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
17629 break;
17630
17631 case DT_PPC64_OPT:
17632 if ((htab->do_multi_toc && htab->multi_toc_needed)
17633 || htab->notoc_plt)
17634 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_MULTI_TOC;
17635 if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
17636 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_LOCALENTRY;
17637 break;
17638
17639 case DT_PPC64_OPDSZ:
17640 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
17641 if (s == NULL)
17642 continue;
17643 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
17644 break;
17645
17646 case DT_PLTGOT:
17647 s = htab->elf.splt;
17648 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17649 break;
17650
17651 case DT_JMPREL:
17652 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
17653 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17654 break;
17655
17656 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
17657 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
17658 break;
17659
17660 case DT_TEXTREL:
17661 if (htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers)
17662 info->callbacks->einfo
17663 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
17664 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
17665 continue;
17666 }
17667
17668 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
17669 }
17670 }
17671
17672 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->elf.sgot->size != 0
17673 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17674 {
17675 /* Fill in the first entry in the global offset table.
17676 We use it to hold the link-time TOCbase. */
17677 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
17678 elf_gp (output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF,
17679 htab->elf.sgot->contents);
17680
17681 /* Set .got entry size. */
17682 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17683 = 8;
17684 }
17685
17686 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
17687 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17688 {
17689 /* Set .plt entry size. */
17690 elf_section_data (htab->elf.splt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17691 = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
17692 }
17693
17694 /* brlt is SEC_LINKER_CREATED, so we need to write out relocs for
17695 brlt ourselves if emitrelocations. */
17696 if (htab->brlt != NULL
17697 && htab->brlt->reloc_count != 0
17698 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17699 htab->brlt,
17700 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->rela.hdr,
17701 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->relocs,
17702 NULL))
17703 return false;
17704
17705 if (htab->glink != NULL
17706 && htab->glink->reloc_count != 0
17707 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17708 htab->glink,
17709 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->rela.hdr,
17710 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->relocs,
17711 NULL))
17712 return false;
17713
17714
17715 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
17716 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0
17717 && htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
17718 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
17719 htab->glink_eh_frame,
17720 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
17721 return false;
17722
17723 /* We need to handle writing out multiple GOT sections ourselves,
17724 since we didn't add them to DYNOBJ. We know dynobj is the first
17725 bfd. */
17726 while ((dynobj = dynobj->link.next) != NULL)
17727 {
17728 asection *s;
17729
17730 if (!is_ppc64_elf (dynobj))
17731 continue;
17732
17733 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->got;
17734 if (s != NULL
17735 && s->size != 0
17736 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17737 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17738 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17739 s->size))
17740 return false;
17741 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->relgot;
17742 if (s != NULL
17743 && s->size != 0
17744 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17745 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17746 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17747 s->size))
17748 return false;
17749 }
17750
17751 return true;
17752 }
17753
17754 #include "elf64-target.h"
17755
17756 /* FreeBSD support */
17757
17758 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
17759 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf64_fbsd_le_vec
17760 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
17761 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf64-powerpcle-freebsd"
17762
17763 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
17764 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_fbsd_vec
17765 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
17766 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc-freebsd"
17767
17768 #undef ELF_OSABI
17769 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
17770
17771 #undef elf64_bed
17772 #define elf64_bed elf64_powerpc_fbsd_bed
17773
17774 #include "elf64-target.h"
This page took 0.378367 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.